I BANK RATE p AND THE MONEY MARKET R.H.INGLIS PALGRAVE HG K\ mull mmxmiiu fawg BOUGHT WITH THE INCOME FROM THE SAGE ENDOWMENT FUND THE GIFT OF .N....l^-^.-.^.-1.1. 189X I Z ZIZ.. m-ha] 5474 The date shoivs when this volume was taken 1 ICT 5-tSIO f(&i ■jt- All books not in use for instruction or re" search are limited to four weeks to all bor- rowers. Periodicals of a gen- eral character should be returned as soon as possible ; when needed beyond two weeks a special request should be made. Limited borrowers are allowed five vol- umes for two weeks, with renewal privi- leges, when a book is ' J not needed by others. ' OCT 1 C 1060 M F °°^' "°' "^"^f * drinng recess periods should be returned to the library, or arrange- ments made for their return during borrow- er's absence.if wanted. Books needed by more than one person are placed on the re- serve list. \ w B HG1811 "pie"' ""'™^«'»V Library .j^oiin '^'^^ 030 181 865 Cornell University Library The original of tiiis book is in tine Cornell University Library. . There are no known copyright restrictions in the United States on the use of the text. http://www.archive.org/details/cu31924030181865 BANK RATE AND THE MONEY MARKET k S^-'h-^-^^ BANK RATE AND THE MONEY MARKET IN ENGLAND, FRANCE, GERMANY HOLLAND, AND BELGIUM 1 844- 1 900 By R. H. INGLIS PALGRAVE, F.R.S. EDITOR OF THE "DICTIONARY OF POLITICAL ECONOMY" DEMONSTRATIO LONGE OPTIMA EST EXPERIENTIA Francis Bacon, Novum Organum LONDON JOHN MURRAY, ALBEMARLE STREET 1903 \All Rights Reserved'] _.^_5:!4^^^^ ^i . ' ? oCs'i' / ''Hi PREFACE The fact that the rate of discount charged at the Bank of England fluctuates more often and more severely than the rate at any other of the important banks of Europe led me to consider what the causes of this instability might be. There are several ways in which the position of the English Money Market is different from that of any other country, all which might have an influence in this direction. Among these are the constant liability to sudden and large demands for specie for export, and the long-standing arrangement by which the whole specie reserve of the entire country is placed practically with one bank alone, the Bank of England, thus causing any demand of this character to centre there. These reasons are of weight, but they appear hardly sufficient to account com- pletely for what has occurred. After endeavouring fruitlessly to find explanations among the ordinary conditions of business for the great fluctuations in the rate of discount which have just been referred to as characteristic of the London Money Market, I was led to investigate the question whether the legal obli- gations under which the Bank of England carries on its operations could have anything to do with these fluctuations and consequently with the rate of interest charged. No other bank, as will be explained further on, carries on its business under similar conditions. The banks on the con- tinent of Europe are conducted under strict rules — stricter rules in some ways than those in force at the Bank of England, But at none of these banks are there conditions at all corresponding to those imposed by the Act of 1844. To make this investigation out thoroughly required much purely statistical work, on which I have now been engaged for vi PREFACE a long period. I put forward the results, not as my personal opinion, nor as a criticism of the principles on which the Bank Act is founded, but as an analysis of what has occurred since that Act came into force. In carrying this work out, I have continued the investigation commenced by myself in 1873 with a paper read before the Economic Section of the British Association at their meeting at Bradford in that year. This paper was reprinted in the Journal of the Statistical Society of London for December, 1873, ^iid afterwards published separately in 1874 under the title of An Analysis of the Transactions of the Bank of England for the Years 1844-72. Since that date the connection between the Money Markets of England and of Europe generally has become so much closer that it was needful to carry the inquiry further and to include some notice of the transactions of the Banks of France and Germany. The results of this inquiry are given in the volume entitled Bank Rate in England, France, and Germany, 1844-78, published by Efifingham Wilson in 1880. Subsequent events again called my attention to the subject, and I read a paper on it under the heading of "The Bank Acts of 1844-5, ^nd the Bank Rate," before the Institute of Bankers, March 2nd, 1892. I reprinted this paper, in which the rates charged in Holland and in Belgium were also included, but as it and my previous publications on the subject are now out of print, I have been led to investigate the subject again and have brought the inquiry down to the close of the nineteenth century. Thus this investigation, which was begun originally as an analysis of the accounts of the Bank of England, has gradually extended itself till it includes not only remarks on the Money Market of London, but on those of France, Germany, Holland, and Belgium. In all these countries, as well as in our own, a very great development in the business of banking has taken place during the last half-century. But while business has extended itself very largely among those countries, this has not been accompanied with the same constant tendency to fluctuation in the rate of discount as has been the case in London, nor have the fluctuations been as sharp. PREFACE vii I have not thought it necessary to include the wonderful growth of banking operations which has taken place in the United States during the same period, because, although the growth in that country has been both proportionally and actually far larger than in Europe, and though the Money Market of New York is very closely connected with that of London, yet the circumstances of banking in the United States are so different from those which obtain in this country and on the continent of Europe that it did not seem possible to insti- tute any useful comparison between them, for the purposes for which this volume is written. These are to call attention to : The increase needed in our specie reserve ; and the desirability of maintaining greater stability in the rate of discount. To take the first point : — The increase needed in our specie reserve. Whilst the reserve which the Bank of England keeps is now smaller in proportion to its own liabilities than it was forty or fifty years ago, it is far smaller in proportion to the liabilities of the other banks in the United Kingdom at the present time than formerly. Besides being smaller, the reserve may be weaker because the amount of specie required to be held against the note issues is relatively less. This follows from Clause V. of the Bank Act, 1844, which enacts that on the extinction of any portion of the note issue of the country banks of England and Wales an addition may be made to the issue of the Bank of England against securities to the extent of two-thirds of the amount of the country note issue cancelled. The effect of this has been since 1844 to increase the securities in the Issue Department of the Bank of England to the extent of ;^4, 175,000. Of this amount of securities, ^3,175,000 has been added since 1880. For an example of the manner in which this arrangement occasionally works out, the figures of the Issue Department as given in the returns of 2nd July, 1 879, and 12th November, 1902, are quoted. The balance between the amount of notes issued, and those in the hands of the public is entered as "Notes" among the assets of the Banking Department and forms the greater portion of the reserve of the Bank of England. The gold held against these notes in 1879 and 1 902 is shown in the figures which follow : — PREFACE Notes issued Notes issued Issue Department ;^49,o22,67S ;;^49,02Z,67S ;^49.339.090 ;^49.339.o9o 2nd July, 1879. Government debt . ;^ii,ois,ioo Other securities . . 3,984,900 Gold coin and bullion . 34,022,675 Silver bullion . . — ^^49,022,675 iz/y^ November, 1902. Government debt . Other securities Gold coin and bullion ;^ii,ois,ioo 7,159,900 • 31,164,090 ^^49.339.090 Notes issued in 1879 ;£^49j022,675 „ in 1902 . 49.339.090 Notes issued in 1902, OTijre 316,415 Gold/wj- . . . 2,858,585 ;£'3,i75,ooo Gold in 1879 . . ;^34.022,675 „ in 1902 . . . 31,164,090 Gold /«« in 1902 . . 2,858,585 Securities in 1902 as com- pared with 1879, more ;£^3,i75,ooo It is to the reserve of the Bank of England that the other banks must have recourse in any time of pressure. The Directors of the Bank of England consider, no doubt, that the reserve they maintain is adequate to their own requirements, but it is only needful to compare it with the vast amount of banking deposits now held to see how entirely inadequate it is to be the reserve of all the banks of this country. Matters have gradually drifted into this position. The arrangement is an anomalous one, but what we are concerned with now is not to discuss the manner in which it has arisen, but to consider how the existing system may be strengthened and improved. The next point is : The desirability of maintaining greater stability in the rate of discount. Great instability in the rate of discount is a very prejudicial thing to the interests of commerce, and hence to those of banking. The close com- petition between one country and another renders it a far greater danger to our business now than previously. A supply of capital at a fairly low rate, and at a rate which may be expected to remain tolerably constant, is as important to trade as a steady supply of food and other necessaries of life to PREFACE ix everyone, and of the materials on which he operates to the manufacturer. Instability in the rate for money tends to render the results of trade more uncertain than they other- wise would be, and is sufficient even to prevent business enterprises from being entertained which otherwise might be carried out to the advantage of the country. The chapters which follow show how much more equable the rate of dis- count has been at the Bank of France and at the Bank of Holland than in this country. Nearly the same may be said of the rates in Belgium and in Germany, although in Germany a higher rate has been charged than in this country ; in the three other countries named the rates have not only been more equable, but they have been lower. In many ways the position of matters is greatly altered from what it was in the early years over which this inquiry has extended. Thus to take two directions only in which the reserve of the Bank of England and the rate in con- sequence is affected. The first is through the great increase in the Scotch and Irish circulation. This increase causes larger demands on the reserve ; these fifty years ago were comparatively small, but are now of serious importance. The next is the great increase in the note circulation of the Bank of England. Every bank note in the hands of the public, whether held by a banker or a private individual, means so much the less in the reserve of the Bank. It is doubtful whether, with the great growth in the use of cheques, a larger number of bank notes is really required, but the vast increase in the banking offices of the country, now about 6,700 — probably not more than 1,000, if so many, in 1845 — of itself causes a greater number of notes of the Bank of England to be entered as "issued" at all times. These notes are of necessity held by the banks in England and Wales as "till- money," and they can scarcely be said to be in circulation. If these notes were in the Banking Department at the Bank of England the reserve would be considerably stronger. The requirements for Bank of England notes, now that the English country note issue is almost extinguished, thus help to increase the instability in the rate of discount. The following pages will explain all these matters more fully. X PREFACE I have endeavoured in them to bring together the main outlines of the facts in the belief that the information thus supplied may lead to a clearer understanding of the subject generally. And here I desire to express the hope that the large mass of figures and tables with which many of the follow- ing pages are filled will not deter anyone who desires to study the subject from entering on the investigation. Every effort has been taken to place the facts clearly before the reader, and to express the calculations on which they are founded in as concise a form as possible. Every table was worked out, week by week, and month by month, into a series of yearly averages, in which form the book would have been published but for the doubt that this would have been too cumbersome for the general reader. The statement has therefore been brought out in groups, principally of ten years each. This method renders the main results more easily intelligible, but the absence of the yearly statements omits necessarily many points in detail which are not without interest to the student. The tables, however, as they stand show the history of what has occurred in a clear outline. Many more persons are interested in banking questions now than at any previous time, owing to the increase both in the numbers of the shareholders and of the customers of banks. To all of these the questions dealt with in these pages are of interest, treating as they do, not only of the important subject of the banking reserve of the country, but of the severity of the fluctuations in the rate of discount. In conclusion, I have to express my thanks to the pro- prietors and the editor of the Bankers' Magazine for permission to employ again materials which I had worked on in that journal. I desire also to recognise the help given me by many friends, especially those engaged in banking, who have assisted me in many ways and by valuable suggestions, for which I most cordially thank them. R. H. INGLIS PALGRAVE. Belton, near Great Yarmouth, April, 1903. CONTENTS CHAPTER I INTRODUCTION Weekly Return of Bank of England continually studied, p. i — Important points in it omitted at present time, pp. i-2 — Table I : Weekly Statements of the Liabilities and Assets of the Bank of England, with full details, 7th September, 1844, and ist January, 1848, pp. 2-3 — Table 2: Example of Returns published by order of Houses of Parliament, up to twenty-five years ago, on which this Analysis of Accounts of Bank of England is based, pp. 4-5 — Greater publicity as to Accounts of Bank of England desirable, p. 6 — More publicity given as to Accounts of other Banks now than formerly, less as to Bank of England, p. 7 — Note circulations of Bank of England, Scotch and Irish Banks influence Reserve of Bank of England, p. 8 — Important recent Events influencing Money Markets of Europe and America, p. 9 — Analysis of Transactions of Banks of France, Germany, Holland, and Belgium included, p. 9 — Rates of Discount at these Banks, p. 9 — Table 3 : Annual Averages of Transactions of the Bank of England for the years 1 844- 1 900, pp. 11-15 ..... Pages 1-15 CHAPTER II THE PRINCIPAL DIVISIONS OF THE ACCOUNTS OF THE BANK OF ENGLAND The principal Divisions of the Accounts of the Bank of England are given in a series of annual averages, p. 16 — Commencement of Analysis of Table 3, p. 17 — Capital of the Bank of England, p. 17 — Notes issued. Specie and Securities in Issue Department, p. 17 — Total Deposits and Bank Post Bills, pp. 17-19 — Private Deposits, p. 18 — Effect of Chinese-Japanese Loan, 1895-6, p. 18 — Liabilities of the Bank, p. 19— The Reserve, pp. 19-20 — Proportion of Reserve to Liabilities, p. 20 — Bankers' Balances, pp. 20-22 — The Note Circulation, pp. 22-23 — The Bankers' Balances and the Reserve, pp. 23-27 — The Clearing House — Stock Exchange " Settling " Days, p. 23 — Bankers' Balances with Bank of England represent " Till Money," p. 23 — Table showing Proportion of Reserve to Liabilities, and of Bankers' Balances to Reserve, 1846-77, p. 24— Examination of this Table, p. 24 — Deposits, etc., o f the Ban l^ Hnrmg papirg nf tSj;7, 7866, and 1871;. pp. 24-25 — Amounts of " Other Deposits, Balances of London Bankers, Other Securities, and Reserve " during times of pressure in 1875, 1878, and 1890, p. 25— TheBaringUdsjs, 1890, p. 2 6 — The Other S ecu rities, their increase sin ce i844,_p^_27— Bills^^counted, amount nofknown now, p.~ 28 — Mr. Thomson Hankey on " Bills " and " Mortgages," p. 29 — Average of Coin and Bullion, pp. 30-32 — Issue Department, compelled by Act of 1844 to receive all Gold Bullion brought to it, p. 30 — Bullion held sometimes larger in amount than Notes in circulation, pp. 31-32 — Average Rate of Discount, p. 32 — Divergence between Market Rate and Bank Rate, 1845-1900, p. 32— Table 4 : Annual Averages of Bank Rate and Market Rate, and differences between them, p. 33 . 16-33 CHAPTER III THE BALANCES OF THE LONDON BANKERS WITH THE BANK OF ENGLAND Desirability of publishing information as to Balances of London Bankers with Bank, p. 34 — No arrangement between the Bank and Bankers as to manner of dealing with Balances, p. 34 — Table 5 : Annual Averages of London Bankers' Balances with the Bank xii CONTENTS of England, 1844-77, p. 35— Dates when Bankers' Balances exceeded the Reserve, 1844-77, p. 36 — Growth of Bankers' Balances unnoticed, p. 37 — Large part of Deposits at Bank consists of Bankers' Balances, p. 37— Desirability of publishing amounts held by Bankers with the Bank, in order to show of what the Reserve really consists, p. 37— Bank of England. Account for the week ending December 26th, 1877, showing Proportion of Reserve to Liabilities in ordinary form, and after deducting Bankers' Balances, p. 38— Bankers' Balances cannot form part of Reserve of Bank of England and of other Banks as well, p. 39— These Balances are the ultimate Reserve of all Banks in the kingdom, p. 39 — Practice of loaning out Reserves of Banks peculiar to this country, p. 39 — Bankers' Balances with the Bank of England included among its LiabiUties, pp. 39-41 — Periodic demands for money, p. 41 — Better arrangements with regard to Bankers' Balances and the Reserve might be made, p. 42 Pages 34-43 CHAPTER IV THE BALANCES OF THE LONDON BANKERS WITH THE BANK OF ENGLAND. HOW FAR THEY FORM AN EFFICIENT RESERVE Correspondence between Lord Aldenham (Mr. H. H. Gibbs) and Professor B. Price on the Bankers' Balances, pp. 44-45 — Portion of Balances of Bankers at the Bank of England only there for " safe custody," pp. 45-46— Normal and Abnormal Balances of Bankers, p. 45— Large part of Bankers' Balances rather "Till Money" than Reserve, pp. 45-46 — Bankers' Balances should be entered under a separate heading in accounts of the Bank, pp. 46-47 — Duty of the Bank : Protection of Reserve, p. 47 . 44-47 CHAPTER V THE PUBLISHED RATE OF DISCOUNT OF THE BANK OF ENGLAND Change made in 1878 as to the fixed Minimum Rate of Discount at the Bank of England, p. 48— The Bank Rate down to 1839, p. 49— The Bank Rate between 1839 and 1844, p. 49 — "New System of Discounting" in 1844, p. 49 — Line taken by the Bank with regard to relative position of Market Rate to Bank Rate in 1844, 1848, 1857, 1878, pp. 49-50 — Drawbacks to a published fixed Rate, p. 51 — Announcement by the Bank as to Rediscounting for Bill-Brokers, practice in 1878 and 1890, p. 51 — This unfavourable to quiet working of the Money Market, p. 52 — Banks on the Continent, Rediscount freely with Central Bank ; convenience of this arrangement, p. 52 — Bankers hardly Discount for their customers now so regularly as previously, pp. 5^-53 — Development of Bill-Broking, pp. 52-54 ...... 48-54 CHAPTER VI THE PUBLISHED RATE OF DISCOUNT OF THE BANK OF ENGLAND AND THE RESERVE The Published Rate of Bank not so clear a guide to Market Rate as formerly, pp. 55-56 — Value of opinion of Bank Directors on fixing Rate, p. 57 — Constitution of Governing Body of Bank of England, pp. 57-58 — Mr. Bagehot's remarks thereon, p. 58 — Continuity in management needed, p. 58— Bank_should observe a settled policy, p. sS^^^Gonstita- ^ tion of Governing Body of Bank discussed in tlTe Report ot the Select Committee ot the House of Lords on Commercial Distress, 184 7-8, pp. ^ij-bo — "W ant of Permanence and of Consistency " in System of Government of Bank commented on in that Report, p. 60 — Need of Authoritative Rate, p. 61 — ^Joint Committee representing Bank and London Bankers could fix Rate, p. 61 — Competition for Deposits by Banks undesirable, p. 61 — Unduly High Rate of Interest on Deposits cause of danger, p. 62 — Fixing the Rate and keeping the Reserve should go together, p. 62 — Practice of the Associated Banks of New York of publishing weekly average of Reserves, p. 63 , . S5-63 CONTENTS xiii CHAPTER VII BILLS DISCOUNTED AND TEMPORARY ADVANCES OF THE BANK OF ENGLAND Capital, etc., of Bank of England I7i millions, p. 64— Deposits held by Bank how employed, p. 64— Division of Securities held by Bank into " Government " and " Other " Securities, p. 64 — Mr. Thomson Hankey's remarks on Investment of Deposits of Bank, p. 65 — Amount of Railway Debentures, about 4 millions in 1865, p. 65 — Fluctuations in the amount of Bills Discounted, p. 66— Estimated amount of Bills in circulation, including Foreign Bills, pp. 66-67— Influence of Bank of England on Discount Market formerly greater than at present, p. 67— Bills Discounted and " Other " Securities, p. 67 — Discounters of Bills have recourse to Bank mainly in times of diflSculty and pressure, p. 67 — Temporary Advances made by the Bank of England indicate immediate wants of business, p. 67 — Fluctuations in Temporary Advances, pp. 67-68 — Fluctuations from week to week, p. 68 — Influence of periods of pressure distinctly marked, p. 68 — Desir- ability of continuing information as to Bills Discounted and Temporary Advances from 187 s onwards, p. 68 — Bank of England in same position as any other bank with regard to its private business, p. 69 . . . . . Pages 64-68 CHAPTER VIII NOTE CIRCULATION OF THE BANK OF ENGLAND, BULLION HELD IN THE ISSUE DEPARTMENT, AND THE ENGLISH COUNTRY NOTE CIRCULATION Note Circulation of the Bank of England, Bullion held in the Issue Department, and the English Country Note Circulation. Description of Table 6, pp. 69-72 — Table 6 : Monthly Averages of Note Circulation of Bank of England 1845-1900, p. 70 — Table 7 : Monthly Averages of Bullion in the Issue Department 1845-1900, p. 71 — Increase in Note Circulation of the Bank of England, p. 72 — Bank of England Notes in circulation in London and the Provinces. These Notes take the place/ of lapsed Country Note Issues, p. 72 — -Increase in Note Circulation compared with increase in Metallic Circulation, p. 72 — Mr. Newmarch's estimate of Metallic Circulation, p. 73 — Other estimates of this, p. 73 — Fluctuations in Bank Note Circulation. Times of diminution, 1879-85 ; Times of increase, 1894-1900, p. 73 — Bank Act of 1844 intended to suppress English Country Note Circulation, p. 74 — Disadvantages of this, p. 74 — Composition of Circulation of Bank of England Notes, p. 74 — Table 8 : Monthly Averages of Eng- lish Country Note Circulation, 1845-1900, p. 75 — Increase in use of smaller Notes, p. 76 — Bullion held by Bank, p. 76 — Increase in Bullion held, p. 76 — Prop ortion of. Annual Average of Bullion and Annual Average of Banking Liabilities, p. 76 — Propor- tion of Bullion held to Deposits and Circulation, pp. 76-78 — Relation between Bullion held and Bank Rate, p. 76 — Table 9 : Showing composition of Bank of England Note Circulation, 1856-76, p. 77 — Strength of the Bank dependent on Proportion borne by Specie to Total Liabilities, p. 78 — Proportion smaller in 1900 than in 1894, p. 78 — — Separation of Issue Department from Banking Department ; some results of this, p. 78 — Silver Bullion formerly held by the Bank, p. 78 — Question as to desirability of the Bank again holding Silver Bullion in connection with low quotation for Indian Exchanges, p. 79 — Silver more distinctly "money" in Europe in 1844 than at present, p. 79 — Table 10 : Annual Averages of Silver Bullion held in Issue Department of Bank of England, and proportion of the same to the Gold Bullion and Coin held during the years 1844-53 and in 1860-61, p. 80 . . . . ^9-80 CHAPTER IX THE RESERVE AND THE LIABILITIES OF THE BANK OF ENGLAND Proportion of Specie to Liabilities at the Banks of France, Germany, Holland, and Belgium, pp. 81-84 — Table 11: Monthly Averages of Liabilities and Reserve of the Bank of England, 1845-1900, pp. 82-83 — Division of Bank of England Account into Issue Department and Banking Department, p. 84— Reserve of Notes represents greater xiv CONTENTS part of Specie at command of the Bank, p. 84 — Reserve of Bank smaller than Coin and Bullion held, p. 84— Fluctuations in the proportion of the Reserve to the Liabilities, pp. 84-85— Description of Table II, pp. 84-85 — Comparison of Table II with Table 12 (Monthly Averages of Minimum Rate of Discount at Bank of England) and with Table 37 and Table 38, p. 85 — Summary of proportion of Reserve to Liabilities between 1845- ■* 1900, p. 85 — Number of Variations in the Rate of Discount .between 1845-1900, p. 86 — Mean of the Extreme Variations between 1845 and 1900, p. 86— Years with greatest Fluctuations in the Rate, 1845-1900, p. 87 — Difference between Rate in Highest and Lowest Month and Mean of Extreme Variations, 1845-1900, p. 87 — Proportion of Reserve to Liabilities connected in general way with fluctuations in the Rate charged, p. 87 — Average Rate for each month during the fifty-six years, 1845-1900, p. 88 — Proportion of Reserve to Liabilities at three dates of sharp pressure, 1847, 1857, and 1866, p. 89— Act of 1844 only infringed in 1857, p. 89— Particulars of what occurred in these crises and also in 1890, pp. 89-90 — Low Bank Reserve accompanied by a High Rate of Interest, p. 90 — General Averages of the proportions of Reserve to Liabilities and of London Bankers' Balances to Reserve when rates specified were charged, 1844-78, p. 90 — Act to Indemnify Bank of England for excess issue over limit allowed in Bank Act, 1844, 1857, pp. 91-93 — Bill proposed by Lord Sherbrooke (Mr. Lowe) in 1873 to allow excess issue, pp. 93-94 . . . Pages 81-94 CHAPTER X VARIATIONS IN THE RATE CHARGED BY THE BANK OF ENGLAND FROM I 844-1 900 The Rate of Discount a valuable index to the fluctuations in the Money Market, p. 95 — Description of Table 12, pp. 95-96 — Description of Table 13, pp. 96-103 — This Table and Tables 12, 14, 37, and 38, giving details as to Rate charged, form chart showing course of market value of money, p. 96 — Great difference in the course of business between one year and another, "p. 96 — Variations in Rate in different years, pp. 96-101 — Table 12 : Monthly Averages of Minimum Rate of Discount of Bank of England, 1845-1900, p. 97 — Table 13 : Table of Changes in the Rate of Discount charged by the Bank of England, and the Number of Days at each Rate, in each year, 1844- 1900, pp. 98-99 — Table 14 : Bank of England Rates of Discount, 1844-1900. The number of days at each Rate arranged from the highest number to the smallest, and also from the lowest Rate to the highest, p. 100 — Facts shown in Table 13 brought together for reference in Table 14, p. loi — Summary of examination of Tables of Rates, pp. 101-103 — A Low Rate prevalent before 1854 ; High Rates more frequent latterly, p. I02 — Effect of Chinese-Japanese War indemnity (1895-96) on the value of money, p. 103 — The vast growth of loanable capital in the country renders it more difficult for the Bank to maintain the needed hold over the Market, pp. 103-104 — Deposits of Banks and amount of Reserve of Bank of England, p. 104 — The fluctuations in the Rates charged by the other Banks of Europe, p. 105 . . . . 95-105 CHAPTER XI SOME OF THE CAUSES WHICH INFLUENCE THE RATE OF INTEREST CHARGED BY THE BANK OF ENGLAND Relation between the Reserve of the Bank of England and the current Rate of Interest, p. 106 — Tendency towards lower rates for money during the last thirty-six years, p. 106 — Average Rates for groups of years, 1845-54, 1895-1900, pp. 106-107 — Influence of the different seasons of the year on the Fluctuations of the Rate and on business generally, p. 107 — Business activity at certain seasons of the year, p. 107 — Periodic increases of Scotch circulation, p. 107 — Particulars of Scotch circulation in May, June, October, November, and December for 1897-1900, pp. 107-109 — The most important causes of increased Scotch Note Issues in May and November, p. 109 — Reference to monthly fluctuations in the Rate at Banks of France, Germany, Holland, and Belgium, p. no — Connection between demands made on account of Irish and Scotch Note Circulation and the Liabilities and Reserve of the Bank, p. 1 10 — Mr. Weguelin (1856) on the influence of the Scotch and Irish Circulation on the Bank of England Reserve, p. no . 106-111 CONTENTS XV CHAPTER XII THE SCOTCH AND IRISH NOTE CIRCULATION Fluctuations in the Irish and Scotch Note Circulation, and connection between this and the Bank of England Reserve, p. 112 — Increase of Scotch and Irish Note Circulation since 1845, p. 1 12 — Table 17 arranged to show the influence of the circulation on the Reserve of the Bank, pp. 112-113 — Dr. Charles Gairdner on the principle by which the holding of specie is regulated, pp. 1 13-1 15 — The Reserve of the Bank of England the only source from which to draw specie, p. 115 — The specie held not a special security, but an asset against general liabilities, p. 115 — Fixed Issues of the Scotch Banks, 1845-1900, p. 1 15 — Fixed Issues of the Irish Banks, 1845-1900, p. 115 — Summary Tables, Scotch and Irish Note Circulation and Specie held, p. 116 — Clauses of the Bank Act of 1845 which regulate the holding of specie against the excess Issue in Ireland and Scotland, pp. 1 i6-i 17 — Table 15 : Monthly Averages of Note Circulation and of Gold and Silver Coin held in Scotland from 1845-1900, pp. 1 18-120 — Table 16: Monthly Averages of Note Circula- tion and of Gold and Silver Coin held in Ireland from 1845-1900, pp. 121-123 — Table 17 : Monthly Averages of Rate of Discount at the Bank of England and of Note Circu- lation and Gold and Silver Coin held in Scotland and Ireland, 1845-1900, pp. 124-131 Paffes 112-131 CHAPTER XIII RETURNS OF THE LONDON BANKERS' CLEARING HOUSE The Returns of the London Bankers' Clearing House a source of information as to business activity in the country, p. 132 — Table 18 : Monthly Averages of London Bankers' Clearing House Returns, 1868-1900, p. 133 — Comparison of Monthly Averages and Annual Averages, p. 134 — Variations of Turnover of Clearing House have diminished, while those of the Rate of Discount have increased, p. 134 — Totals for 1868-igoo, p. 134 — Fluctuations in the Clearing House Returns show no correspon- dence with those of the Rate at the Bank of England, p. 135 — Months of Highest Rates at the Banks of England, France, Germany, Holland, and Belgium, compared with Clearing" House Returns, pp. 135-136 — Months of Maximum Note Circulation in Scotland and Ireland, p. 136 — Transactions of the Clearing House earlier than 1868, p. 136 — Table 19: Exports and Imports, Clearing House Returns, and total Bank Note Circulation, years 1861, 1871, 1881, 1891, and 1900; p. 137 . . . 132-137 CHAPTER XIV THE AUTUMNAL DRAIN The Autumnal Drain takes its origin from the requirements of the season, p. 138 — Table 20 : Statement showing the Autumnal Movements in Gold and Silver Coin held by the Bank of England, 1881-1900, p. 138 — Influence of the Bank Acts of 1844-5 on the Autumnal Drain, p. 139 — Gold taken from the Reserve of the Bank of England as basis of Note circulation in Scotland and Ireland, p. 139— Examples of this and large proportion of amount drawn from Bank during the Autumnal Drain on account of re- quirements of Acts of 1844-S, p. 139 — Effect of this movement on the Bank Rate, p. 139 138-139 CHAPTER XV VARIATIONS IN THE RATE CHARGED BY THE BANK OF FRANCE FROM 1844-I9OO Reasons for selecting 1844 as the starting-point of these investigations, p. 140— Organisa- tion of Bank of France, pp. 141-143 — Table 21 : Monthly Averages of Minimum Rate of Discount of Bank of France from 1845-1900, p. 142— Number of Branches, p. 143 —Description of the business of the Bank of France, pp. 143-148— Table 22 : Changes in the Rate of Discount charged by the Bank of France, and the number of days at xvi CONTENTS each Rate in each year, 1844-1900, pp. 144-145 — Table 23 : Bank of France Rate of Discount, 1844-1900. The number of days at each Rate, arranged from the highest number to the smallest, and from the lowest rate to the highest, p. 146 — Management of the Business in times of difficulty, p. 148 — Assistance given to England during the Baring Crisis, p. 148 — Other Banks in France, pp. 148-149 — Difference between Banking in England and in France, pp. 148-149 — Difference between number and extent of varia- tions in the Rate in England and in France, pp. 150-151 — Comparisons from 1890-1900, p. 151 — Comparison of Rates in years 1847, 1857, 1866, and 1890, p. 152 — Reserve in the Precious Metals at the Bank of France, p. 152 — Table 24: Gold and Silver held by the Bank of France, 1877-1900, p. 153 . . . . Pages 140-153 CHAPTER XVI VARIATIONS IN THE RATE CHARGED BY THE IMPERIAL BANK OF GERMANY FROM 1844-I9OO Origin of the Bank of Germany, p. 155 — Table 25 : Monthly Averages of Minimum Rate of Discount of the Bank of Germany, 1845- 1900, p. 156 — Table 26 : Changes in the Rate of Discount charged by the Bank of Germany, and the number of days at each Rate in each year, 1844-1900, p. 157 — The Bank of Germany, like the Bank of France, under the con- trol of the State, p. 158 — Table 27 : Bank of Germany Rate of Discount, 1844-1900. The number of days at each Rate, arranged from the highest number to the smallest, and from the lowest Rate to the highest, p. 158— German Bank Acts of 1875 and 1899, pp. 158-159 — Supervision and Direction of the Bank of Germany, p. 159 — The supreme control over the Bank exercised by the Chancellor of the Empire, p. 159 — Number of Branches, p. 160 — Number of alterations in the Rate of Discount compared with England and France, p. 160 — Disturbances caused by Gold Currency introduced into Germany in 1872, p. 160 — Banking more developed in Germany than in France, p. 160 —Other Banks in Germany, p. 160 — Business carried on by the Bank of Germany com- pared with that carried on by the Bank of France and by the Bank of England, p. 160 — Comparison of Bills discounted in France and Germany, pp. 160-161 — Business of the Bank of Germany in Current Accounts (Giro-Verkehr), and transmitting money from one part of the country to another, p. 161 — Note Circulation, pp. 162-166 — Limit of the authorised Note Issue, pp. 162-163 — Tax on the Excess Issue, p. 163 — Differ- ence between this system and the system in England, p. 163 — Dangers of the English system observed by German Legislators, p. 163 — Diflferent place taken in business matters by the Note Circulation in Germany to that taken by the Note Circulation in England, pp. 163-164 — Development of the Note Circulation, p. 164 — Further comparison of Note Issues in Germany and England, p. 166 — Three Limitations on the Note Issue of the Bank of Germany, (i) the Legal Limit, (2) the tax of 5 per cent, on the excess issue, (3) the requirement that one-third of the issue should be held in cash, p. 166 — Discount of Bills by Bank of Germany, p. 166 — Foreign Bills held, p. 167 — Pro- portion of these on England, p. 167 — Inland and Foreign Bills held by Bank, p. 167 — Fluidity of Securities held by Bank, p. 167 — Specie held by the Bank, p. 168 — Table 28 : Coin and Bullion, 1876-1900, p. 168 — Table 29 : Annual Averages of Note Circulation, 1876-1900, p. 169 — Occasions when the Note Issue exceeded the Legal Limit, the Dates of these, and the Duty on the Excess, pp. 169-171 — Rate at the Bank of Germany compared with the Banks of England, France, Holland, and Belgium, p. 171 — Tax on Excess Issues, p. 172 — Proposal to adopt in England an arrangement similar to that in Germany as to exceeding authorised circulation, p. 172 — Bill brought forward by Lord Sherbrooke in 1873, p. 172— Injurious effect of High Rates of Interest on Trade, p. 173 ...... 154-173 CHAPTER XVn VARIATIONS IN THE RATE CHARGED BY THE BANK OF HOLLAND FROM 1844-I900 History of Bank of Holland, pp. 174-175— President and Secretary appointed by the Crown, p. 174— System of Management, p. 175— Branch (Rotterdam), Agencies, and Corres- pondents, p. 175— Business of Bank of Holland, pp. 175-176— Law of 7th August, 1888, CONTENTS xvii allows the Bank to buy Bills payable abroad, p. 176— Capital and Reserve, p. 176— Bill passed (1884) to Protect Stock of Gold, p. 176— Holland regards it a duty of the Govern- ment to endeavour to prevent the Standard of Value which it imposes on its subjects from fluctuating, p. 177— The Bank of Holland principally a Bank of Discount, p. 177— Rate of Discount at Bank of Holland lower than at any other of the great Banks of Europe, P- 177 — Variations in the Rate of Discount compared with those at other European Banks, p. 177 — Table 30: Monthly Averages of Minimum Rate of Discount of Bank of Holland from 1845-1900, p. 178— Table 31 : Changes in the Rate of Discount charged by the Bank of Holland and the number of days at each Rate in each year, 1844-1900, p. 179— Table 32: Bank of Holland, Rate of Discount, 1844-1900. The number of days at each Rate, arranged from the highest number to the smallest, and arranged from the lowest rate to the highest, p. 180 . . . Pages 174-180 CHAPTER XVIII VARIATIONS IN THE RATE CHARGED BY THE BANK OF BELGIUM FROM 1851-I90O Direction of Bank of Belgium, pp. 181-182— Governor and Deputy-Governor appointed by the King, pp. 181-182 — Branch (Antwerp) and Discount Offices, pp. 182-183 — Business of Bank in Commercial Paper and Bills, pp. 182-183 — The Country Discount Offices Private Partnerships, responsible for the business they carry on, p. 183— Fluctuations in the Rate of Discount compared with those at the Banks of Holland and France, p. 184 — Specie Reserve of Bank of Belgium comparatively small, p. 184 — Bills Discounted, p. 185 — Large Proportion of Bills on other Countries held, p. 185 — Average Note Circulation, p. 185 — Rate of Discount compared with that at Banks of England, France, Germany, and Holland, pp. 185-186 — Large Proportion of Days at Low Rates, pp. 185-186 — Comparatively small number of Fluctuations in Rate, p. 186 — Table 33 : Monthly Averages of Minimum Rate of Discount of Bank of Belgium from 1851-igoo, p. 187 — Table 34 : Changes in the Rate of Discount charged by Bank of Belgium and the number of days at each Rate in each year, 1851-1900, p. 188 — Table 35 : Bank of Belgium Rate of Discount, 1851-1900. The number of days at each Rate arranged from the highest number to the smallest, and arranged from the lowest rate to the highest, p. 189 . . . . . . . 181-189 CHAPTER XIX THE FLUCTUATIONS IN THE RATE OF THE BANK OF ENGLAND COMPARED WITH OTHER BUSINESS FLUCTUATIONS Fluctuations of the Rate at Bank of England, severity of these compared with the fluctua- tions at Banks of France, Germany, Holland and Belgium, pp. 191-194 — Table 36 : Summary of Fluctuations, Rates of Discount, Banks of England, France, Germany, Hol- land, and Belgium, Note Circulation Bank of England, Bullion in Issue Department, Liabilities and Reserve, English Country Note Circulation, London Bankers' Clearing HouseReturns, Scotch and Irish Note Circulation, and Specie held, 1845-1900, pp. 192-193 — Fluctuations in London Bankers' Clearing House Returns, p. 194— Bank of England Note and English Country Note Circulation, p. 194 — Scotch and Irish Note Circulation, Fluctuations compared with Bank Rate, p. 194 — Causes which lead to Severity of Fluctuations in England, p. 195 — Table 37: Number of variations in Rates of Discount of Banks of England, France, Germany, Holland, Belgium, 1844-igoo, p. 196 — Table 38 : Lowest and Highest Rate charged, and extent of Fluctuation of the same Banks during each year from 1844 to 1900, p. 197 — Table 39: Number and extent of Annual Fluctua- tions in Rate of the same Banks from 1844 to igoo grouped together, so as to show the extent of the Fluctuations and the number of years in which these Fluctuations occurred, p. 198 — Demands on Reserve of Bank of England, p. 198 — Division of Issue Depart- ment and Banking Department separates the resources of the Bank into two parts, and causes demand to fall on the smaller, p. 198 — Regulations of Act of 1844 compel purchase of Standard Gold whether needed or not, p. 199 — This may lead at times to unnecessary accumulation of Specie and consequent Low Rates, p. 199 — Deficiency of Fluidity in Securities of Bank of England, p. 199 — Bills Discounted and Short b xviii CONTENTS Loans at the Bank of England, p. 199— Influence of Bank of England over Market formerly greater than now, p. 199 — Balance Sheet of Bank of England compared with those of the other Banks, p. 200 — Capital of Bank of England compared with those of the other Banks mentioned, p. 200 — Investments of the Banks compared, p. 201 — Arrangements which assist other Banks to avoid the Fluctuations in Rate of Discount and the constant changes occurring at Bank of England, p. 202 . . Pages 190-202 CHAPTER XX SOME REMARKS ON THE RATE OF DISCOUNT OF THE BANKS OF ENGLAND, FRANCE, GERMANY, HOLLAND, AND BELGIUM Some remarks on the Rate of Discount of Banks of England, France, Germany, Holland, and Belgium. Number of days at each rate compared, pp. 203-210 — Table 40: Balance Sheets of Banks of England, France, Germany, Holland, and Belgium compared, pp. 206-207 — For last twenty-five years the Rate lower in Paris than in London, p. 209 — Table 41 : Rate of Discount of Banks of England, France, Germany, and Holland, 1844-1900, and Belgium, 1851-1900. Number of days at each rate arranged from lowest rate to highest, and proportion per millt at each Rate, p. 209 — Tendency to greater Variations and number of Fluctuations to be expected, p. 210 — Foreign money in England and English capital abroad, pp. 210-212 — Table 42: Average Minimum Rate of Discount charged by Banks of England, France, Germany, and Holland for years 1845-1900, and Belgium for years 1851-1900, showing average for the groups of years and for the whole period, p. 210 — Table 43: Years in which no change took place in the Rate of Discount of Banks of England, France, Germany, Holland, and Belgium, 1844-1900, p. 211 — Bonds of Foreign Governments frequently held in England, p. 212 — Foreign Bills scarcely held, p. 212 — Arrangements by which Foreign Banks meet demands arising from adverse exchanges, p. 212 — Demand for Gold for Export, pp. 212-213 — Om^ Exports and Imports compared, pp. 213-214 — Table 44: Foreign Trade of United Kingdom (1861-1900), Imports and Exports, and London Clearing House Returns (totals at intervals of ten years), p. 213 — Need of a strong Bullion Reserve, p. 215 — Advantages of London Money Market being the point where many monetary transactions are carried on, and that this country is so largely the Clearing House of the World, p. 215 — Disadvantages to business in this country of sudden and great Fluctuations in Rate of Discount, p. 216 — Supply of Loanable Capital at moderate rates important to Trade, p. 216 — Table 45: Average Monthly Discount Rate, with proportion of each month to Annual Average Rate, 1845-1900, at Banks of England, France, Germany, and Holland, Belgium 1851-1900, and London Bankers' Clearing House Returns 1868-1900, p. 216 . . 203-216 CHAPTER XXI CONCLUSION Fluctuations observed at certain periods in Bankers' Balances when these were made public, p. 217— Reasons for these, pp. 217-218— Great increase of Banking business in the United Kingdom, p. 218— Relation of Reserve to Current Rate of Interest charged, p. 218 —Influence of the Foreign Exchanges on Bank Rate, p. 219— Influence of Bank of England on the Money Market, p. 219— Relation of proportion of Reserve to Liabilities, influence of this and of demands on Reserve connected with Scotch and Irish Note Circulation on Rate of Interest charged, p. 219 — Increase of Money in the country between 1851 and 1900 and of Banking Deposits, pp. 219-220— Estimate of Banking Deposits at present time, p. 220— Increase of Specie Reserves of Banks, p. 220— Increase of Securities in Issue Department of Bank of England caused by operation of Bank Act of 1844, p. 220— Clauses of Act of 1844 sanctioning this, pp. 221-222— The composition of the Reserve of Bank may be thus altered, p. 223— Example of this, p. 224— Competition in business between this country and other countries now greater than ever before, p. 225— More powerful means of meeting demands on Specie Reserve needed, p. 225— Greater stability desirable for Money Market of this country, p. 225— Need of Agreement between Banks as to a sufficient Specie Reserve, pp. 225-226 . 217-226 LIST OF TABLES TABLE 1. PAGE Weekly Statement of the Liabilities and Assets of the Bank of England, with full details, 7th September, 1844, and ist January, 1848 . , ... 2-3 TABLE 2. An Account of Bank Notes of the Bank of England held by the Public, and of Bank Notes of the Bank of England held in Reserve by the Bank of England ; also, of the Rates of Exchange between London, Paris, Hamburgh, and Amsterdam ; also, of the Total Amount of BuUion ; also, of the Minimum Rate of Interest charged by the Bank of England ; also, of the Total Amount of Bills Discounted ; also, of the Total Amount of Temporary Advances ; also, of the Total Amount of Deposits, including the Balances on the account of the Exchequer, and the Balances held on account of the London Bankers from the last day of each week from the 7th September, 1844, to the latest date of the year, both Days inclusive . . . ... 4-5 TABLE 3. Annual Averages of the Transactions of the Bank of England for the Years 1 844- 1 goo 11-15 TABLE 4- Annual Averages of Bank Rate and of Market Rate High-Class Bills for the years 1845-1900, showing when the Market Rate was above or below the Bank Rate . . 33 TABLE 5. Annual Averages of London Bankers' Balances with the Bank of England, 1S44-1877 . 35 TABLE 6. Monthly Averages of Note Circulation of Bank of England, from 1845-1900, in groups of Ten Years, 1845-54, 1855-64, 1865-74, 1875-84, 1885-94, and of Six Years, 1895-1900, with Summary Table, 1845-1900 . . . . . 70 TABLE 7- Monthly Averages of Bullion in the Issue Department of the Bank of England, firom 1845-1900, divided into groups of Ten Years, 1845-54, 1855-64, 1865-74, 1875-84, 1885-94, and of Six Years, 1895-1900, with Summary Table, 1845-1900 . . 71 TABLE 8. Monthly Averages of Country Note Circulation, England, from 1845-1900, in groups of Ten Years, 1845-54, 1855-64, 1865-74, 1875-84, 1885-94, and of Six Years, 1895-1900, with Summary Table, 1845-1900. . . . • • • 75 XX LIST OF TABLES TABLE 9. PAGE Table showing Composition of Bank of England Note Circulation. Divided according to the Denomination of the Notes in Hands of the Public from 1856 to 1876, the latest date to which this information can be given . . . . . 77 TABLE 10. Silver Bullion held by the Bank of England 1844-53, 1860-61. Annual Averages of Silver Bullion held in the Issue Department of the Bank of England and Proportion of the Same to the Gold Bullion and Coin held during the Years 1844-53 ^-nd 1860-61 . 80 TABLE II. Monthly Averages of Liabilities and Reserve of the Bank of England, 1845-1900, in groups of Ten Years, 1845-54, 1855-64, 1865-74, 1875-84, 1885-94, and of Six Years, 1895-1900, with Summary Table, 1845-igoo . . . . 82-83 TABLE 12. Monthly Averages of Minimum Rate of Discount of Bank of England 1845-1900, in groups of Ten Years, 1845-54, 1855-64, 1865-74, 1875-84, 1885-94, and of Six Years, 1895-1900, with Summary Table, 1845-1900 . . . . • • 97 TABLE 13. Changes in the Rate of Discount charged by the Bank of England, and the Number of Days at each Rate in each Year, since 5th September, 1844 (when the Bank Act came into operation), to 31st December, 1900 . . . . . 98-99 TABLE 14. Bank of England — Rate of Discount — 1844-1900. The Number of Days at each Rate, arranged from the highest number to the smallest, and the Number of Days at each Rate, arranged from the lowest rate to the highest . . . . . 100 TABLE 15. Monthly Averages of Note Circulation and of Gold and Silver Coin held in Scotland, 1845-1900, in groups of Ten Years, 1845-54, 1855-64, 1865-74, 1875-84, 1885-94, and of Six Years, 1895-1900, with Summary Table, 1845-1900. (The returns of the specie held commence in 1846) ...... 1 18-120 TABLE 16. Monthly Averages of Note Circulation and of Gold and Silver Coin held in Ireland, 1845-1900, in Groups of Ten Years, 1845-54, 1855-64, 1865-74, 1875-84, 1885-94, and of Six Years, 1895- 1900, with Summary Table, 1845-1900. (The returns of the specie held commence in 1846) ...... 121-123 TABLE 17. Monthly Averages of Rate of Discount at the Bank of England, and of Note Circulation, and of Gold and Silver Coin held, in Scotland and in Ireland, 1845-1900, in groups of Ten Years, 1845-54, 1855-64, 1865-74, 1875-84, 1885-94, and of Six Years, 1895-1900, with Summary Table, 1845-1900, arranged from the smallest to the largest figures. (The returns of the specie held both in Scotland and Ireland commence with the year 1846) ....... 124-131 TABLE 18. Monthly Averages of London Bankers' Clearing House Returns 1 868-1 900, in groups of Seven Years, 1868-74 5 Ten Years, 1875-84 ; Ten Years, 1885-94 i and Six Years, 1895-1900; with Summary Table, 1868-1900 . .... 133 LIST OF TABLES xxi TABLE 19. Exports and Imports of United Kingdom, Amounts passed through the London Bankers' "^^^^ Clearing House, and the Total Bank Note Circulation of all the Issuing Banks in the United Kingdom for the years 1861, 1871, 1881, 1891, and 1900 . . . 137 TABLE 20. Statement showing the Autumnal Movements in Gold and Silver Coin held by the Bank of England for the years 1881-1900— beginning of September to about the middle of November in each year . . . . ... 138 TABLE 21. Monthly Averages of Minimum Rate of Discount of Bank of France, 1845-1900, in groups of Ten Years, 1845-54, 1855-64, 1865-74, 1875-84, 1885-94, and of Six Years, 1 895- 1 900, with Summary Table, 1845- 1900 . . . . . 142 TABLE 22. Changes in the Rate of Discount charged by the Bank of France, and the Number of Days at Each Rate in Each Year, since the 5th September, 1844 (when the Bank Act came into operation in England), to 31st December, 1900 . . . 144-145 TABLE 23. Bank of France— Rate of Discount— 1844- 1900. The Number of Days at each Rate, arranged from the highest number to the smallest ; and the Number of Days at each Rate, arranged from the lowest rate to the highest . . . . . 146 TABLE 24. Gold and Silver held by the Bank of France, 1877-1900.— Alterations in amounts of Gold and Silver held from December 31st, 1877, to December 31st, 1900; the year 1877 is taken as the starting-point, being the earliest from which the Statement can be carried on continuously . . , . . . . ■ • '53 TABLE 25. Monthly Averages of Minimum Rate of Discount of Bank of Germany, 1845-1900, in groups of Ten Years, 1845-54, 1855-64, 1865-74, 1875-84, 1885-94, and of Six Years, 1895-1900, with Summary Table, 1845-1900 . . ... 156 TABLE 26. Changes in the Rate of Discount charged by the Bank of Germany, and the Number of Days at Each Rate in Each Year, from 5th September, 1844 (when the Bank Act came into operation in England), to 31st December, igoo . ... 157 TABLE 27. Imperial Bank of Germany — Rate of Discount — 1844-1900. The Number of Days at each Rate, arranged from the highest number to the smallest, and the Number of Days at each Rate, arranged from the lowest rate to the highest . . . . 158 TABLE 28. Imperial Bank of Germany. Coin and Bullion, 1876-1900 . ... 168 xxii LIST OF TABLES TABLE 29. Imperial Bank of Germany. Annual Averages of Note Circulation, 1876-1900 . . 169 TABLE 30. Monthly Averages of Minimum Rate of Discount of Bank of Holland, 1845-1900, in groups of Ten Years, 1845-54, 1855-64, 1865-74, 1875-84, 1885-94, and of Six Years, 1895-1900, with Summary Table, 1845-1900 . . • . . 178 TABLE 31. Changes in the Rate of Discount charged by Bank of Holland, and the Number of Days at each Rate in each Year, from September 5th, 1844, to December 31st, 1900 . 179 TABLE 32. Bank of Holland— Rate of Discount— 1844-1900. The Number of Days at each Rate, arranged from the highest number to the smallest, and the Number of Days at each Rate, arranged from the lowest rate to the highest . . . . . 180 TABLE 33. Monthly Averages of Minimum Rate of Discount of Bank of Belgium, 1851-1900, in groups of Four Years, 1851-54, and Ten Years, 1855-64, 1865-74, 1875-84, 1885-94, and of Six Years, 1895-1900, with Summary Table, 1851-1900 . • • 187 TABLE 34. Changes in the Rate of Discount charged by Bank of Belgium, and the Number of Days at each Rate, in each Year, from January ist, 1851, to December 31st, 1900 . . 188 TABLE 35. Bank of Belgium— Rate of Discount— 1851-1900. The Number of Days at each Rate, arranged from the highest number to the smallest, and the Number of Days at each Rate, arranged from the lowest rate to the highest . . ... 189 TABLE 36. Summary of Fluctuations, Rates of Discount, Banks of England, France, Germany, Holland, and Belgium, Note Circulation Bank of England, Bullion in Issue Department, Liabilities and Reserve, English Country Note Circulation, London Bankers' Clearing House Returns, Scotch and Irish Note Circulation, and Specie held, 1845-1900 . 192-193 TABLE 37. Number of Variations in Rates of Discount, Banks of England, France, Germany, Holland, 1844-1900, and Belgium, 1851-1900 . . ... 196 TABLE 38. Lowest and Highest Rate charged and Extent of Fluctuation during each year, Banks of England, France, Germany, Holland, 1844-1900, and Belgium, 1851-1900 . . 197 TABLE 39. Number and extent of Annual Fluctuations in Rate at the Banks of England, France, Germany, Holland, 1844-1900, and Belgium, 1851-1900, during each year, grouped together so as to show the extent of the fluctuations and the number of years in which these fluctuations occurred . . . ... 198 TABLE 40. Balance Sheets of the Banks of England, France, Germany, Holland, and Belgium 206-207 LIST OF TABLES xxiii TABLE 41. PAGE Rate of Discount, Banks of England, France, Germany, and Holland, 1844-igoo, and Belgium, 1851-igoo. The Number of Days at each Rate, arranged from the Lowest Rate to the Highest, and the Proportion per mille at each Rate . . . 209 TABLE 42. Average Minimum Rate of Discount charged by the Banks of England, France, Germany, and Holland for the years 1845-1900, and Belgium for the years 1851-1900, showing Average for the groups of ten years 1845-54 (Belgium, 1851-54), 1855-64, 1865-74, 1875-84, 1885-94, and for six years 1895-1900, and for the whole period, 1845-1900 (Belgium, 1851-1900) . . . . . ... 210 TABLE 43. Years in which no change took place in the Rate of Discount at the Banks of England, France, Germany, Holland, 1845-1900, and Belgium, 1851-1900 . . .211 TABLE 44. Foreign Trade of the United Kingdom, 1861-1900 (totals at intervals of ten years). Showing Excess of Imports over Exports . . . . . . 213 TABLE 45. Average Monthly Discount Rate, with proportion of each month to Average Annual Rate, 1845-1900, at Banks of England, France, Germany, and Holland, Belgium 1851-1900, and of monthly average to yearly average at London Bankers' Clearing House 1868-1900 . . . . . . ... 2l6 BANK RATE AND THE MONEY MARKET IN ENGLAND, FRANCE, GERMANY HOLLAND, AND BELGIUM, 1 844-1900 CHAPTER I INTRODUCTION Weekly Return of Bank of England con- tinually studied Important points in it omitted at present time ... Table I.— Weekly Statements of the Lia- bilities and Assets of the Bank of England, with full details, 7th Septem- ber, 1844, and 1st January, 1848 Table 2. — Example of Returns published by order of Houses of Parliament, up to twenty-five years ago, on which this Analysis of Accounts of Bank of England is based Greater publicity as to Accounts of Bank of England desirable 2-3 4-S More publicity given as to Accounts of other Banks now than formerly, less as to Bank of England . Note circulations of Bank of England, Scotch and Irish Banks influence Re- serve of Bank of England Important recent Events influencing Money Markets of Europe and America Analysis of Transactions of Banks of France, Germany, Holland, and Bel- gium included Rates of Discount at these Banks . Table 3. — Annual Aver^es of Transac- tions of the Bank of England for the years 1844-1900 . . . 11- IS The weekly return of the Bank of England is always care- fully studied as supplying much useful information on the position of the money market. The demands likely to be made on the " Reserve," and the proportion held by it to the " Liabilities," form the basis of most of those calculations which are continually being made by men engaged in business as to the probability of a rise or fall in the Bank rate of discount. The form in which the usual statement is made out supplies a great deal of information, but several very important points are left unnoticed. Thus, for example, no figures are now published of several details, the knowledge of which would be of great service to those engaged in business, as of the temporary advances made by the Bank or of the Bills discounted, or of the amount of the Balances kept by Bankers with the Bank both in London and in the Provinces. INTRODUCTION [CH. I As recently, however, as some twenty- five years ago, a great deal more information used to be given. Returns pub- lished from time to time by order of both Houses of Parlia- ment contained a great deal of information on the subject. Some of the earlier returns are very full of detail both as to the composition of the deposits of the Bank and the manner in which they were employed. So many years, however, have elapsed since even the most recent of them were published, that they are now quite matters of "ancient history," and are unknown to the present generation of business men. To explain their characters and the class of information which they give I therefore bring in examples of these, the first. Table i, being the details of the weekly statement of the Bank, on 7th September, 1844, the first return after the Act of 1844 came into operation, and the second, similar details for ist January, 1848. Both of these are taken from the Report from the Select (Secret) Committee on Commercial Distress, 1848, House of Commons, Appendix No. 8. TABLE I. Weekly Statement of the Liabilities and Assets of the Bank of England, with full details, 7th September, 1844, and ist January, 1848. Circulation — London Country 14,802,000 6,405,000 7TH September, 1844, £ Deposits, Public, viz. — Exchequer Account 2,198,000 For Payment of Dividends . 315,000 Savings Banks, etc. y)\,cxxi Other Public Accounts 617,000 Deposits, Private, viz. — Railways . . 30,000 London Bankers. 963,000 East India Co. . 636,000 Bank of Ireland, Royal Bank of Scotland, etc. . 175,000 Other Deposits . 5,631,000 Deposits at Branches 1,209,000 21,207,000 3,631,000 8,644,000 33,482,000 Public Securities — Advances on Ex- chequer Bills — Deficiency . Other Exchequer Bills Exchequer Bills purchased Stock and Annui- ties 870,000 311,000 12,821,000 Private Securities — Bills discounted — London Country East India Bonds City Bonds, etc. . Mortgage . Advances — Bills of Exchange Exchequer Bills, Stock, etc. Bullion 113,000 2,003,000 198,000 3,357,000 620,000 883,000 661,000 14,002,000 2,1 16,000 5,719.000 21,837,000 15,209,000 37,046,000 CH. l] EXAMPLES OF PUBLISHED RETURNS Circulation- London Country 12,592,000 6,138,000 Deposits, Public, viz. — Exchequer Account 8,157,000 For Payment of Dividends . 150,000 Savings Banks, etc. 15,000 Other PubUc Accounts 690,000 Deposits, Private, viz. — Railways . London Bankers. East India Co. . Bank of Ireland, Royal Bank of Scotland, etc. . Other Deposits 1ST January, 1848. 18,730,000 9,012,000 12,000 1,929,000 740,000 181,000 4,626,000 Deposits at Branches 1,035,000 8,523,000 36,265,000 Public Securities — £, £ Advances on Ex- chequer Bills — Deficiency . — Other Exchequei Bills — Exchequer Bills purchased 232,000 Stock and Annui- ties 10,279,000 10,511,000 Private Securities — Bills discounted — London 4,140,000 Country 3,960,000 8,100,000 East India Bonds 405,000 City Bonds, etc. . 3,999,000 Mortgage . 461,000 Advances — Bills of Exchange 2,529,000 Exchequer Bills, Stock, etc. 1,496,000 Bank of England, l^th January, 1848. 8,890,000 27,501,000 Bullion .... 12,404,000 39,905,000 M. MARSHALL, Chief Cashier. The return marked No. 6 in the Appendix to the Report from the Select (Secret) Committee on Commercial Distress, House of Commons, 1848, may also be cited, as it carries the statement back to the date when the Bank Act came into operation. This return is reprinted, and continued to December, 1856, in the Appendix (No. 13) to the Report from the Select Committee on the Bank Acts, House of Commons, 1857. Sub- sequent returns continue a consecutive statement, on a uniform plan, from the date of the division of the two departments of the Bank of England, in 1844, to the close of 1875, containing particulars which are not disclosed in the ordinary returns, of the amount of bills discounted, the amount of temporary advances made by the Bank, and the balances of the London bankers. The commencement of this Return, extending from August 31st to December 28th, 1844, is given in Table 2, pp. 4, 5. The return, however, which was ordered by the House of Commons to be printed 31st May, 1877, giving the statement for the year 1876, while it separates the amounts of the balances of the Exchequer and of the London bankers from INTRODUCTION [CH. I TABLE 2. Report from the Select (Secret) Committee on Commercial An Account of Bank Notes of the Bank of England held by the Public, and of Bank Rates of Exchange between London, Paris, Hamburgh, and Amsterdam ; also, of Bank of England ; also, of the Total Amount of Bills Discounted ; also, of the Total the Balances on the account of the Exchequer, and the Balances held on account of the latest date of the year, both days inclusive. Bank Notes. Rate of Exchange ; London on Held by the Public. Held in Reserve by the Bank of England. Paris 3 d/s. Hamburgh. Amsterdam. 1844. August 31 . 20,448,000 7,732.000 25 -471 13-IOi 12-3} September 7 . 20,176,000 8,175,000 25-45 13-lOf II 14 . 19,881,000 8,620,000 25 "45 I3-" »i 21 . 19,618,000 8,965,000 25 -474 13-111 II „ 28 . . 19,902,000 8,461,000 25 -521 II 12 -4i October 5 . 20,153,000 7,930.000 25-50 13-iiJ >l 12 . 20,228,000 7,610,000 25-524 i3-ioi 12-4 19 • 21,083,000 6,649,000 25-55 i3-iii »l ., 26 . . 21,321,000 6,225,000 25-57i 13-12 II November 2 . 20,820,000 6,679,000 J» 13-iii »l 9 ■ • 20,557,000 6,844,000 25-55 .1 12-31 16 . 20,581,000 6,927,000 ** 13-12 i2-4i 23 . 20,118,000 7,410,000 If 13-12! 12 -4i 30 • 19,842,000 7,944,000 25-57i II i2-5i December 7 . 19,531,000 8,286,000 25-60 13-iii I2-S 14 . 19,258,000 8,746,000 25-57i 11 12-41 21 . 19,192,000 8,960,000 .. i3-iii 12-si „ 28 . . 19,123,000 9,077,000 25-60 II 12-Si CH. l] EXAMPLES OF PUBLISHED RETURNS TABLE 2 (coniinutd). Distress, 1848, House of Commons, Appendix No. 6. Notes of the Bank of England held in Reserve by the Bank of England ; also, of the the Total Amount of Bullion ; also, of the Minimum Rate of Interest charged by the Amount of Temporary Advances ; also, of the Total Amount of Deposits, including the London Bankers from the last day of each week from the 7th September, 1844, to Total Amount of Bullion. Minimum Rate of Interest. Total Amount of Bills Discounted. Total Amount of Temporary Advances. Total Amount of Deposits, inclu- ding Exchequer and London Bankers. Balances held on account of the Exchequer and London Bankers included in the fore* going Column. £ 15,315,000 Per Cent. 4 £ 2,141,000 £ 252,000 £ 12,137,000 / 1,572,000 E. \ 1,480,000 B. 15,209,000 2i 2,116,000 252,000 12,275,000 (■2,198,000 E. \ 963,000 B. 15,198,000 2,137,000 602,000 12,892,000 (•2,976,000 E. \ 905,000 B. 15,159,000 2,162,000 1,193,000 13,805,000 (■3,981,000 E. \ 1,059,000 B. 15,022,000 2,193,000 2,165,000 14,297,000 /4,702,ooo E. ■\. 855,000 B. 14,702,000 2,259,000 2,814,000 14,427,000 r4,944>ooo E. \ 880,000 B. 14,445,000 2,310,000 2,792,000 16,378,000 / 946,000 E. \ 845,000 B. 14, 190,000 2,394,000 690,000 12,472,000 f 684,000 E. \ 1,071,000 B. 14,097,000 2,481,000 577,000 11,847,000 / 829,000 E. ■(. 801,000 B. 14,039,000 2,810,000 625,000 12,228,000 / 800,000 E. ■\. 1,214,000 B. 14,116,000 2,863,000 625,000 11,994,000 f 1,054,000 E. \ 1,046,000 B. 14,231,000 3,047,000 1,047,000 11,909,000 / 1,732,000 E. \ 797,000 B. 14,366,000 3,094,000 1,128,000 12,676,000 /2,7S3.ooo E. \ 847,000 B. 14,558,000 3,503,000 1,154,000 13,571,000 (■3,666,000 E. \ 1,068,000 B. 14,645,000 3,407,000 1,423,000 14,218,000 /4,405,ooo E. \ 1,041,000 B. 14,844,000 3,268,000 1,612,000 14,766,000 /5,093,ooo E. \ 869,000 B. 14,943,000 3,200,000 2,140,000 15,424,000 (-5,842,000 E. \ 874,000 B. 14,878,000 3,029,000 2,585,000 15,677,000 (■6,284,000 E. \ 984,000 B. 6 INTRODUCTION [ch. i the total deposits, does not continue to furnish either the amount of "bills discounted" or of the "temporary advances," which had been uniformly given from 1844 downwards in the previous returns. The corresponding return for 1877 is like- wise deficient in the same manner, and in the return for 1878 the London bankers' balances were altogether left out. Thus from that date down to the present time bankers are absolutely ignorant of matters which are of the very highest importance to them. Every bank knows, of course, its own balance, and occasionally the amount of that of one or two of its neighbours, but there is no general knowledge of the amount of the collective balances of the bankers standing to their credit at the Bank of England as a whole. These omissions are to be regretted, quite as much in the interest of the Bank of England itself as of the public at large. Discounting bills, and making temporary advances, are both proper functions of a bank. In the case of the Bank of England it is especially desirable that there should be no uncertainty as to the extent of its operation on these points, as it is mainly in this manner that its control over the outer market should be maintained. The full possession of that control, and the power of exercising it rapidly when circum- stances render it needful, are essential to the security both of the Bank of England and of the other banks of the country, and it cannot therefore be an unimportant matter that the information which shows the action of the Bank in this respect should now no longer be supplied. It would also be very valuable if the information given in return No. 8 in the Appendix to the Report from the Select (Secret) Committee on Commercial Distress, House of Commons, 1848, from which the details given in Table i, pp. 2, 3, are taken, were continued to the present time. This return, which is carried back to the year 1832, through the Appendix to the Report from Select Committees on Banks of Issue, House of Commons, 1840 and 1841, gives a great deal of very important information as to the working of the Bank of England. It is no spirit of idle curiosity, no desire to pry needlessly into the concerns of others, that seeks for this information. Those who feel, as all concerned in banking CH. I] BANKING INFORMATION FORMERLY GIVEN 7 business must, that the enormous extension which that business has experienced in this country during the last half-century requires every safeguard to be strengthened, must regret that a closer secrecy is now maintained on matters on which more publicity was freely given at previous times when this publicity was less needed. If that information was valuable in 1832, 1844, and 1848, it would be even more valuable now. Such information, however, as can be obtained from the materials at our command on the history of the working of the money market during the last fifty-six years may be very useful to all who are engaged in commercial pursuits. These years have witnessed a very marvellous extension of the business of the country in general ; and the extension of bank- ing generally has fully kept pace with the increase in other directions. It is now often scarcely remembered how recent any accurate information as to the details of banking is. When, in the year 1877, I commenced seeking to obtain this information, I remember being told that to collect it was impossible. No private banks at that time — and indeed for many years afterwards — published their accounts. Some even of the joint stock banks also did not publish their figures. These matters are managed in a different way at the present time. While, however, much more information is now given as to the position of banks in general, less, as has been men- tioned, is given as to that of the Bank of England. The Parliamentary returns formerly published relating to the Bank of England, which dissected its transactions week by week, have not been continued since 1878, and though, as men- tioned above, of late years they have given details less full than formerly, they contain the record of many important events. But the very length of these returns is a bar to facility in consulting them, or in understanding the many important lessons which may be learned from them. The number of details, through their very quantity, has a tendency to obscure a distinct view of the case. The old proverb expresses the truth exactly : " You cannot see the wood for the trees." It is hoped, therefore, that the analysis which follows may be of service by giving a history of the main alterations which have occurred in the position of the Bank of England during the 8 INTRODUCTION [cH. i time over which the Parliamentary returns extend. It has been continued to the end of the year 1900 by employing the weekly returns of the Bank. The whole statement will assist us to trace out some of the causes which have led to the greatly increased fluctuations which have prevailed in the money market during some of the last few years. It should be clearly understood from the outset that the object of this work is neither a controversial investigation into the working of the Act of 1844, nor a critical inquiry into the conduct of the Bank of England, Complete investigation into the working of that Act would require more space than could be allotted to the subject here, though it is hoped that the information given in these pages may be of service by showing some of the ways in which the Act of 1844 influences our business system, and bringing back to our remembrance some points in its working which are often overlooked. With regard to the Bank of England, that great institution is, from its position, the acknowledged centre of our banking system ; and an analysis of its transactions may enable us to see more clearly the progress of recent events in the financial world. To render this clear and readily intelligible, a series of tables has been drawn up. Into these the main points of the work of the Bank of England for the years from 1844 to 1900 have been con- densed. Through the arrangements of the Acts of 1844-5, for convenience spoken of as the Act of 1844 in this work, the note circulation of the United Kingdom is also connected with the working of the Reserve of the Bank of England. Every note of the Bank of England in the hands of the public means the abstraction of the value of that note from the Reserve of the Bank. This is equally true whether the note has been "issued" against gold which has been long in the coffers of the Bank or against fresh gold just received from abroad. The gold may remain in the Issue Department, but the Banking Reserve, which consists mainly of the notes in the Banking Department, is not strengthened. Every note issued in Scotland and Ireland, beyond the fixed limit of the circulation, has the same effect. The way in which this takes place is explained in Chapter VIII. p. 69 and Chapter XII. p. 112. Tables have hence been prepared showing the course CH. i] MODERN INFLUENCES ON MONEY MARKET 9 of the circulation of the notes of the Bank of England, of the English Provincial Banks, and of the Banks in Scotland and Ireland for the same period — from 1845 to 1900. This has been done with the utmost care, and it is hoped that any error of importance has been avoided. Since I first began to write on this subject, several events have occurred which have introduced very important influences among the money markets of Europe and America. The limitation in the coinage of silver by the countries forming the Latin Union ; the resumption of specie payments in France, and also in the United States ; the change in the standard of value in Germany from a silver to a gold basis ; the creation of a gold standard by Russia ; the official alteration in the par of exchange between this country and India ; the establish- ment of a currency system in that country, sometimes described as gold monometallism, sometimes as a bimetallic system ; the bimetallic system being on a different basis from that formerly prevailing — namely, on the ratio of i to 22 — the one previously in force in Europe having been on that of i to 15 approxi- mately ; the great development of banking in these countries — all are events which could not take place without greatly affecting this country. These events have made it desirable to carry the investigation further than was first proposed. It has not been thought needful to form a complete analysis of the transactions of the Banks of France, Germany, Holland, and Belgium, in the same manner as that of the transactions of the Bank of England. A comparison of the rates of interest charged in the five countries, and of the number of the fluctua- tions in the rates, gives a sufficient outline for the purpose desired — an outline of the working of the demand and supply of money in the leading countries of Europe for the time under consideration. Tables relating to the variations in the rate of interest charged by the Banks of France, Germany, Holland, and Belgium, drawn up on the same plan as the corresponding tables referring to the Bank of England, have therefore been added, and tables giving the number and extent of the altera- tions of the rates. These are valuable, as giving an outline of the working of business in those countries ; they also supply a 10 INTRODUCTION [ch. i comparative view of the movements of the rate of interest in other European centres of business which may enable us the better to understand the influences which are at work on our own. A list of the tables which form the basis of this analysis precedes this chapter. The table (marked Table 3, pp. 11 -15) analysing the accounts of the Bank of England in a series of annual averages follows. NOTE TO TABLE 3— Pages 11-15 The Annual Averages of "Notes Issued," as stated in the Weekly Returns of the Bank, are entered in col. i ; the Notes held in the Banking Department, in col. 7, p. Ii ; the Notes held by the Public are entered in col. 39, p. 15. The Notes issued at the Branches and held by the Public, and those issued in London and held by the Public, are entered in col. 35, p. 14 and col. 37, p. 15. These particulars are given up to the year 1881, when this information was discontinued. The Annual Averages of the Coin and Bullion held in the Issue Department are entered in col. 9, p. II. The Coin held in the Banking Department is added to this, and entered in col. 41, p. 15, containing the Total Bullion held by the Bank ; it is also entered, with the Notes held in the Banking Department, in col. 21, p. 13, which contains the Reserve of the Bank. It was notified on the publication of the Return of the Bank of England for the week ending Wednesday, January 8, 1873, that, with regard to the Deposits in the Return then issued, the practice was commenced of placing the Chancery Balances under the head of Government Deposits instead of under that of the ordinary Deposits of the public as hereto- fore. The average amount was about ;£'i,ooo,ooo, and to that extent, therefore, the respective totals have undergone transposition. This must be borne in mind in comparing the amounts of the Public and Private Deposits from 1844 to 1872, and from 1873 onwards (cols. 13 and IS, p. 12). During the years 1844-53 the Bank continually held some Silver Bullion, and also from November 28, i860, to July 3, 1861. This is included in the amounts given in col. 9, p. 11, and also in col. 41, p. 15, of this Table. The stock of Silver thus held is shown in Table 10, p. 80. Col. 43, p. 15. — Where the average of Bullion is more than the Liabilities, the figure is put in thick type, as 103, year 1844. Col. 44, p. 15. — Where the average of Total Bullion is more than the Circulation, the figure is put in thick type, as 104, year 1876. The date of the publication of the Weekly Returns was changed from the Saturday (Oct. 31st) to the Wednesday (Nov. 4th) in the year 1857. It has since been continued on the Wednesday. The reader must bear in mind that the figures of the yearly statements are annual averages, and hence do not show the numerous fluctuations in the course of each year, with the exception of col. 3, which shows the amount of the securities held in the Issue Department on Dec. 31 of each year. CH. i] ANNUAL AVERAGES, ACCOUNTS, BANK OF ENGLAND II TABLE 3. Annual Averages of the Transactions of the Bank of England for the Years 1844-1900. 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 Propor- Amount of Propor- tion of Propor- tion of Notes Issued against Securities Propor- tion of Notes Annual Proportion of Notes Annual Proportion of Annual tion of Securities Securities Average of held in Average of Coin and Year. Average of Notes Issued. Notes Issued to 1844. held in Issue Department in Issue Depart- ment Issued against Bullion Notes held in Banking Banking Depart- ment Coin and Bullion in Issue Bullion in Issue Department 1844=100. ^ on 31 Dec. in each year. to 1844. 1844=100. (Col. 3). (Col. 9). Department. to 1844. 1844=100. Department. to 1844. 1844=100. £ £. % % i. £, 1844 27,934,000 100 14,000,000 100 50 50 7,853,000 100 13.93S.000 100 1845 28,619,000 103 14,000,000 100 49 51 7,895,000 101 14,617,000 '05 1846 28,163,000 lOI 14,000,000 100 50 50 7,877,000 100 14,163,000 102 1847 23.765.000 ss 14,000,000 100 59 41 4,610,000 59 9,769,000 70 1848 27,196,000 97 14,000,000 100 52 48 9,108,000 116 13,196,000 95 1849 28,320,000 lOI 14,000,000 zoo 49 51 9,916,000 126 14,323.000 '03 1850 29,943,000 toy 14,000,000 100 47 53 10,545,000 '34 15,949,000 "4 1851 27,939,000 100 14,000,000 100 50 50 8,466,000 108 13,864,000 100 1852 34,079,000 123 14,000,000 100 41 59 12,222,000 'S6 20,077,000 144 1853 30,984,000 III 14,000,000 100 45 55 8,363,000 107 16,984,000 122 1854 27,303,000 98 14,000,000 100 51 49 6,594,000 83 13,304,000 96 1855 27,555,000 98 14,475,000 103 51 49 7,762,000 99 13,529,000 97 1856 24,783,000 89 14.475.000 103 58 42 5,135,000 ^P 10,306,000 74 1857 24,177,000 Sj 14,475,000 103 60 40 4,696,000 60 9,702,000 70 1858 31,604,000 i'3 14,475.000 103 46 54 11,190,000 '43 17,129,000 123 1859 31,709,000 114 14,475,000 '03 45 55 10,429,000 '33 17,272,000 124 1860 28,973,000 104. 14.475.000 103 50 60 7,702,000 98 14,498,000 ^°± 1861 26,737,000 96 14,650,000 104 54 46 6,717,000 86 12,199,000 88 1862 30,175,000 J08 14,650,000 104 48 52 9,330,000 119 15,525,000 111 1863 28,403,000 lOI 14,650,000 104 52 48 7,730,000 98 13,764,000 99 1864 27,412,000 98 14,650,000 104 53 47 6,849,000 87 12,771,000 92 1865 28,351,000 I02 14,650,000 104 52 48 7,263,000 93 13,709,000 , 99 1866 28,922,000 104 15,000,000 107 51 49 5,764,000 73 14,009,000 101 1867 35,249,000 126 15,000,000 107 43 57 11,592,000 148 20,246,000 '45 1868 34,649,000 124 15,000,000 107 43 67 10,727,000 136 19,662,000 141 1869 32,775,000 117 15,000,000 107 46 54 9,322,000 119 17,775,000 127 1870 34,877,000 i^S 15,000,000 107 43 57 11,564,000 '47 19,877,000 142 1871 37,880,000 136 15,000,000 107 40 60 13,470,000 172 22,880,000 164 1872 36,911,000 '3' 15,000,000 107 41 59 11,390,000 '43 21,898,000 '58 1873 36,887,000 132 15,000,000 107 41 59 11,220,000 '43 21,887,000 '58 1874 36,550,000 '3' 15,000,000 107 41 59 10,270,000 '3' 21,570,000 '55 1875 38,180,000 '37 15,000,000 107 39 61 10,834,000 '38 23,180,000 166 1876 42,870,000 '4S 15,000,000 107 35 66 15,137,000 '93 27,857,000 200 1877 39,530,000 142 15,000,000 107 38 62 11,635,000 148 24,530,000 176 1878 37,942,000 136 15,000,000 107 40 60 9,885,000 126 22,942,000 '65 1879 46,284,000 166 15,000,000 107 32 68 17,076,000 2l8 31,297,000 225 1880 41,661,000 149 15,000,000 107 36 64 14,748,000 188 26,662,000 191 1881 38,827,000 '39 15,750,000 112 40 60 12,678,000 161 23, 509,000 169 1882 36,791,000 132 15,750,000 112 43 57 10,826,000 '3S 21,043,000 '5' 1883 37,050,000 '33 15,750,000 112 42 68 11,522,000 '47 21,341,000 ^H 1884 37,751,000 '3S 15.750,000 112 42 58 12,373,000 'S8 21,991,000 '58 1885 38,722,000 '39 15.750,000 112 41 59 14,072,000 179 22,972,000 '65 1886 35,548,000 127 15,750,000 112 44 56 10,869,000 '3S 19,778,000 142 1887 36,377,000 '30 16,200,000 116 44 56 11,994,000 'S3 20,513,000 '50 1888 35.633.000 128 16,200,000 116 45 55 11,350,000 '4S 19.433.000 140 1889 36,661,000 '3' 16,450,000 117 45 55 12,279,000 '57 20,461,000 '47 1890 37,216,000 '33 16,450,000 117 44 56 12,629,000 161 20,800,000 ^ii 1891 39,838,000 '43 16,450,000 117 41 59 14,596,000 186 23,365,000 168 1892 40,743,000 I4() 16,450,000 117 40 60 14,914,000 190 24,281,000 '74 1893 41,068,000 '47 16,450,000 117 40 60 15,192,000 '93 24,618,000 '77 1894 48,689,000 '74 16,800,000 120 34 66 23,439,000 299 31,916,000 230 1895 53,191,000 190 16,800,000 120 32 68 27,312,000 348 36,387,000 262 1896 58,802,000 2IX 16,800,000 120 29 71 32,290,000 411 41,980,000 302 1897 50,005,000 '79 16,800,000 120 34 66 22,807,000 290 33,225,000 239 1898 48,049,000 172 16,800,000 120 35 65 20,602,000 263 31,242,000 224 1899 47,142,000 169 16,800,000 120 36 64 19,263,000 24s 30,342,000 218 1900 49,232,000 176 17,775,000 127 36 64 19,797.000 25' 31,663,000 228 INTRODUCTION [CH. TABLE 3 {continued). Annual Averages of the Transactions of the Bank of England for the Years 1844-1900. U 12 13 11 15 16 17 18 Annual Average Propor- Propor- Propor- Propor- Date. of Liabilities on Deposits (Public and Private), and Bank Post tion of Liabilities to 1844. 1844=100. Annual Average of Public Deposits. tion of Public Deposits to 1844. Annual Average of Private Deposits. tion of Private Deposits to 1844. Annual Average of Total Deposits. tion of Total Deposits to 1844. Bills. 1844=100. 1844 = 100. 1844=100. £. i. ;£ £ 1844 14,317,000 JOO 5,231,000 100 8,069,000 100 13,300,000 100 1845 16,367,000 114 5,665,000 108 9,643,000 120 15,308,000 IIS 1846 20,262,000 141 6,254,000 120 13,070,000 161 19,324,000 14s 1847 15,973,000 III 6,446,000 123 8,668,000 107 15,114,000 113 1848 15,963,000 III 5,154,000 99 9,809,000 122 14,963,000 112 1849 17,211,000 120 6,086,000 116 10,042,000 124 16,128,000 121 1850 18,822,000 131 7,772,000 '49 9,825,000 122 17,597,000 132 1851 17,638,000 123 7,128,000 136 9,351,000 116 16,479,000 124 1852 20,149,000 140 6,010,000 IIS 12,836,000 iss 18,846,000 141 1853 19,543,000 136 5,682,000 109 13,482,000 167 19,164,000 143 1864 15,740,000 tio 3,641,000 70 11,016,000 136 14,657,000 no 1855 17,698,000 134 5,005,000 96 11,711,000 14s 16,716,000 126 1856 16,864,000 117 4,840,000 93 11,183,000 139 16,023,000 120 1857 17,828,000 124 6,380,000 122 10,677,000 133 17,057,000 128 1868 20,847,000 14s 5,884,000 113 14,139,000 17s 20,023,000 ISO 1859 22,530,000 137 7,319,000 140 14,393,000 178 21,712,000 163 1860 20,893,000 '43 6,646,000 127 13,518,000 167 20,164,000 iSi 1861 18,481,000 129 5,281,000 lOI 12,530,000 ISS 17,811,000 134 1862 22,414,000 'S(> 7,052,000 13s 14,642,000 181 21,694,000 163 1863 21,946,000 IS3 7,327,000 140 13.975.000 173 21,302,000 160 1864 20,600,000 144 6,870,000 132 13,199,000 104 20,069,000 ISO 1865 21,200,000 148 6,707,000 128 14,000,000 173 20,707,000 ISS 1866 22,603,000 iss 5,318,000 102 16,746,000 207 22,064,000 i(>S 1867 26, 106,000 182 6,812,000 130 18,790,000 233 25,602,000 192 1868 25,619,000 179 4,906,000 94 20,169,000 230 25,075,000 188 1869 23,713,000 lbs 5,129,000 98 18,087,000 224 23,216,000 174 1870 26,358,000 184 7,635,000 146 18,100,000 224 25.735.000 193 1871 29,022,000 202 7,071,000 135 21,322,000 264 28,393,000 213 1872 29,268,000 204 8,875,000 169 19,986,000 248 28,861,000 2l6 1873 28,900,000 202 9,422,000 180 19,073,000 236 28,495,000 214 1874 25,476,000 I7S 6,251,000 120 18,847,000 233 25,098,000 189 1875 26,749,000 187 5,223,000 99 21,190,000 263 26,413,000 19S 1876 30,616,000 214 6,793,000 130 23.493.000 291 30,286,000 228 1877 28,771,000 201 5,838,000 112 22,574,000 279 28,4W,ooo 213 1878 29,077,000 203 5,560,000 106 23,229,000 287 28,789,000 216 1879 36,975,000 2S5 6,024,000 IIS 30,624,000 379 36,672,000 27s 1880 33,297,000 232 7,861,000 ISO 26, 138,000 323 32,950,000 247 1881 31,954,000 220 7,470,000 143 25,235,000 312 31,519,000 237 1882 29,970,000 237 5,660,000 108 23,606,000 292 29,740,000 223 1883 29,980,000 207 6,924,000 132 23,610,000 292 29,783,000 223 1884 31,450,000 217 7,288,000 139 23,984,000 296 31,271,000 234 1885 33,626,000 232 6,196,000 Its 26,617,000 330 33,451,000 251 1886 29,352,000 202 4,983.000 95 24,001,000 297 29,177,000 219 1887 29,581,000 204 S.377,000 103 24,000,000 297 29,402,000 221 1888 31,141,000 214 6,443,000 122 24,508,000 303 30,951,000 232 1889 32,742,000 229 7,179,000 137 25,362,000 313 32,714,000 246 1890 33,574,000 231 5,840,000 112 27,526,000 341 33,364,000 2S0 1891 38,220,000 263 6,610,000 126 31,414,000 389 38,025,000 286 1892 36,449,000 2J0 5,856,000 112 30,282,000 374 36,266,000 27a 1893 36,209,000 272 5,697,000 109 30,334,000 37S 36,030,000 270 1894 41,105,000 283 6,969,000 133 33,628,000 416 40,943,000 307 1895 48,320,000 332 7,601,000 14s 40,585,000 S02 48,186,000 361 1896 59,948,000 4'3 10,418,000 199 49>390,ooo 611 59,808,000 449 1897 49,974,000 344 9,982,000 191 39.83S.000 493 49,818,000 374 1898 49,902,000 344 10,501,000 201 39,286,000 4SS 49,785,000 374 1899 49,722,000 343 10,042,000 191 39,511,000 490 49,571,000 372 1900 50,049,000 34S 9,285,000 178 40,602,000 S03 49,887,000 374 CH. i] ANNUAL AVERAGES, ACCOUNTS, BANK OF ENGLAND 13 TABLE 3 {candnued). Annual Averages of the Transactions of the Bank of England for the Years 1844-1900. 19 20 sa 22 23 24 25 26 27 Annual Average London Bankers' Balances inclu- ded in Private Deposits(Col. 6). Propor- tion of London Bankers' Balances to 1844. x844=xoo. Annual Average Reserve of Bank of England (Notes & Specie). Propor- tion of Reserve to 1844. 1844=100. Propor- tion Res. toLiabili- ties on Deposits and Bank PostBills. Propor- tion Res. to Liabili- ties, De- ducting Bankers' Balances, Propor- tion of London Bankers' Balances to Res. Annual Average of "Other" Securities in Banking Depart- ment. Propor- tion of other Securities to 1844. 1844 = 100 Date. £ £. % X % £ 977,000 700 8,500,000 100 59 56 11 9,472,000 100 1844 1,256,000 I2S 8,516,000 too 52 48 15 12,215,000 129 1846 1,558,000 160 8,539,000 100 42 37 18 16,661,000 176 184S 1,467,000 ISO 5,291,000 62 33 26 27 17,241,000 182 1847 2.3S9.000 241 9,784,000 "S 61 54 24 11,967,000 126 1848 2,131,000 3l8 10,694,000 126 62 57 20 10,222,000 108 1840 1,656,000 170 11,219,000 132 69 55 15 11,048,000 116 1850 1,666,000 170 9,103,000 107 62 46 18 12,642,000 133 1851 3,184,000 326 12,764,000 ISO 63 66 25 11,398,000 120 1852 2,259,000 231 8,907,000 103 46 38 25 15,086,000 'S9 1853 2,692,000 S7S 7,290,000 86 46 35 37 14,732,000 iSS 1854 3,065,000 3'3 8,366,000 98 47 36 37 15,316,000 162 1855 3,032,000 sro 5,772,000 68 34 19 52 17,067,000 180 1856 3,274,000 33S 5,347,000 63 30 14 61 20,392,000 21S 1857 4,639,000 47S 12,037,000 141 58 45 39 16,316,000 172 1858 4,256,000 43^ 11,076,000 129 49 37 39 18,196,000 192 1859 4,283,000 43S 8,451,000 99 40 25 51 20,511,000 216 1860 4,185,000 ^8 7,611,000 h 41 24 55 18,738,000 198 1861 5,030,000 SrS 10,194,000 t20 45 29 45 18,987,000 200 1862 4,726,000 484 8,536,000 100 39 22 65 20,176,000 212 1863 4,899,000 SOB 7,478,000 88 36 16 66 20,296,000 214 1864 5,038,000 $13 8,089,000 95 38 19 63 20,568,000 2t7 1885 6,259,000 641 6,745,000 79 30 3 93 22,962,000 242 1866 6,689,000 68s 12,906,000 IS2 49 32 52 18,235,000 "li 1867 6,801,000 696 11,903,000 140 46 27 57 17,647,000 186 1868 6,479,000 M,3 10,320,000 121 43 22 62 16,822,000 178 1869 6,618,000 678 12,435,000 146 47 29 53 18,622,000 197 1870 8,390,000 8S9 14,162,000 166 48 28 69 18,803,000 198 1871 7,609,000 778 12, 122,000 141 41 21 63 21,466,000 226 1872 8,586,000 878 12,051,000 141 41 17 71 21,643,000 229 1873 8,341,000 SS4 11,035,000 129 43 15 75 18,487,000 '9S 1874 10,324,000 11,851,000 'OSS 11,597,000 136 43 6 89 19,163,000 202 1875 1212 15,962,000 187 62 22 74 17,502,000 'Ss 1876 9,543,000 976 12,478,000 146 43 15 77 18,861,000 200 1877 10,879,000 127 37 — — 20,424,000 2'S 1878 — 18,262,000 HIS 49 — — 20,836,000 220 1879 15,997,000 188 48 — — 19,161,000 202 1880 13.77S.000 162 43 — — 21,100,000 223 1881 11,756,000 '3S 39 — — 22,991,000 242 1832 .,^ 12,401,000 146 42 — — 22,124,000 233^ 1883 — — 13,306,000 IS7 42 — — 22,561,000 238 1884 15,137,000 178 46 — — 21,189,000 223 1885 „_ 12, 148,000 '43 41 — — 20,716,000 219 1886 13,348,000 'S7 45 — — 19,586,000 206 1887 __ 12,688,000 149 41 — — 19,912,000 2IO 1888 13,228,000 'SS 40 — — 21,587,000 227 1889 13,684,000 161 41 — — 23,410,000 247 1890 15,566,000 1S3 41 — — 29,667,000 312 1891 16,071,000 189 43 — — 26,227,000 T 1892 16,982,000 200 47 — — 25,571,000 269 1893 — — 25,816,000 304 63 — — 21,314,000 22S 1894 _ _ 29,875,000 3S0 62 — — 22,127,000 ^■^4, 1895 34,645,000 407 58 — — 29,281,000 308 1896 25, 153,000 29s 50 — — 29,443,000 310 1897 22,920,000 209 46 — — 31,805,000 336 1898 21,191,000 24/8 43 — — 32,717,000 34S 1899 — — 21,455,000 2S' 43 — — Z9.474.OOO 310 1900 14 INTRODUCTION [CH. TABLE 3 {continued). Annual Averages of the Transactions of the Bank of England for the Years 1844-1900. 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 Annual Average Propor- Propor- Propor- Propor- Propor- of "Other" tion of Annual tion of tion of Annual tion of Annual Average tion Pro- Date. Securities after "Other" Average of Bills Dis- Bills Dis- Average of Tempo- of Notes held by vincial Deducting Bills Securi- Bills Dis- counted counted Temporary rary Ad- Public issued at Circula- Discounted and ties, etc., counted. to 1844. toTotalof Advances. vances to the Branches. tion to Temporary in 1644. "Other" 1844. TotalCir- Advances. 1844=100 r844=roo Securities 1844=100 culation. £ £ X £ £ % 1844 5,467,000 ZOO 2,690,000 100 28 1,315,000 100 6,510,000 32 1845 5,732,000 'OS 4,680,000 '74 38 1,803,000 '37 7,130,000 34 1846 5,788,000 106 9,030,000 334 54 1,843,000 140 6,770,000 33 1847 5,803,000 106 9,616,000 357 56 1,822,000 '39 6,530,000 34 1848 6,216,000 "3 4,289,000 '59 35 1,462,000 iti 5,830,000 32 1849 6,655,000 122 2,590,000 96 25 977,000 74 5,900,000 32 1850 6,540,000 iig 2,660,000 99 24 1,848,000 J40 6,260,000 32 1851 7,004,000 128 4,544,000 log 36 1,094,000 S3 6,420,000 33 1852 7,798,000 143 3,020,000 112 27 580,000 44 6,940,000 31 1853 8,028,000 14b 6, 137,000 228 41 921,000 70 7,810,000 34 1864 8,007,000 146 6,086,000 22b 41 639,000 48 7,380,000 36 1865 8,630,000 1S7 6,004,000 223 39 682,000 52 7,040,000 35 1856 8,487,000 '% 6,700,000 249 39 1,880,000 '43 6,970,000 35 1867 9,068,000 166 9,474,000 352 46 1,850,000 '4' 7,000,000 36 1868 11,101,000 202 4,620,000 172 28 595,000 45 6,880,000 34 1859 11,648,000 212 5,570,000 207 30 978,000 74 7,660,000 36 1860 11,078,000 201 8,091,000 301 39 1,342,000 102 7,910,000 37 1861 11,136,000 202 6,586,000 244 36 1,016,000 77 7,390,000 37 1862 11,207,000 20s 6,239,000 232 33 1,541,000 "7 7,480,000 36 1863 10,546,000 ig2 7,402,000 275 37 2,228,000 i6g 7,440,000 36 1864 9,703,000 m 8,600,000 320 42 1,993,000 '5' 7,570,000 37 1865 9,525,000 '74 8,601,000 320 42 2,442,000 '85 7,720,000 36 1866 9,778,000 '79 9,631,000 358 42 3,553,000 270 8,480,000 37 1867 10,575,000 '93 5,846,000 217 32 1,814,000 '38 8,6io,ooQ 37 1868 10,783,000 '97 5,030,000 187 28 1,834,000 '39 8,990,000 38 1869 9,165,000 167 5,808,000 2l6 34 1,849,000 140 8,860,000 38 1870 8,508,000 '55 6,418,000 239 34 3,696,000 281 8,830,000 38 1871 9,554,000 '74 6,411,000 239 34 2,838,000 21s 9,320,000 38 1872 10,622,000 '94 6,945,000 25S 32 3,899,000 296 9,882,000 39 1873 10,999,000 201 7,737,000 287 36 2,907,000 220 9,999,000 39 1874 11,080,000 201 4,665,000 '73 25 2,742,000 208 10,154,000 38 1875 11,429,000 2og 4,402,000 164 23 3,332,000 253 10,383,000 38 1876 — — — — — — — 10,362,000 37 1877 — — — — — — — 10,274,000 37 1878 — — — — — — — 9,989,000 35 1879 — — — — — — — 10,124,000 35 1880 — — — — — — — 9,295,000 35 1881 1882 1883 — — — — = — 9,114,000 35 1884 1885 — — — — — — — — — 1886 — — — — — — — — — 1887 1888 1889 — — — — — — — — — — — — — 1890 — — — — — — — — — 1891 — — — — — — — — — 1892 — — — — — — — — — 1893 — — — — — — — — — 1894 — — — — — — — — — 1895 — — 1896 — — — — — — — — — 1897 — — — — 1898 — — — 1899 — — 1900 — — — — — — — — - CH. i] ANNUAL AVERAGES, ACCOUNTS, BANK OF ENGLAND 15 TABLE 3 {continued). Annual Averages of the Transactions of the Bank of England for the Years 1844-1900. 37 ] 38 Propor- 33 40 Propor- 41 42 43 Propor- 44 Propor- 45 Proportion of 46 Annual Average tion of I Jinual Average of Total tion of Annual Average] Propor- tion of tion of Total Bullion Annual of Notes held : ^ondon Notes 01 iotal Com tion of Bullion Bullion Col. 41 Average of Date. by Public issued ' Dircula- Notes held by held by and Bullion Bullion Col. 41 Col. 41 to Liabilities Minimum in London. tion to Public. Public held by the 1844. to Lia- Notes Col. 11 and Rate of Total 1844. Bank. 44=100 bilities. held by Notes held by Discount. ( :ir'lat'n 44=loo Col. 1. Public. Public Col.39. £ X £ £ % X X £ i. d. 13,740,000 68 20,250,000 TOO 14,664,000 100 103 72 42 2 10 1844 13,544,000 66 20,674,000 102 15,243.000 104 93 74 41 2 13 8 1845 13,482,000 77 20,252,000 100 14,785,000 lOI 73 73 36 366 1846 12,593,000 66 19,123,000 94 10,428,000 T 65 54 30 5 3 6 1847 12,256,000 68 18,086,000 89 13,872,000 9S 87 77 41 3 14 5 1848 12,538,000 68 18,438,000 9' 15,161,000 103 88 82 42 2 18 7 1849 13, 188,000 68 19,448,000 96 16,636,000 "3 88 86 43 2 10 1 1850 13,040,000 67 19,468,000 gb 14,564,000 99 82 75 39 300 1851 14,970,000 69 21,910,000 108 20,587,000 140 102 94 49 230 1852 14,792,000 66 22,602,000 III 17,516,000 iig 90 78 41 3 13 10 1853 13,308,000 64 20,688,000 102 13,997,000 95 89 68 38 5 2 3 1854 12,790,000 65 19,830,000 gS 14,181,000 97 80 71 38 4 17 10 1855 12,697,000 65 19,667,000 97 10,932,000 75 65 56 30 6 I 2 1856 12,467,000 64 19,467,000 gb 10,118,000 bg 57 52 27 6 13 3 1857 13,368,000 66 20,248,000 100 17,847,000 122 86 88 43 3 4 7 1858 13,666,000 64 21,326,000 los 17,928,000 122 80 84 41 2 14 7 1859 13,342,000 63 21,252,000 105 15,239,000 104 73 72 36 4 3 7 1860 12,602,000 63 19,992,000 99 13,009,000 8g 71 65 34 5 5 4 1861 13.355,000 64 20,835,000 103 16,380,000 112 73 78 38 2 10 7 1862 13,224,000 64 20,664,000 102 14,567,000 99 66 70 34 482 1863 13,035,000 63 20,605,000 102 13,482,000 g2 65 65 33 780 1864 13,397,000 64 21,117,000 104 14,546,000 99 68 69 34 4 IS 4 1865 14,679,000 63 23,159.000 114 14,887,000 lOI 65 64 33 6 19 1866 14,828,000 63 23,438,000 lib 21,353,000 145 82 91 43 2 10 9 1867 14,942.000 62 23,932,000 118 20,838,000 142 81 87 42 2 I 11 1868 14,623,000 62 23,483,000 lib 18,825,000 128 79 80 40 3 4 2 1869 14,497.000 62 23,327,000 115 20,776,000 142 79 89 42 3 2 1870 15,096,000 62 24,416,000 120 23,588,000 ibz 81 96 44 2 17 8 1871 15,641,000 61 25,523,000 izb 22,585,000 '54 77 88 41 420 1872 15,685,000 61 25,645.000 12b 22,665,000 154 78 88 41 4 15 10 1873 16, 1 10,000 62 26,264,000 130 22,294,000 152 87 85 43 3 13 10 1874 16,963,000 62 27,346,000 ^35 23,923,000 ib3 90 88 44 3 4 8 1875 17,371,000 63 27,734.000 137 28,695,000 igb 93 104 49 2 12 I 1876 17,621,000 63 27,895,000 13S 25,374,000 173 88 91 45 2 18 1877 18,068,000 64 28,058,000 13S 23,952,000 ib3 82 85 42 3 15 8 1878 19,111,000 65 29,212,000 144 32,452,000 220 88 HI 49 2 10 4 1879 17,620,000 65 26,915,000 133 27,636,000 188 83 103 46 2 15 4 1880 17,226,000 65 26,321,000 130 24,580,000 ibr 77 93 42 3 10 1881 — — 25,985,000 128 21,992,000 149 74 84 39 428 1882 — — 25,568,000 12b 22,227,000 15' 74 86 40 3 " 4 1883 — — 25,358,000 125 22,907,000 '56 73 90 40 2 19 I 1884 — 24,667,000 122 24,173,000 ib4 75 98 41 2 17 7 1886 — — 24,659,000 122 21,018,000 '43 72 85 38 3 I 1886 — — 24,350,000 120 21,779,000 148 74 89 40 3 7 1887 — — 24,283,000 120 20,770,000 141 66 85 37 3 5 " 1888 — — 24,389,000 121 21,410,000 146 65 88 37 3 10 11 1889 — — 24,561,000 122 21,818,000 148 65 89 38 4 10 5 1890 — — 25,145,000 124 24,363,000 '65 63 97 39 3 5 2 1891 — — 25,863,000 128 25,519,000 '74 70 99 41 2 10 7 1892 — — 25,858,000 128 26,425,000 180 73 102 43 3 I 1893 — — 25,262,000 I2J 34,309,000 S34 83 136 52 223 1894 — — 25,815,000 128 38,951,000 2bs 81 ISl 52 200 1895 — — 26,474,000 131 44,334,000 302 74 168 51 298 1896 — — 27,198,000 134 35.571,000 242 71 131 46 2 12 8 1897 — — 27,447,000 T36 33,561,000 22g 67 122 43 3 4 10 1898 — — , 27,878,000 ^3S 32,268,000 220 65 116 41 3 IS 1899 — 1 — 29,396,000 H5 33,321,000 227 67 114 42 3 19 6 1900 CHAPTER II THE PRINCIPAL DIVISIONS OF THE ACCOUNTS OF THE BANK OF ENGLAND The principal Divisions of the Accounts of the Bank of England are given in a series of annual averages . . l6 Commencement of analysis of Table 3 . 17 Capital of the Bank of England . . i"] Notes issued, Specie and Securities in Issue Department . . . i? Total Deposits and Bank Post Bills 17-19 Private Deposits . . . . 18 Effect of Chinese-Japanese Loan, 1895-6 18 Liabilities of the Bank The Reserve Proportion of Reserve to Liabilities Bankers' Balances The Note Circulation The Bankers' Balances and the Reserve 23-27 The Clearing House — Stock Exchange "Settling" Days Bankers' Balances with Bank of England represent " Till Money " Table showing Proportion of Reserve to Liabilities, and of Bankers' Balances to Reserve, 1846-77 . . . 24 Examination of this Table . . . 24 • 19 19-20 . 20 20-22 22-23 23 23 Deposits, etc., of the Bank during panics of 1857, 1866, and 187s • 24-25 Amounts of "Other Deposits, Balances of London Bankers, Other Securities, and Reserve " during times of pressure in 1875, i87''> a"d 1890 . . 25 The Baring Crisis, 1890 . . . 26 The Other Securities, their increase since 1844 . . . . 27 Bills Discounted, amount not known now 28 Mr. Thomson Hankey on "Bills" and "Mortgages" . . . 29 Average of Coin and Bullion . 30-32 Issue Department, compelled by Act of 1844 to receive all Gold Bullion brought to it . . . . 30 Bullion held sometimes larger in amount than notes in circulation . 31-32 Average Rate of Discount . . . 32 Divergence between Market Rate and Bank Rate, 1845-1900 . . . 32 Table 4.— Annual Averages of Bank Rate and Market Rate, and differences be- tween them . . • • 33 We will now proceed to examine Table 3, pp. 11-15, which is drawn up for the purpose of assisting us to understand the operations of the Bank of England by placing before us a complete summary of its published accounts, from the year 1844 to the close of the year 1900. These are stated in a series of annual averages. To each of the columns of amounts which the statement contains columns of propor- tional figures have been added, which show at a glance the proportion which the amount for each year bears to 1844. This method of exhibiting the development of the business will be found convenient by the reader, who is thus enabled to compare at one view the whole of the operations of the Bank. The Bank of England has the largest paid-up capital of any I6 CH. ii] DEPOSITS AND BANK POST BILLS 17 bank in the world, being ;^i4,553,ooo ; the " Rest," or accumu- lated and undivided profit, averages about 3 millions more. The total capital belonging to the Bank is therefore about 17J millions. Notes Issued, Specie and Securities in Issue Department. Col. I of Table 3, p. 11, shows the average amount of " notes issued " as given in the weekly returns of the Bank. The securities held in the Issue Department are entered in col. 3, the notes held in the Banking Department in col. 7. A larger amount than that held by the Bank is always in the hands of the public. The notes issued at the branches are given in col. 35, p. 14, and those issued in London in col. 37, p. 15. The notes cannot be separated thus later than 1881, as this information has not been supplied further. The total amount of the notes in the hands of the public is given in col. 39, p. 1 5. The notes held by the Bank are also included together with the specie in the Banking Department in the amount of the reserve of the Bank, col. 21, p. 13. The total specie held by the Bank, both in the Issue and Banking Departments, is shown in col. 41, p. 1 5. The notes held by the Bank have increased proportion- ally more than those entered as " issued." These have increased in proportion more than those held by the public, as cols. 2, 8, and 40 show. The bullion in the Issue Department, cols. 9 and 10, has increased in proportion more than the notes, cols. 2, 40. The securities in the Issue Department, cols. 3 and 4, have not increased as much. Hence the proportion of notes issued against bullion is larger, and that issued against securities is generally less in 1900 than in 1844. Total Deposits and Bank Post Bills. Col. 17 of Table 3, p. 12, contains the yearly averages of the total deposits of the Bank of England. These are now in a usual way nearly four times as large as in 1844. Col. 18 shows the proportion of the deposits in each year to 1844 ^■nd their progress each year. Occasionally, as it will be seen by the table, the progress has not been uniform, but on the whole it is continuous. Cols. 13 and 15 show the averages of the public deposits and of the private deposits. i8 ACCOUNTS OF BANK OF ENGLAND [ch. ii The monthly fluctuations of the bullion in the Issue Depart- ment are given in Table 7, p. 71, and those of the Liabilities and the Reserve in Table 11, pp. 82, 83. The figures were largely afifected in the years 1895 and 1896 by the payments made by the Chinese Government to that of Japan. A Chinese Loan was negotiated at Paris under a Russian guarantee^in the latter half of 1895, some ;^8,ooo,ooo having been paid over in October, and the remaining ^5,000,000 in the month of November. The private deposits of the Bank had risen from an average of about ;^30,ooo,ooo in 1893 ^^^ of ;^33,ooo,ooo in 1894, to more than ;^40,ooo,oo in 1895, and ^^49,000,000 in 1896. The ;if 13,000,000 lodged on account of the Japanese Government with the Bank was principally paid in bills, only a small part having been forwarded in specie. This immense sum practically never left this country ; a small part was under- stood to have been repaid, as it came, in specie, but the remainder was employed in the building of ships, the purchase of naval and military stores, in these and other ways giving em- ployment here. It does not appear to figure in the accounts of the Bank after the spring of 1896, The public deposits, col. 13, p. 12, are considerably larger now than in 1844, but the increase in them has been by no means so large as in the total deposits. Col. 14, which shows the proportion of the annual average to 1 844, makes this point very clear. Col. 1 5 contains the annual average of the private deposits, and it is in these that the largest increase has occurred. In 1900 they were five times as large as in 1844, having been in 1896 six times as large. Col. 16 shows the proportion in each year; while the growth has been continuous, it has not been uniform. The amounts held during the last ten years show a very large increase, and examining this column gives a better idea of the growth of the business than any other statement that can be put before the reader. Col. 19, p. 13, shows the annual averages of the London Bankers' Balances from 1844 to 1877, the last year in which they were published. These are included among the private deposits shown in col. 15. The increase in them during the period for which the information is given was far larger than that of any other branch of the business of the Bank — the increase in them between 1844 and 1877 having been nearly CH. ii] LIABILITIES— RESERVE 19 tenfold. The growth since 1877 has certainly been far larger. This subject will be dealt with more fully later on. Col. II, p. 12, contains the yearly averages of the total liabilities of the Bank of England, including under this head the amount of the deposits and of the Bank post bills. From this point of view we need not take the Bank note circulation into account, as that concerns the Issue Department and not the Banking Department of the Bank of England ; the only lia- bilities, therefore, which have to be taken into consideration here besides the deposits, are the seven-day and other bills. These last have declined in amount greatly since 1854, the last year in which they were over _^ 1,000,000. From averaging more than ^1,000,000 in 1844, they have diminished to less than ;^300,ooo in 1900. Hence it has not been thought necessary to tabulate the amounts of the Bank post bills separately. They are included with the public and private deposits in col. 1 1, p. 12. During the time under notice a very considerable increase in the liabilities of the Bank on deposits has taken place. The liabilities, which averaged about 14^^ millions in 1844, averaged more than 50 millions in 1900, having thus much more than tripled in the course of that time ; this growth, as will be seen by a reference to col. 12, has been gradual and continuous. It was not till i860 or 1870 that the average deposits of the Bank much exceeded its capital ; even at the present date the deposits are rarely equal to four times the amount of the capital. This is an unusually strong position for any bank to occupy. The capital of most banks bears generally a much smaller proportion to the deposits. In Scotland the proportion has on average been of late years 14 per cent. In Ireland it is from 19 to 20 per cent. In the United Kingdom generally the average is 15 per cent, though with many banks it is distincriy higher.* The position of the Bank of England in this respect is unusually and exceptionally strong. The Reserve. In a similar manner, though not by any means in a like proportion, the average reserve has increased. The annual * See articles on the "Progress of Banking," numbers for January, February, April to June in Banker^ Magazine. Published by Waterlow and Sons, Limited. 20 ACCOUNTS OF BANK OF ENGLAND [ch. ii average of the reserve, with a statement of the proportion each year bears to 1844, will be found in cols. 21 and 22, p. 13. The average reserve, from being S^ millions in 1844, has increased to nearly 21^ millions in 1900. In col. 23 is given the average proportion of the reserve to the liabilities on deposits and Bank post bills. This is generally very considerable. It has been as high as 63 per cent, in 1852, and again in 1894; it was as low as 30 per cent, in 1866. It rose in 1867 to 49 per cent., and has since never averaged less than 37 per cent. This proportion was marked in 1878. But the reserve has sometimes been comparatively low of recent years, and the proportion was only 43 per cent, in 1899-1900. In looking down col. 23, a distinct, though gradual, diminution in the proportion of the reserve to the liabilities becomes obvious. And it is not only the proportion of the reserve to the liabilities which has altered ; the character of the demands which may be made upon the reserve has, during the last twenty-five years, undergone a great, though a gradual alteration. This is indicated by the great increase in the balances which the London bankers have kept with the Bank of England ; these amounts are more likely to be drawn on severely and sharply in a time of pressure than any other money kept with the Bank of England. We will now proceed to consider the amounts of these balances, the proportion which they bore to the reserve of the Bank of England between the years 1844 and 1877, and their position at the present time. Bankers' Balances. Col. 19, p. 13, contains the annual average of the London bankers' balances from 1844 to 1877, when the publication ceased. In these there was, as long as the published figures allowed the matter to be traced, a very considerable and progressive in- crease, far larger than the increase in the reserve itself. The particulars of this are not given in the weekly statements, and it is only the returns published by order of the House of Commons which supply this valuable information. The average amount of each year, which was less than i million in 1844, had become more than 9|- millions in 1877, the latest date to which the information can be given. By the balances CH. n] BANKERS' BALANCES 21 of "the London bankers," it is understood that the balances of "the clearing bankers" are described. There are, there- fore, doubtless other amounts than these belonging to bankers, and really forming a portion of the general reserve of bankers with the Bank. There are now many important banks located in the metropolis, besides the London banks properly so called, among which are Scotch banks, Irish banks, Colonial banks, and many foreign banks. Most of these do large businesses in London, and doubtless keep corresponding sums of money in reserve. There are also large sums of money kept with the branches of the Bank of England at Manchester, at Liverpool, and elsewhere, by provincial banks, which often do business on a large scale, quite comparable with that of many London banks. These sums are all, properly speaking, "bankers' balances," and the amounts being kept for the same purpose, should be included in the same statement. We can, however, only deal with the figures as stated in the published returns. The increase of the figures was progressive, and, so long as it was recorded, proceeded in a far more rapid proportion than the increase of the reserve of the Bank of England itself, or of any other branch of its business. Col. 20, p. 1 3, contains the proportion which the balances of the London bankers bore during each year to their amount in 1 844 ; this enables us to follow their fluctuations with facility. In col. 25 the proportion per cent, of the average bankers' balances to the reserve is given. From being only 1 1 per cent, of the total reserve in 1844, the proportion increased to 93 per cent, in 1866; and, though it did not always remain at that high figure, it was more than 75 per cent, in the years 1873-77. Thus, from being but a small fraction of the reserve in the early years over which the table extends, the amount increased to being equal to three-quarters of the average reserve at the date last mentioned. Col. 24 shows the proportion which the reserve would have borne to the liabilities if the bankers' balances had not been included. It shows how largely the bankers' balances assist to keep up the amount of the resources of the Bank. It is the practice of the London banks to keep their principal reserve against immediate demands with the Bank of England, as being the easiest and safest plan. And as their 22 ACCOUNTS OF BANK OF ENGLAND [ch. ii business has extended, so they have also increased the balances to the credit of their accounts with the Bank of England. As far as the connection between the two can be traced, it appears that the amounts of the bankers' balances (the bankers' reserves) were, when the publication of the amounts ceased, much larger in proportion to their liabilities than they had been twenty-five years before ; while the proportion of the reserve of the Bank of England to its own liabilities was somewhat smaller. This subject is so important that it is dealt with separately in Chapter III., p. 34. No doubt a very considerable portion of the increase in the balances of the London bankers is due to the necessity of holding larger sums at the Bank of England, consequent on the development of the Clearing House system, and the admission of the principal London joint stock banks to that establishment, arranged in the years 1853 and 1854. The Note Circulation. The effect of the alterations consequent on the admission of the Joint Stock Banks to the London Clearing House may be traced in the diminution of the metropolitan note circulation of the Bank of England about that time. The annual averages of the notes held by the public issued at the branches and in London are shown in cols. 35 and 2>1> PP- 14. 15. of this table, up to the close of the year 1881. Since that date no information has been published on this subject. Between 1844 and 1875 the provincial circulation had increased more rapidly than the circulation which centres in London. If the same course has been followed to the present time, nearly half the note circu- lation of the Bank of England now proceeds from the branch offices. As mentioned above, a distinct diminution in the metro- politan circulation, given in col. 37, p. 15, is observable about 1855. And from that date also, following on the admission of the joint stock banks to the Clearing House, the proportion borne by the balances of the London bankers to the reserve of the Bank of England, which had not ever previously exceeded 20 per cent, of that reserve, rose till, as previously mentioned, the bankers' balances became, between 1873 and 1877, usually about three-quarters of the reserve. The total amount held by CH. II] NOTES— BANKERS' BALANCES AND RESERVE 23 the public and the proportion to that in 1844 are shown in cols. 39 and 40, p. 1 5. The note circulation and the bullion in the Issue Department are stated in Tables 6 and 7, pp. 70, 71. The Bankers' Balances and the Reserve. The enormous amounts, as ;^i09, 143,000, May 15, 1901, which pass through the Clearing House, especially on Stock Ex- change " settling days," when totals of 60 millions, 70 millions, and more are often cleared, leave large differences to be adjusted through the "clearing bankers'" account with the Bank of England. Due preparation has to be made to meet these differ- ences, and very large amounts are required on these occasions. What is paid away by one bank in this manner is, how- ever, received by another. The "money" remains equally with the Bank of England, whether it stands to the credit of one bank or of another bank. Taking the amounts held on deposit by the bankers in London into consideration, and the demands which may be made on them on that account, it would appear that the balances which they keep with the Bank of England rather represent what should, with strict accuracy, be called their "Till Money" than their "Reserve." " Till Money," as everyone concerned in banking knows, is the amount which every banker is bound to keep close at hand ready to meet the calls of the moment, as cheques are presented over the counter. An adequate supply of " Till Money " is indispensable to the proper conduct of a banking business, but it cannot be looked upon as a " Reserve." A " reserve," though equally needed to meet immediate calls, must be on a far larger scale than the mere amount of cash necessarily held in the "till." And taking into consideration, as just mentioned, the vast amounts of deposits held by London bankers, and the demands which may be made on them at any time, the balances they keep with the Bank of England must be considered as the cash needed for immediate require- ments — that is to say, the " Till Money " — transferred for convenience sake to the custody of the Bank of England, rather than a really adequate banking reserve. The growth and development of the London bankers' balances and the proportion they stood in to the reserve of 24 ACCOUNTS OF BANK OF ENGLAND [ch. ii the Bank of England will be clearly shown if we divide the period from 1846 to 1877 into four groups of eight years each. This comparison cannot be carried later than the year 1877, because that was the last year in which the amount of the bankers' balances was published. The averages are as follows : — Statement for years 1846-1877. Proportion per Cent, of Reserve of Bank of England to Liabilities. Proportion per Cent, of Bankers' Balances to Reserve of Bank of England. Averages of the years 1846-53 1854-61 „ „ 1862-69 „ „ 1870-77 52 per cent. 43 42 45 21 per cent. 45 » 60 70 In the earliest group, the proportion of the reserve was more than half the liabilities. This proportion, it will be seen, on the whole declined, while the proportion which the balances of the London bankers bore to the banking reserve itself steadily increased. Though the progress of the balances of the London bankers kept with the Bank of England cannot be traced through any published statements beyond the year 1877, yet it is well known that they are far larger now than at that date. And as these amounts are included among the total deposits of the Bank, it becomes clear how very consider- able a part of the increase of those deposits is due to this source. The general effect may be seen by comparing the figures in col. 17, p. 12, with those in col. 19, p. 13. It might be thought that these deposits would be the most certain to diminish in times of pressure, but, on the contrary, they are certain to rise at such a time. Thus they greatly increased during the panics of 1857 and 1866. Between the 4th and the 25th of November, 1857, the bankers' balances increased 2 millions ; rising from ^3,400,000 on the 4th November, to ;i^5, 400,000 on the 25th November. In 1866 the action of the bankers was more rapid. On the 9th May, 1866, their balances were ;^5, 000,000; by the i6th — that is to say, in one week — the amount had increased nearly 3 millions, the figures being ^7,900,000. Beyond doubt, a great portion of these sums had been derived from the Bank of England itself, as the temporary advances during that time increased nearly 5 millions, and the amount of bills discounted also increased to about the same extent. The CH. II] BANKERS' BALANCES IN TIMES OF PRESSURE 25 reserve of the Bank of England had diminished during the same time, from the 9th to the i6th May, more than 4 millions, from ;^4, 900,000 on the earlier date, to ;^7oo,ooo on the later. A great portion of that amount had undoubtedly been drawn by the London bankers. The immediate response to the call of necessity speaks very well for the manner in which the reserves of money at short dates were placed, for the prudence with which the banking business of the country generally was carried on, and also for the liberality shown by the Bank at a period of great national peril. A more recent instance of the manner in which the balances of the London bankers are increased during a time of anxiety was shown in the year 1875. On May 31st in that year the failure of Messrs. Sanderson and Co., the Discount Brokers, of Lombard Street, was announced simultaneously with that of the Aberdare and Plymouth Iron Companies, some anxiety having existed for a short time previous; and on June 15th the bankruptcy of Messrs. A. Collie and Co. took place, accompanied with the downfall of a host of minor traders who were involved in their ruin. The influence of these events on the balances of the London bankers was very remarkable. The particulars are as follows : — BANK OF ENGLAND. Other Deposits. Balances of London Bankers (included among Other Securities. Reserve, Notes and Coin. other Deposits). 1875 £. May 5 = i. May 5 = £ May 5 = I May 5 . 17,209,000 JOO 7,072,000 100 18,923,000 100 8,399,000 „ 12 . 17,992,000 104 8,346,000 J18 19,191,000 lOI 8,804,000 ,. 19 • 17,030,000 99 7,274,000 '03 17,715,000 94 9,159,000 „ 26 . 19.437,000 113 10,017,000 141 19,055,000 101 10,344,000 June 2 . 21,625,000 J26 11,857,000 167 21,977,000 116 10,076,000 .. 9 • 20,074,000 116 10,497,000 '49 20,099,000 106 11,061,000 „ 16 . 19,547,000 "3 9,902,000 J40 18,334,000 97 12,385,000 >. 23 . 22,847,000 '33 12,399,000 176 21,186,000 "5 13,072,000 A very great rise also took place in the "other" deposits of the Bank of England in October, 1878. On the 2nd of that month the stoppage of the City of Glasgow Bank was announced. The movement in the "other" deposits of the Bank, consequent on this event, was as follows : — 26 ACCOUNTS OF BANK OF ENGLAND BANK OF ENGLAND. [CH. II Other Deposits. Other Securities. Reserve, Notes and Coin. 1878 September 25 . . . October 2 . . . 9 ■ • 16 . . . 23 . . . 20,087,459 21,938,505 25,967,071 27,321,433 27,859,388 Sept. 25 = 100 log 129 '37 '39 £ 17,333,000 20,028,000 20,930,000 23,024,000 23,312,000 Sept.25 = 100 116 121 '33 '3S 12,254,000 10,772,000 10,215,000 8,517,000 9,166,000 A large portion of this increase in the deposits was at- tributed at the time to additions made to the bankers' accounts, but as the particulars of the London bankers' balances have not been published since 1877, the details have not been made public. A similar movement was observable in November, 1890, and it is desirable to recapitulate the circumstances. The announcement of the involved position of Baring's was made by the Bank of England on Friday, November 14th. The Bank rate had been raised to 6 per cent., as a pre- cautionary measure, on November 7th, which was Friday — a very unusual day for a change, the regular day being, as is well known, Thursday, the Court day at the Bank. It was nearly a week before the City generally was informed how matters really stood. On the afternoon of Friday, November 14th, a meeting of leading City men was held at the Bank, and a guarantee commenced, which, at a further meeting held on the 15th, was brought up to the amount of ^8,ooo,ooo-;^9,ooo,ooo required to stave off a forced liquidation. In the next return of the Bank of England the "other" deposits had increased _;^6,ooo,ooo, which may hence be concluded to have been added to their balances by the bankers between the 15 th and the 19th. The following statement shows the course of events : — BANK OF ENGLAND. Other Deposits. Other Securities. Reserve, Notes and Coin. iSgo £ Nov. 5 = £ Nov. 5 = t. November 5 . . . 29,172,000 700 23,128,000 100 11,206,000 12 . . . 30,286,000 104 25,067,000 108 11,105,000 19 • ■ ■ 36,365,000 '25 32,136,000 '39 14,552,000 „ 26 . . . 34,990,000 120 29,920,000 129 16,503,000 December 3 33,313,000 "4 27,517,000 "9 16,673,000 10 . . . 32,643,000 112 27,373.000 118 17,007,000 17 ■ • • 33,199,000 "4 28,603,000 124 16,763,000 CH. ii] THE OTHER SECURITIES 27 In all these periods of pressure the increase in the "other" deposits has been accompanied by a generally corresponding increase in other securities. This indicates that in round figures what has been borrowed frorri the Bank, or a great part of it, has been deposited with the Bank. The columns of proportional figures enable us to trace this point. Pari passu the increases in the two columns, of the other deposits and of the other securities, balance each other. Information at the moment would have been very valuable, as this would have helped to allay needless alarm. Suitable precautions against danger sometimes prevent that danger from becoming serious, and on such occasions it is very desirable that the extent of the precautions taken should be known. The Other Securities. The annual average of the "other" securities held by the Bank of England is given in Table 3, col. 26, p. 13. Col. 27, which accompanies this, shows the gradual growth of these. The amount was, roughly, three times as large in 1900 as it was in 1 844. I have not thought it necessary to tabulate the Govern- ment securities held by the Bank, which are at the present date of writing (November 26th, 1902) about ^35,700,000, being : — Government Debt and other Securities in Issue /;£i 1,015,100 Department . . . . . I 7,159,900 18,175,000 Government Securities in Banking Department . . . 17,512,457 £35>687,457 The "other" securities in the Issue Department are included in this statement, since these are Parliamentary securities, like the "Government debt." These have increased from ;^2,984,900 in 1844 to ;^7, 159,900 in 1902, the increase arising from the additional amount of note issue allowed to the Bank on securities through the contraction of the English country note circulation. This subject, the importance of which is scarcely generally recognised, is referred to in Chapter XXL, p. 217. Col. 26, Table 3, contains only the "other" securities held in the Banking Department. Little is now known as to the details which make up these securities, but the bills dis- counted by the Bank and the temporary advances are included among them. More information on these heads was given 28 ACCOUNTS OF BANK OF ENGLAND [ch. ii up to the year 1875. I have tabulated this information in cols. 28, 30, and 33 of Table 3, p. 14. Col. 28 shows the amount of the "other" securities which would remain after deducting the bills discounted and the temporary advances from the total ; and col. 29 gives the corresponding propor- tion for each year from 1844 to 1875. More than half the "other" securities thus appear always to have been of a fixed character during the periods over which our information extends. Col. 30 shows the annual average of bills discounted, and col. 33 the annual average of the temporary advances made by the Bank. The amount of bills discounted shown in col. 30 has, at times, been large, and it has fluctuated greatly. It will be seen that the largest amounts were in the years when pressure on the money market was the highest, as in 1846, 1847, 1857, i860, 1864, 1865, 1866. To facilitate examination into this point, and for convenience of reference, the annual average of the minimum rate of discount has been given in col. 46, Table 3, p. 15. The rate charged at the Bank is com- pared with the market rate in Table 4, p. 33. This subject is dealt with separately, as the statement of the market rate could not conveniently be brought into the analysis of the accounts of the Bank. When the rate of interest has been quite low, as in 1844, 1849, and 1850, the amount of bills discounted was small. It will be seen from Table 4 that during these years the market rate dropped distinctly below the Bank rate, and those who required discounts naturally obtained the accommodation they needed elsewhere. In the last two years for which the informa- tion can be given — 1874 and 1875 — the average amount was close to ;^4, 500,000. It would appear that this branch of the business of the Bank has not increased in the same degree as the deposits have done. The statement in col. 32, p. 14, supports this impression. It shows the proportion which the bills dis- counted held to the total of the other securities. Only in two years during the period in which this point can be examined into did the bills discounted amount to more than half of the total of the securities. The proportion in the last year for which the information was given was less than a quarter of the whole amount of the securities held. This subject will be dealt with further on, when the analysis of the accounts CH. ii] A MORTGAGE OR BILL OF EXCHANGE 29 of the other great banks of Europe is proceeded with in Chapters XV. p. 140, XVI. p. 154, XVII. p. 174, XVIII. p. 181, and XX. p. 203. Col. 33, p. 14, shows the annual average of temporary advances. These, it appears, have fluctuated very considerably. It is difficult, without the aid of information on the part of the Bank, to form any distinct idea of what the amount may be now, but the probability is that it is now occasionally far larger than it was twenty-five years since. It is much to be regretted that the statement given in the table cannot be continued to the present time, and that information on this point and as to the amount of bills discounted is not supplied now. These are the only items in the account of the Bank in which any "fluidity" can exist. The remainder of the other securities held are believed to be principally debenture stocks of the great railway companies of the country and stocks of the large municipal corporations. Of "other" securities there were held, on November 26th, 1902, in the Banking Department ;i^30,378,633. On average the amount is now from about 29 to 32 millions, the difference between one week and another arising, probably a good deal, from alterations in the temporary advances. Little is known as to the details, but the description given in Mr. Thomson Hankey's book on The Principles of Banking, published 1867, may apply. Mr. Hankey was Governor of the Bank some years since. He possessed great natural shrewdness and was a first-rate man of business. He criticises, in The Principles of Banking, the classes of securities which a banker should hold, and remarks that "a relative of mine, C. Poulett Thomson, many years since used to say to me that nothing was easier to conduct than the business of a banker if he would only learn the difference between a mort- gage and a bill of exchange. This saying may appear absurd; but I believe it is full of wisdom." Mr. Hankey applies this principle to bills of exchange ; he means by it to discriminate between those bills which are based on current transactions and naturally, as it is said, "turn themselves into money," and those bills, such as the acceptances of contractors and others, which, though they no doubt will eventually be paid, may require a fresh loan to be made to continue them. The prin- ciple which Mr. Hankey applies is the right principle to act on 30 ACCOUNTS OF BANK OF ENGLAND [ch. ii when bills are offered for discount. It would be interesting to learn what proportion of the securities held by the Bank are now bills of exchange, short loans, or debenture and municipal stocks, "mortgages" according to Mr. Hankey's definition. These, though admirable securities from an investor's point of view, are not those which are usually held to be suitable for bankers to place any large part of their money in. Average of Coin and Bullion. The yearly averages of the coin and bullion held in the Issue Department are given in col. 9, p. 1 1. A column with proportional figures. No. 10, follows, which gives the proportion of the coin and bullion held to the amount in 1 844. The fluctuations have been considerable, and the increase not so large as in the deposits and the reserve. The amount in several years — as in 1847 and 1848, during the years 1854 to 1857 inclusive, in 1861, and in 1863 to 1865 — was smaller than in 1844. It has not been till compara- tively recently, in 1876 — and especially from the year 1894 on- wards — that any marked increase has taken place. The position of the Bank of England in respect to the gold bullion imported into this country is peculiar. The Act of 1 844 declares in the 4th section that, after the date when that Act came into operation, "all Persons shall be entitled to demand from the Issue De- partment of the Bank of England Bank of England Notes in exchange for Gold Bullion at the Rate of Three Pounds Seventeen Shillings and Ninepence per Ounce of Standard Gold." Hence by far the greater part of the gold brought into the country makes its way automatically to the Bank, and the amount held there doubtless represents at times rather the convenience of the importer than the requirements of the Bank. What happens when the Bank buys gold is usually this. A bullion dealer brings bar gold. An advance is made upon it, pending assay, by the Issue Department. The dealer's account in the Drawing Office — he is sure to have an account, though it is not essential to the transaction — is credited with the amount, and notes to the same sum are transferred from the Issue De- partment to the Banking Department. After the assay the exact value of the bar gold is calculated at standard fineness. CH. ii] COIN AND BULLION— RATE OF DISCOUNT 31 and the balance due to the dealer is dealt with in the same manner as the original advance. In the Issue Department the gold held and the notes issued are increased, in the Banking Department the drawing accounts and the reserve are increased. Practically all gold brought to the Bank in whatever form is paid for by the Issue Department in notes. The Act of 1844 places no limit on the issue of notes against gold : in other words, the Bank is empowered by that Act to issue notes against gold at the rate of ']']$. <^d. per ounce standard without any limitation. A further amount of specie, gold and silver coin, is held in the Banking Department, besides the bullion in the Issue Depart- ment. This, except in the years 1867 to 1869, and 1878 to 1 88 1, never exceeded a million regularly till about the year 1885. For the years 1893 ^o 1900 the amount on average has exceeded two millions. The specie thus held is included in the statement of the reserve, Table 3, col. 21, p. 13, being in that case added to the notes held by the Bank, col. 7, and also in the amount of the total bullion held, col. 41, p. 15, being in that case added to the coin in the Issue Department, col. 9, p. 11. The manner in which the accounts of the Bank are divided between the Issue Department and the Banking Department has rendered it necessary to make the statement in this form, in order to show both what the amount of the reserve is, and the total amount of bullion and specie held. Col. 43, p. 1 5, shows the proportion of the total specie and bullion to the total liabilities — that is, to the deposits and the Bank post bills. As a rule the specie and bullion are less in amount than these, the proportion being from 65 per cent, to 81 per cent, in the years from 1895 to 1900. There were two years, 1844 and 1852, in which the specie and bullion held were larger in amount than the liabilities, being in the pro- portion of 103 and 102 respectively. The figures for these two years are therefore printed in a thick type to call atten- tion to this point. Col. 44, p. 15, shows the proportion of the total specie and bullion to the notes held by the public. The proportion of the cover in metal to the notes in the hands of the public has rarely for the last twenty years been much less than 90 per cent. There have been several occasions in recent years — in 1876, 1879, 1880, and from 1893 to 1900 — in which 33 ACCOUNTS OF BANK OF ENGLAND [ch. ii the specie and bullion held have been larger in amount than the notes in circulation. For these years also the figures have been printed in a thick type — as 104 for 1876. Col. 45 shows the proportion of the bullion to the liabilities and the notes in the hands of the public united. This has been, on average, for many years more than 40 per cent, of the amount of the liabilities and notes held by the public. With respect to the "notes issued," the proportions issued against securities and against bullion are shown in cols. 5 and 6, p. II. The average issue against bullion has increased of recent years. Average Rate of Discount. The annual average minimum rate of discount charged by the Bank is shown in col. 46, p. 15. This subject is dealt with more fully in Chapters V. and VI. pp. 48, 55, which dis- cuss the relations between the rate of discount and the reserve of the Bank, also in Chapters X. and XI. pp. 95, 106, on the variations in the rate from 1844 to 1900, and some of the causes which influence it ; and in Chapters XIX. and XX. pp. 190, 203, on the fluctuations in the rate charged by the Bank compared with other business fluctuations, with some remarks on the rate of discount of the Banks of England, France, Germany, Holland, and Belgium. To illustrate the increasing divergence between the market rate and the Bank rate, Table 4, p. 33, is given showing the annual average of the Bank rate and of the market rate for high-class bills for 1 845-1 900, and the differences between the two rates. Down to 1870 the market rate was occasionally above the Bank rate. Since that time, however, the market rate has been constantly and, on average, increasingly below the Bank rate charged in London. At its provincial branches the Bank works at the ordinary local rate current. Indeed complaints are made that the Bank will at times discount below the rate usual in those places — complaints which are not to be wondered at considering the large amounts placed with the Bank of England by bankers, who naturally object to com- petition of this description, carried on against them with their own money. CH. II] AVERAGES OF THE BANK AND MARKET RATES 33 TABLE 4. Annual Averages of Bank Rate and of Market Rate High-Class Bills for the years 1845-1900, showing when the Market Rate was above or below the Bank Rate. Year. Annual Average Bank Rate. Proportion of Annual Average Bank Rate to 1 8^5 Annual Average Market Rate High-Class Bills. Proportion of Annual Average Market Rate to 1845 Difference between Market Rate and Bank Rate. Year. ^ Market Rate. (1845 = 100). (1843 = 100). More. Less. £. s. d. £. '. d. t. d. I !. d. 1845 2 13 8 100 300 100 6 4 1845 1846 366 124 3 IS I..2S 8 — 1846 1847 S 3 6 192 5 n 6 19s 14 1847 1848 3 14 S 139 3 S 108 — 095 1848 1849 2 18 7 109 2 S 75 — 13 7 1849 1850 2 10 I 93 s S 75 — 5' 1850 1851 300 112 300 100 — 1851 1852 230 80 I 17 6 62 — s (> 1862 1863 3 13 10 138 3 10 117 — 3 10 1863 1854 523 190 4 17 6 162 — 049 1854 1855 4 17 10 181 4 10 150 — 7 10 1855 1856 6 I 2 225 S 10 183 — II 2 1866 1857 6 13 3 248 6 IS 22s I 9 — 1857 1858 3 4 7 120 3 IS 91 — 097 1858 1859 2 14 7 102 2 10 83 — 047 1859 1860 4 3 7 IS6 400 133 — 037 1860 1861 5 S 4 196 S 167 — 054 1861 1862 2 10 7 94 3 S 75 — 057 1862 1863 482 164 4 S 142 — 032 1863 1864 780 276 700 233 — 080 1864 1865 4 'S 4 177 367 177 II 3 — 1865 1866 6 19 2S9 6 8 2 213 10 10 1866 1867 2 10 9 94 2 13 4 88 2 7 — 1867 1868 2 I II 77 2 5 9 76 3 10 — 1868 1869 342 119 3 7 3 H2 3 3 — 1869 1870 320 116 3 3 7 109 3 7 — 1870 1871 2 17 8 107 2 17 10 96 2 — 1871 1872 420 IS3 419 136 — 003 1872 1873 4 'S 10 177 4 14 157 — I 10 1873 1874 3 13 10 138 3 II I 118 — 029 1874 1875 348 120 329 105 — I II 1876 1876 2 12 I 97 2 5 3 75 — 6 10 1876 1877 2 18 1 08 2 12 5 87 — 7 7 1877 1878 3 15 8 141 3 II II 120 — 039 1878 1879 2 10 4 93 2 2 9 71 — 077 1879 1880 2 IS 4 103 2 10 7 8S — 049 1880 1881 3 10 130 311 102 — 8 II 1881 1882 428 1 54 3 II I 118 — II 7 1882 1883 3 II 4 133 3 4 4 '27 — 070 1883 1884 2 19 I no 2 II 6 86 — 077 1884 1885 2 17 7 107 280 80 — 097 1885 1886 310 114 ^68 78 — 14 4 1886 1887 370 125 2 12 II 88 — 14 I 1887 1888 3 5 II 123 2 10 7 85 — 15 4 1888 1889 3 10 II 132 2 16 II 95 — 14 1889 1890 4 10 5 168 3 n 7 128 — 12 10 1890 1891 352 121 2 15 4 92 — 9 10 1891 1892 2 10 7 94 I IS 2 59 — 15 5 1892 1893 3 I 114 263 77 — 14 9 1893 1894 223 79 139 39 — 18 6 1894 1895 200 75 19 2 32 — I 10 1895 1896 298 93 I II 5 52 — 18 3 1896 1897 2 12 8 98 t 18 6 ^oi — 14 2 1897 1898 3 4 10 120 n 12 II 88 — II II 1898 1899 3 IS 140 350 108 — 10 1899 1900 3 19 6 148 3 14 2 123 ~ 054 1900 D CHAPTER III THE BALANCES OF THE LONDON BANKERS WITH THE BANK OF ENGLAND Desirability of publishing information as to Balances of London Bankers with Bank . ... No arrangement between the Bank and bankers as to manner of dealing with balances . ... Table 5. Annual Averages of London Bankers' Balances with the Bank of England, 1844-1877 Dates when Bankers' Balances exceeded the Reserve, 1844-1877 . Growth of Bankers' Balances unnoticed . Large part of Deposits at Bank consists of Bankers' Balances Desirability of publishing amounts held by Bankers with the Bank, in order to show of what the Reserve really consists 34 34 37 Bank of England. Account for the week ending December 26th, 1877, showing Proportion of Reserve to Liabilities in ordinary form, and after deducting Bankers' Balances . . . 38 Bankers' Balances cannot form part of Reserve of Bank of England and of other Banks as well . • • 39 These balances are the ultimate Reserve of all Banks in the kingdom . . 39 Practice of loaning out Reserves of Banks, peculiar to this country . • • 39 Bankers' Balances with the Bank of Eng- land included among its Liabilities 39-41 Periodic demands for money . .41 Better arrangements with regard to Bankers' Balances and the Reserve might be made . . . 42 The subject of the balances which the bankers keep with the Bank of England requires some further examination. The amounts of these cannot be carried later than the year 1877, as the publication of the figures ceased with the close of that year. It is much to be desired that the publication of this information should be resumed, but meanwhile all that can be learned from the consideration of the manner in which these balances have accumulated must be obtained by the examination of what has already been made public. This will be found of service in enabling us to understand better what is the position of the reserves held by the banks of this country. Some further remarks on this point will be found in the next chapter. There has never been any distinct arrangement made between the Bank of England and the bankers as to the 34 CH. Ill] AVERAGES OF BANKERS' BALANCES 35 manner in which these balances should be dealt with. It might, generally speaking, be said that they were held on the basis of the ordinary arrangement between a banker and his customer as to a credit account — that the balance should be withdrawable whenever required. The annual averages of the bankers' balances for the period that they have been made public are given jn col. 19 of Table 3, p. 13. For convenience of reference they are repeated here. TABLE 5. Annual Averages of London Bankers' Balances with the Bank of England, 1844-1877. Proportion of London Bankers' Balances to £ 1844(1844=100). 1844 .... 997,000 . . . 100 1845 1,256,000 128 1846 1,558,000 160 1^47 1,467,000 150 1848 2,359,000 241 1849 2,131,000 218 1850 1,656,000 170 1851 1,666,000 170 1852 3,184,000 326 1853 2,259,000 231 1854 2,692,000 275 185s 3,065,000 313 1856 3,032,000 310 1857 3,274,000 335 1858 4,639,000 475 1859 4,256,000 435 i860 4,283,000 438 1861 4,185,000 428 1862 5,030,000 515 1863 4,726,000 ■ 484 1864 • 4,899.000 . 502 1865 5,038,000 . 512 1866 6,259,000 641 1867 6,689,000 . 685 1868 6,801,000 6g6 1869 • 6,479,000 663 1870 6,618,000 . 678 1871 8,390,000 ■ 859 1872 7,609,000 ■ 778 1873 8,586,000 . 878 1874 . 8,341,000 ■ 854 1875 . 10,324,000 ■ 1^55 1876 . 11,851,000 . 1,212 1877 • 9,543.000 ■ 976 36 BALANCES OF LONDON BANKERS [CH. Ill There were many occasions, principally between 1857-77, on which the balances of the London bankers with the Bank were fully as large as, and some on which they were distinctly larger than, the reserve of the Bank of England. Thus : — On nth November, 1857, the Bank of England reserve was and the London bankers' balances On 1 6th May, 1866, the Bank of England reserve was and the London bankers' balances On 31st October, 1877, the Bank of England reserve was . and the London bankers' balances ;£ 1,462,000 Jt,61fifi00 1,203,000 7,980,000 9,678,000 10,069,000 The last statement shows in a very remarkable way the manner in which the balances of the London bankers have continued to expand. October, 1877, was a very severe time of pressure, and the amount of the bankers' balances then shown was by no means the largest in the return of that year, but it still largely exceeded the amount attained during the panic of 1866. The details of the dates when the bankers' balances ex- ceeded the reserve are as follows : — Number of Times when the Bankers' Balances Exceeded the Reserve OF the Bank of England in the Years between 1844 and 1877. IS47 I 1856 2 1857 7 1858 2 1865 I 1866 20 I87I 4 1872 r 1873 6 1874 6 187s 9 1877 2 61 Divided into four groups of eight years each, the results are as follows : — ■ Number of Times when the Bankers' Balances Exceeded the Reserve OF the Bank of England. Years 1844-53 „ 1854-61 „ 1862-69 „ 1870-77 I II 21 28 61 CH. Ill] GROWTH OF BANKERS' BALANCES 37 The reader should compare this statement with the one showing the proportion borne by the bankers' balances to the re- serve, given in cols. 19, 20, and 25 of Table 3, p. 13, and the state- ments on p. 35. It is clear that the tendency of the bankers' balances to increase is entirely independent of years of panic or extraordinary pressure, and is the result merely of the natural growth of the business. Though no absolute panic occurred during the years 1870-77, there was grave anxiety at times, some of the causes of which are mentioned on p. 25, and the balances of the London bankers were more often larger than the reserve of the Bank of England during those eight years than in any of the similar groups of years which preceded. These figures also mark very distinctly that the growth of the balances of the London bankers increased, in the period during which they were published, progressively in a larger proportion than the reserve of the Bank of England. There is no doubt that they have continued to increase, and in a larger proportion, up to the present time. In an ordinary way people who read the weekly accounts of the Bank of England, which appear in the newspapers every Friday morning, do not remember this point ; it will therefore be advisable to show how large a part of the deposits of the Bank consists of the balances of the London bankers. As an illustration, the account for the week ending Wed- nesday, December 26th, 1877, is shown on p. 38. It has been selected as the most recent example which can be given of the proportion which the balances of the London bankers bore to the total deposits of the Bank up to the time when our know- ledge of this matter ceases. The publication of the amounts of the London bankers' balances has not been continued since the end of December, 1877. If the amounts held by bankers with the Bank, both in London and the provinces, were published every week, it would then be clear what the reserve really consisted of ; that is to say, whether it consisted of money belonging to the Bank of England itself, and kept to meet the demands which may at any time be made on it, or whether it consisted of the reserves of the other banks of the country, placed by them with the Bank of England for safe custody. If in the pub- 38 BALANCES OF LONDON BANKERS [cH. in lished accounts of the Bank the amount of the balances of the bankers were deducted from the ordinary deposits, and a corresponding deduction made from the reserve, as in the form of account given below, it would become obvious at once that, on the 26th December, 1877 — the latest statement respecting which these details are available — the deposits of the public with the Bank of England, instead of being 20 millions, were 11 millions, that the reserve available against the ordinary as distinguished from the banking portion of the liabilities was less than 3 millions instead of 1 1^ millions, and that the proportion of this reserve to the liabilities on deposits other than those derived from the bankers, instead of being 5 7J per cent., as the usual statement makes it, was only 23!- per cent. Bank of England. Account for the Week Ending on Wednesday, the 26TH Day of December, 1877. Arranged so as to Show the Proportion of the Reserve to the Liabilities after Deducting the Balances of the London Bankers from Both. Notes issued ISSUE department 38,231,530 38,231,530 Government debt Other securities Gold coin and bullion £ 11,015,100 3,984,900 23.231.530 38,231,530 banking department. Proprietors' capital Rest . ... Public deposits . Other deposits . 20,183,367 Less bankers' balances 8,695,000 Seven-day and other bills 14,553,000 3.073.356 5,942,869 11,488,367 306,037 35,363,629 Government securities . 13,383,176 Other securities . . 18,441,368 Notes . . 11,433,545 Less per contra 8,695,000 2,738,545 Gold and silver coin . . 800,540 35,363,629 Proportion of reserve to liabilities, shown in ordinary form, 57^ per cent. Proportion of reserve to liabilities, after deducting bankers' balances from both, 23|- per cent. It was mentioned above that the week's account of the Bank of England selected here as an illustration is merely taken as being the most recent in reference to which this com- parison can be made, and not for any other reason. It would CH. Ill] BANKERS' BALANCES AND THE RESERVE 39 have been easy to select the accounts of other weeks, in which the proportion borne by the London bankers' balances to the deposits generally, and also the proportion of the London bankers' balances to the reserve, would have been considerably larger than in the one chosen, and consequently the proportion borne by the reserve to the remainder of the liabilities would have been far smaller. Or again, it would have been easy to have taken a week's account in which the whole reserve was insufificient to meet the demands which might be made by the London bankers alone. The account of a week has been taken which is not an extreme instance in any way. If the ordinary liabilities of the Bank were distinguished from those incurred to its banking customers, attention would be more readily drawn to those occasions on which the bank reserve of the Bank of England was insufificient to meet the balances of the London bankers. But whether the accounts of the Bank of England are ever again published in such a manner as to show these details or not, one thing is clear — that the balances kept by other bankers with it cannot really form part both of its own reserve and of the reserves of the other banks as well. If these amounts are employed for the one purpose, they cannot be available at the same time for the other. These balances are the ultimate reserve of all the banks in the kingdom. There is no other country in the world, of which the banking system is known, in which the reserves of the banks are loaned out in the manner in which they are in this country. This has been the case here ever since banking in the United Kingdom assumed its present form. The practice has, therefore, the plea of usage in its favour, and the plea of usage is an extremely strong one ; but it is not one which should be followed implicitly when there are good reasons for a change. It might be undesir- able to say that these balances should never be loaned out ; but it is clear that they form that portion of the resources of the Bank which should be employed with the utmost caution. The balances of the London bankers with the Bank of England are included among its other liabilities. In another sense also, while these balances are practically, as previously mentioned, of the nature of " till money " — as far as transactions 40 BALANCES OF LONDON BANKERS [ch. m between the banks who own them are concerned — they form part, and by no means an unimportant part, of the general banking reserve of the country. These balances are the only reserve of ready money kept by the bankers of the United Kingdom beyond the amount of cash in their tills. It is not meant, of course, by this to suggest the idea that they are by any means the only resources which the bankers of the country would have to fall back on in any time of pressure. The amounts held at " call," and the amounts readily available in other forms, are very large — far larger than any of the figures now before us for consideration. But, as far as actual hard "cash" is con- cerned, the balances at the Bank of England are the only source from which an immediate supply of " money " can be obtained by the bankers of the country to meet any immediate need beyond what they themselves hold in their own vaults. It is not by any means the whole of these balances which are available to meet such an immediate need. The bankers have to bear in mind that a " working balance " has always to be main- tained against the demands which may arise on account of the clearing (see p. 22, and Chapter IV. p. 44). And to include the amounts which these balances represent among the reserves of the Bank of England, and also among the banking reserves of the country at large, is really to reckon them twice over. In order to illustrate this for the period over which information on the subject is available, namely from 1844 to 1877, a state- ment has been drawn up showing the proportion which the reserve would have borne to the liabilities if the bankers' balances had been deducted both from the reserve and the liabilities, and also of the proportion which the bankers' balances bore to the reserve. These show the position in which the Bank of England would have stood if the London bankers had held their own balances in Bank of England notes, or in gold in their own safes. It has not been possible, in the space to which this state- ment is of necessity confined, to exhibit what the effect of making up the accounts of the Bank of England in this manner would have been on every weekly return of the Bank from 1844 to 1877 ; but the general effect is shown in cols. 24 and 25 of Table 3, p. 13. Col. 24 contains the proportion which the CH. Ill] BANK RESERVE ALSO RESERVE OF OTHER BANKS 41 average annual reserve of the Bank of England would have borne to the liabilities if the balances of the London bankers had been deducted from those liabilities and the same amount were deducted also from the reserve. Col. 25, p. 13, shows the proportion of the bankers' balances to the reserve. The gradual and progressive diminution in the proportion of reserve kept to the liabilities in general has been already noticed ; but from the figures recorded in these columns we may see how much greater and more marked, especially in recent years, that diminution would have been, had the accounts of the Bank been made up in such a manner as to distinguish the ordinary from the special banking liabilities. The average reserve of the Bank of England would, if the bankers' balances had not been included in it, have been on average in 1875 but 6 per cent, of the liabilities, and in 1866 but 3 per cent. (Table 3, cols. 24 and 25, p. 13). We may thus see clearly how largely the reserve of the Bank of England is composed of money which is really also the reserve of other banks, and retained against other liabilities than those which appear in this account — liabilities which, of banks in the United Kingdom alone, are many times larger than those of the Bank of England, and have increased very rapidly in recent years, having been estimated in 1844 as about 70 millions, in 1856 as 200 millions, in 1866 as 350 tnillions, in 1873 as 800 millions, in 1902 as about 1,000 millions. From a banking position, there is no doubt economy in making the Bank of England keep the reserve of the bankers, but it is equally certain that, from a general point of view, the doing this tends to place the stress of every pressure which occurs always on one point — a point on which many and varied demands all concentrate — demands for domestic and foreign needs, the requirements for harvest wages and autumn holiday-makers in England, of farmers in Scotland, of dealers in Ireland, the requirements of great nations forming and increasing their gold circulations, the demands for gold for export as well as for the internal cir- culation of the country. Of these demands, those caused by the periodic fluctuations of the note circulation of the Scotch and Irish banks are specially linked through the provisions of the Bank Acts of 1844-5 with the fluctuations of the 42 BALANCES OF LONDON BANKERS [ch. hi reserve of the Bank. This subject requires a more special treatment than can be accorded it here, and it is dealt with in Chapter XII., p. 112. The more general demands are referred to in Chapter XIV., p. 138, which describes the "Autumnal Drain" of specie from the Bank. Great un- steadiness in the value of money is the result. Several useful suggestions have from time to time been made on this matter, and by those whose opinions deserve careful consideration. But the vis inertice which in this case would have to be overcome is a remarkably powerful force. It can only be hoped that those who feel the importance of the subject will keep it steadily before the public, till an arrange- ment is agreed to better suited to the necessities of the case than the present most inadequate method. I am glad to see the matter referred to in the paper on the Short Loan Fund of the London Money Market, read before the Institute of Bankers by Mr. J. Herbert Tritton, on February 5th, 1902. Much discussion will no doubt have to take place before any- thing practical is done, but keeping the subject thus before the minds of business men will assist in arriving at a satisfactory result. It is to be hoped that we may not require the expe- rience of another panic, with all its miseries and all its losses, the extent of which none except those who have experienced the real brunt of such a season of trial can appreciate, before a better arrangement is arrived at. Still it is best to place on record some suggestions as to what might be done. If our banks were to keep their own reserves, and publish their accounts weekly or monthly, the reserves held would undoubtedly be much larger than they are now, and business would be on a far more solid footing, and more even in its tenor. Such an arrangement is hardly likely to be arrived at, and the plan would be open to some objections. The banking business of the country has been carried on so long on the One Bank Reserve system that so great a change as this could not be lightly undertaken. But if the committee of the Clearing House were to publish the collective amounts of the bankers' balances with the Bank weekly, together with the statement of the Clearing House Returns, this might be useful. If the balances were sum- CH. Ill] INFORMATION ON BANKERS' BALANCES DESIRABLE 43 marised in one total the knowledge of the amount could be dangerous to no one, and would even diminish the risks to which we are exposed in any time of pressure. There is a great danger at such times to our highly complicated banking system from alarm among the ill-informed and ignorant. Their anxiety would be soothed by a knowledge of the large re- sources held by the banks ; and to those who have the conduct of the business such information would be of signal service. A knowledge of the position of the shoals and breakers to be avoided in his course, and of the position of the channel through which he may steer his ship in safety, useful at all times to the pilot, is essential among the additional perils of the storm. CHAPTER IV THE BALANCES OF THE LONDON BANKERS WITH THE BANK OF ENGLAND. HOW FAR THEY FORM AN EFFICIENT RESERVE Correspondence between Lord Aldenham (Mr. H. H. Gibbs) and Professor B. Price on the Bankers' Balances . 44-4S Portion of Balances of Bankers at the Bank of England only there for " safe custody" . . . 45-46 PAGB Normal and Abnormal Balances of Bankers 45 Large part of Bankers' Balances rather " Till Money " than Reserve . 45-46 Bankers' Balances should be entered under a separate beading in accounts of the Bank . . . 46-4? Duty of the Bank — Protection of Reserve 47 Considerable information of a very interesting character as to the manner in which the balances of the London bankers with the Bank are regarded by the Bank directors, is given in some letters written by Lord Aldenham, then Mr. H. H. Gibbs, a well-known director of the Bank of England, pub- lished in an appendix to a book written by the late Professor Bonamy Price.* These letters form part of an animated and interesting correspondence between Lord Aldenham and Professor B. Price, on the Bank rate, the influx and efiflux of gold, the " regulation of the currency," and other kindred sub- jects. It is not necessary to enter into the consideration of all these questions at the present time ; we will content ourselves with examining mainly two points which are discussed in the letters, namely, the manner in which the Bank of England views the bankers' balances kept with it, and the proportion of these sums which they consider they may make use of in the ordinary way of business. The opinions of any director of the Bank, and especially of a past-governor of such experience and standing * Chapters on Practical Political Economy. Political Economy in the University of Oxford. By BoNAMY Price, Professor of London : C. Kegan Paul and Co., 1878. 44 CH. IV] LORD ALDENHAM ON BANKERS' BALANCES 45 as Lord Aldenham, are very valuable, and no apology is needed for quoting from a book which is open to the whole world to read. The correspondence at the point alluded to turns first on the question whether the custody of such large sums as the bankers keep on their accounts at the Bank of England may not cause some difficulty or even danger to the Bank. Lord Aldenham in referring to this, and to the fact that the bankers' account is really an extremely easy one to arrange for, commences by remarking that "next to the Government account, the account of the collective bankers is the most certain and the most intelligible. . . . We know of the bankers, better than of any account in our books, what is the minimum balance wherewith they can live. They must have X on their account (a quantity unknown to all but us), and x-y therefore — never appears. But if x-^y is seen, then we know that y must remain untouched and uninvested ; must, in fact, form an addition to our reserve; x is ours for profit if we like to use it, but y is ours only for safe custody. Where is the danger ? On the other hand, the possession of that account is of the greatest importance to us, as affording the most perfect and accurate measure of how far the public can at all act independently of us." The italics are in the book quoted from. In a later letter Lord Aldenham explains " that up to a certain point {x)" the normal balance of the bankers, was perfectly intelligible to the Bank ; " {y), their abnormal balance, is an element of doubt." These remarks made by Lord Aldenham appear to confirm the advisability of the step which has been recommended above, namely, that the bankers should decide that everything which they keep in hand beyond their working balances should not be placed to the credit of their clearing accounts with the Bank, but should be retained weekly under a separate heading, and not appear in the statements of the Bank. Such a separation would mark out at once what was really "reserve," and what was only nominally "reserve." The bankers' balances up to the point which Lord Aldenham speaks of, and which may approximately be estimated from the out- side, are really not reserves to them at all ; they are merely "till money" on a scale commensurate with their operations, 46 BALANCES OF LONDON BANKERS [cH. iv relatively, that is, to the demands which may be made on them at any moment in settling the clearing balances. This would be seen immediately if business in the city were conducted now as it used to be up to the date when the clearing demands were still settled by the payment of the actual notes, not by means of a cheque drawn on the Bank of England. No one could call the sums held in bank notes in the safe, or the drawer near the counter, for that purpose, a "reserve." The notes were merely " till money," and " till money " the amounts which represent them still remain, though for their own convenience the banks have advanced a step beyond their primitive practice, and have agreed to divest themselves of the actual custody of the notes, and to keep the money itself in Threadneedle Street. It is impossible to call the sums thus held by the Bank, which represent cash merely held to meet immediate claims on the bankers, a reserve. Nor is anything beyond these sums, the clearing balances as they may be described, of much use to the Bank of England. The bankers have frequently large sums on their accounts beyond what they require for settling the daily clearing demands. These sums, and they are often very large, are a real reserve to them. But in consequence of uncertainty as to the length of time this money may remain with the Bank, it is to be supposed that the directors do not feel justified in employing the part of the sum which exceeds the " minimum balance " in the same manner as they do the part which they know must remain fixed. This amount, Lord Aldenham says, and truly, with a most proper feeling of the line of action the Bank should always take, "is ours only for safe custody." Now if there is an axiom to be observed in banking, it is that things should always be regarded as they really are. To have a balance in your hands which you cannot use is a hindrance to business, and not a help. The bankers' balances in 1876 fluctuated nearly ten millions between their lowest and their highest point, and as the lowest may be taken as approximating to the necessary amount which has always to be maintained, it is clear that a very serious responsibility, without any corresponding advantage, must have been imposed on the Bank. To have placed these sums under a separate heading would, by Lord Aldenham's own showing, have been CH. iv] RATE OF DISCOUNT AND PROTECTION OF RESERVE 47 no detriment to the Bank, while the doing so would have tended to the increase of that comparatively small amount of " unused money," the smallness of which is so constant and so real a danger to business in this country. After all, the point perhaps of most importance in the decision of the Bank directors on the subject of their discounts, which is dealt with in the next chapter, is how far their present intention of governing their dealings in the matter of discounting by the strict rules of supply and demand can be reconciled with their old practice of protecting the reserve when needful, irrespective of the rate of interest ruling in the market. The two things seem hardly capable of being recon- ciled with each other. The market rate for " money " may be very low, and yet a demand for bullion for export may set in which may require that the rate should be raised. In circumstances like these — and they may occur any day — which course are the directors to follow? It cannot be doubted that the Bank will be faithful to its old traditions and protect the reserve. But considering the vast sums continually float- ing in the outside market, and the sudden and large demand which may arise at any time out of exchange operations, the Bank might in all fairness call on those who have so large a share in regulating the outside market to co-operate with it in providing a proper reserve to meet the demands which these operations are at times certain to entail. One thing is clear, that the fixing the rate of discount, and the custody of the reserve which is influenced by that rate, should be in the same hands ; and if the rate fixed by the other banks influences the market more than it used to do, as appears to be the case, — then the responsibility of providing an adequate reserve should be shared between them and the Bank of England. CHAPTER V THE PUBLISHED RATE OF DISCOUNT OF THE BANK OF ENGLAND Change made in 1878 as to the fixed Minimum Rate of Discount at the Bank of England . . 48 The Bank Rate down to 1839 . . 49 The Bank Rate between 1839 and 1844 . 49 " New System of Discounting " in 1844 . 49 Line taken by the Bank with regard to re- lative position of Market Rate to Bank Rate in 1844, 1848, 1857, 1878 . 49-50 Drawbacks to a published fixed rate . 51 Announcement by the Bank as to re- discounting for Bill-Brokers, practice in 1878 and 1890 . . . 51 This unfavourable to quiet working of the Money Market - . . -52 Banks on the Continent, Re-discount freely with Central Sank — convenience of this arrangement . . . 52 Bankers hardly Discount for their custom- ers now so regularly as previously S2-53 Development of Bill-Broking . 52-54 The directors of the Bank made, in February, 1878, a change in their mode of business with respect to discounts, by announcing that they would no longer feel bound to adhere to the rule of maintaining a fixed minimum rate as closely as they had done. This has had in some ways a considerable effect both on their own transactions and on the money market at large, and is not unlikely to have more in the future. To investigate the reason for this change it is needful to go back some years, and to trace the practice of the Bank with regard to discounts from the year 1844. The most authentic record of the history of this is to be found in the reports and evidence given before Parliamentary Committees, as the opinions of those who appeared before those Committees are preserved there in their own words. Thus the Report of the Committee of the House of Lords on Commercial Distress, Session 1847-8, contains a historical statement of great value on these questions. The report of the corresponding Committee of the House of Commons, also 48 CH. v] BANK RATE A CENTURY SINCE 49 dated in 1848, was referred to in the opening chapter of this volume. In some respects the report of the House of Lords is the more weighty document. It was deemed of so much importance that it was reprinted in 1857. From it may be learned that for more than a century, down to the year 1839, the Bank rate never exceeded 5, nor fell below 4 per cent. During the pressure of 1839 the rate was raised for some months to 6 per cent, but it was reduced to 5 per cent, in January, 1840, and remained at 4 or 5 per cent, as before, till after the Bank Act was passed. At that date the market value of money was, and had been for some time previous, considerably below the Bank rate, so much so, in fact, that the Bank was entirely "out of the market." According to the evidence of Mr. H. J. Prescott, the deputy-governor of the Bank at the time, the Bank did not then hold " above two or three hundred thousand pounds of discounts in London, the market rate being at that time not above if to 2 per cent." The actual sum is mentioned as being ^113,000 in August, 1844, when the Bank rate was reduced to 2^ per cent. This was the date at which the " new system of dis- counting," as Mr. Prescott termed it in his evidence, was adopted by the Bank. The novelty of the system consisted in the fact that the Bank commenced from the autumn of 1844 to adapt its own rate to the market rate, and with such effect that the governor of the Bank, Mr. James Morris, in giving evidence on the same occasion as Mr. Prescott, con- sidered that by 1848 the Bank held half the discounts then in the market. "I consider," were Mr. Morris's words, "that in London the discounts by other parties, the great discount brokers and bankers, must be equal to the amount which the Bank holds under discount." And, in answer to another question, Mr. Morris added, " I think that the discount brokers and other parties afford altogether to the public an amount of discount equal to that afforded by the Bank, except in times of extreme pressure." These observations made by the governor and the deputy- governor of the Bank in 1848 show what the position of the Bank of England was towards the outside market some fifty years ago. They are supplemented and supported by the 50 THE PUBLISHED RATE OF DISCOUNT [ch. v remarks made by Mr. Samuel Jones Lloyd (afterwards Lord Overstone) at the same date, when examined before the "Com- mittee on Commercial Distress" of the House of Commons. Mr. Lloyd's evidence was to the effect that the Bank had at that time become more of a competitor in discount business than formerly, owing to the fact that it made its own rate con- form to the fluctuations in the market rate more closely than it used to do. "The Bank rate," Mr. Lloyd said, "formerly was 4 or 5 per cent. ; if the market rate of interest was below 4 per cent., the Bank ceased to discount till it got up again to that point. But in point of fact, latterly the discount department has become a very active department of the Bank." Mr. Lloyd's evidence thus confirms the statement which Mr. Morris had made. This describes the position of matters in 1848. No great alteration had occurred in it for nine or ten years, when the Select Committees of the House of Commons of 1857 and 1858 collected further evidence on the working of the Bank Acts. Mr. David Barclay Chapman was examined before the Committee of 1857; by his evidence it appears that the rate charged by the Bank of England in 1857 was not, as it is at present, almost invariably above the outside rate, but that it worked more nearly in unison with it, being sometimes a little above and sometimes a little below the market rate. When the Bank rate was very low the market rate was a little lower, and when the Bank rate was very high the market rate was a little higher. The evidence of Sir David Salomons before the Committee of 1858 was to the same effect as that of Mr. Chapman, and showed that the Bank rate conformed fairly closely to the market rate at that period. The question asked by Mr. Hankey and answered by Sir D. Salomons on the subject was as follows : — " Do you believe that the Bank of England has generally led or followed the current rate of interest in the London market ? — I think they sometimes have led and sometimes have followed ; generally they are supposed to follow, but I think that sometimes they have led" (1199). In 1857, however, the first signs of divergence between the Bank rate and the market rate appear to have occurred. Sir D. Salomons stated that in December, 1857, the London CH. v] DRAWBACKS TO PUBLISHED FIXED RATE 51 and Westminster Bank had deviated from the principle of working in accordance with the Bank. His words were : " We at that time altered our system. We do not now follow so closely the Bank rate ; we have, as far as we can, broken from it, adopting what may be called an expedient rate, not following the Bank rate so closely as hitherto we have done" (1145). (Evidence before Select Committee of House of Commons on the Bank Acts, 1858.) These statements of Sir David Salomons show the direc- tion in which matters were tending in his time. The facts are shown in Table 4, p. 33. Gradually it became a question whether the publication of a fixed rate by the Bank of England had not become as much an anachronism as a permanently fixed rate was in the year 1844. When a fixed rate was published by the Bank, people could tell at once whether they could get their business done cheaper elsewhere, and in this period of sharp competition, such knowledge, is enough of itself to deter them from coming to a bank, the rate of which they know already. The Bank lost that power of delicate adjustment of its position to the precise needs of the moment, which is essential to the maintenance of business. It cannot, as it were, feel the pulse of its customers as closely as if its rate were not advertised ; it cannot follow so well the distinctions made between one class of paper and another as it could — did a hard and fast rule not exist. When, in February, 1878, the Bank announced, as men- tioned above, that it would no longer feel bound to discount at the published minimum rate, it made a further and perhaps more important alteration by letting it be known that it would make advances to the bill-brokers when desired, reverting in this to its practice before March, 1858. This was extremely convenient for the bill-brokers, and is understood to have been used more frequently and for larger sums since the further change of the Bank's practice in 1890. Previous to July, 1890, the Bank made advances to bill-brokers and discount companies on bills, but would not discount the bills outright. In 1890 the Bank announced that the brokers, etc., would be allowed to offer for discount at not less than the published rate, bills not having more than fifteen days to run. 52 THE PUBLISHED RATE OF DISCOUNT [ch. v The currency of the bills has since been extended by degrees to sixty days. When a banker requires a broker to repay him his " Call-Money " the only source from which the broker can obtain the requisite supply is from the Bank of England. The broker cannot expect to be able to obtain the sum in the open market, as all available resources there are, as a rule, employed up to the hilt. He therefore goes to the Bank of England, pledges what are virtually the banker's own bills, and thus is enabled to repay the banker. These bills may have but a very few days to run, but the broker cannot wait till they have matured. The banker must have his money, and the broker must find it. The broker has no reserve of unem- ployed money. He cannot afford to keep a reserve, as he allows interest at a higher rate than the banker does on all his deposits. Hence a demand for a comparatively small sum makes a stir, disproportionally large, in the money market. This arrangement is not favourable to the quiet working of the money market. If the custom generally followed on the Continent prevailed in this country, and bankers laid them- selves out to discount freely for their customers, feeling at liberty to re-discount these bills whenever needed with the Bank of England, all the work of intermediaries would be saved, and business would be on a sounder foundation. It is the custom of banks in foreign centres, as at Berlin, to re- discount thus habitually. The arrangement is a good one in many ways ; it helps the central bank to keep in touch with the smaller business houses which surround it, and it enables those houses to carry on their business with perfect smoothness. The smaller banks in foreign business centres re-discount as a matter of course with the central bank, which is thus supplied with a large mass of perfectly dependable and rapidly maturing paper; but in London if it were known that a bank, even of the highest standing, habitually re-discounted with the Bank of England, it would at once be held to be "in extremis." In times of panic and peril such things, of course, have to be done, but in the ordinary way of business no London banker ever dreams of such a thing. The result is that while some London bankers discount, and to large sums for their CH. v] GROWTH OF BILL-BROKING 53 customers, others do not do so, and the customers, many of very high standing, go to the bill-brokers. There are several causes which have led to this. In the first place the habit of a banker's discounting for his customers has been to a certain extent discontinued, if not dropped, while side by side with this the bill-broker has stepped in and found his opportunity. He can be depended on with certainty, while the reply of the customer's banker may be that he is "not dis- counting to-day." People do not like being met with this kind of answer from their bankers. They are far more independent than they were some twenty or thirty years since. They know that the brokers are always ready to discount, and will quote them the exact market price. The banker may not always follow this as closely as the broker. A very fractional difference nowadays is sufficient to send a man from his banker to the broker. The broker discounts the bills with money which belongs to the banker, who afterwards very probably receives the paper as "security bills" from the broker. The London bankers have, to a great extent, built up the business of the bill-brokers by the course which they have taken of entrusting large sums to their care. The bankers have spared themselves some considerable labour by this, and though they have made a smaller profit from their transactions, they have gained by the being able to devote a closer attention to their business generally. There are also, it must be remem- bered, the banks outside the business centre of the City, who hold large sums of money without possessing such means of employing them as the City banker does. Their requirements have also to be considered. The present division of the work of our money market between bankers and bill-brokers appears likely to continue. While on the one hand there is an increasing tendency towards the exclusion of intermediaries in business, there is on the other a tendency almost equally strong towards specialisation. The bill-broker devotes his whole time and thought towards his subject ; he knows not only the character and standing of the houses whose acceptances he is willing to take admirably well, but he becomes able to prognosticate very closely and with great shrewdness the future position of the money market, and arranges his dealings accordingly. He 54 THE PUBLISHED RATE OF DISCOUNT [ch. v keeps his eye fixed not only on the position of affairs in this country, but on that in other countries as well. A knowledge of the course of the foreign exchanges is a great assistance to success in the business. But the practice of the bill-broker to work without a reserve necessarily tends to focus any large demand for money immediately on the Bank of England. The description of their business given by Mr. Samuel Gurney before the Committee of the House of Lords on Commercial Distress, Session 1847-8, and the Committee of the House of Commons also on Commercial Distress, 1848, and by Mr. David Barclay Chapman before the Committee of the House of Commons on the Bank Acts, 1857, shows how different this was from the business of the bill-broker at the present time. Both Mr. Gurney and Mr. Chapman were partners in the house of Overend and Gurney at the time of its highest prosperity. The great development of the business of bill-broking, money dealing, as it more properly should be called, has taken place since that time. Meanwhile, the competition for bills in the discount market is beyond question extremely sharp at the present day. There are several large joint stock companies formed for the purpose of carrying on this class of business, and the number of private firms engaged in it seems also to grow. Various circumstances — the increasing supply of money, the power of dealing by means of telegraphic transfers, and other business arrange- ments — have all tended to limit the supply of bills, which is distinctly smaller now in proportion to the supply of money than it was thirty or forty years since, whilst the competition for those bills which are in the market is closer than ever. CHAPTER VI THE PUBLISHED RATE OF DISCOUNT OF THE BANK OF ENGLAND AND THE RESERVE The Published Rate of Bank not so clear a guide to Market Rate as formerly SS-56 Value of opinion of Bank Directors on fixing Rate . . • • 57 Constitution of Governing Body of Bank of England . . . 57-58 Mr. Bagehot's remarks thereon . . 58 Continuity in management needed . . 58 Bank should observe a settled policy . 58 Constitution of Governing Body of Bank discussed in the Report of the Select Committee of the House of Lords on Commercial Distress, 1847-8 . 58-60 "Want of Permanence and of Consist- ency" in System of Government of Bank commented on in that Report . Need of Authoritative Rate Joint Committee representing Bank and London Bankers could fix rate . Competition for Deposits by Banks un- desirable . ... Unduly High Rate of Interest on Deposits cause of danger Fixing the Rate and keeping the Reserve should go together Practice of the Associated Banks of New York of publishing weekly average of reserves . ... 60 61 61 61 62 62 63 As mentioned in the last chapter, the Bank of England an- nounced in February, 1878, that it would, when occasion required, discount for those of its customers who transacted business exclusively with it, at a rate lower than that advertised as the official rate. One result of this has been that the Bank rate is less a real guide to the value of money than it used to be, since it is impossible to say how far the published rate is being adhered to. Events had been gradually drifting in this direction for some time past. The outer market, which is compelled to regulate its actions by the strict law of supply and demand, has constantly recognised this fact. Thus, in November, 1877, the metropolitan joint stock banks formally acknowledged that they could not remain bound by the old rule of allowing interest on deposits at " one below Bank rate," and undertook for the time an independent course of action. It is only needful to look in the money articles of the daily papers 55 S6 RATE OF DISCOUNT OF THE BANK OF ENGLAND [ch. vi to see what occurs when the Bank of England alters its rate. This is still regarded by the other banks as a sign that a change should be made, though not so closely as in former years. Thus, on June 6th, 1901, the Bank lowered its rate from 4 per cent, to 3^ per cent., and the joint stock banks dropped their deposit rate to 2 percent. On June 13th the Bank reduced its rate from 3^ per cent, to 3 per cent, and the joint stock banks reduced theirs to i^ per cent. But such a proof as the one just mentioned of the inability of the outside market to accept the Bank rate as an index to the real value of money, important as it was as a sign of the gradual breaking up of the traditional rule which had governed the English money market generally for years, is of far smaller importance than an official recognition by the Bank directors that the Bank itself can no longer be bound by its own rate. This, or nothing at all, is the outcome of the recent alteration in the practice of the Bank, and since it cannot be supposed that the Bank announced the alteration, and had to meet the objections which were certain to be made to it, without intending to abide by its decision, and to act upon it, the con- clusion appears to be that the Bank rate by itself is distinctly less a guide to the value of money than it used to be. The system which has thus almost come to an end commenced in the year 1844. Up to that date the Bank rate had been almost always a fixed rate, which for more than a century was never raised above 5 per cent., or allowed to drop below 4, irrespective of the market rate of the period. In 1839, a 6 per cent, rate was charged for some little time, but with that exception what may be regarded as the original state of matters continued till 1844, when the establishment of the principle of a rate to fluctuate according to the wants of the market was as great an innovation as the decision of the Bank in 1878. Ancient prestige, actual pre-eminence of capital, the fact that they are the bankers of the Government and the issuers of the only description of notes which are legal tender throughout England and Wales — all these circumstances enabled the Bank to take a position which gave its announcement as to a rate of interest a great if not a preponderating weight. The Bank of England told CH. VI] FREQUENT CHANGES IN BANK RATE 57 all the monetary world what it would charge for money, and all the monetary world in degree followed it. Sometimes it has happened that the directors have not been right in their decisions, and have lowered the rate when they should have advanced it, or advanced it or lowered it when they ought to have remained where they were. Sometimes they have worried the market by needless alterations. Thus there were in the year 1873 no fewer than twenty-four changes in the Bank rate, that is to say, twenty-four changes in twelve months. It is difficult to imagine what events can possibly have occurred to justify an alteration in the price of money once a fortnight during a whole year. Since 1890, however, there have never been more than twelve changes in the twelvemonth Again, what may be called an experimental rate once occurred, as in 1 87 1, when 2^ per cent, was charged for four weeks, the only time when a " quarter " rate has been officially announced.* Putting, however, these occasions aside, the decision of the directors of the Bank as to the value of money generally carries great weight with it. In a market so delicately balanced as ours, in which the causes of change are so numerous and often so unexpected, even the best informed must occasionally err. But the directors, as a body, are men of high standing and of much experience, acting with a strong sense of the responsi- bility of their position, and with considerable opportunities of observing what the demand for money is likely to be. The fixing the rate is indeed one of the portions of the work of carrying on the business of the Bank which such a body of men as the Bank directors are likely to do best. A committee of men with great and varied commercial experiences, fluctuating but slightly from year to year, with a head appointed for two years — which is, broadly speaking, the constitution of the Bank court — is very well constituted to judge of the value of money from day to day. It is not so well constituted to meet the greater difficulties which banking has nowadays to contend with, and which appear to require that a permanent governor should be appointed to maintain a more complete control over * These points are also dealt with in Chapter X., p. 95, which contains Table 13, pp. 98, 99, showing the changes in the Rate of Discount charged by the Bank of England and the number of days at each Rate. 58 RATE OF DISCOUNT OF THE BANK OF ENGLAND [ch. vi the business of the Bank than can be done by any body of directors, however able and well selected. The constitution of the governing body of the Bank of England is a subject which has been frequently discussed, and it seems impossible to speak on this subject at all without saying something about it. The remarks on it by Mr. Bagehot in his well-known work, Lombard Street, are well known. His opinion was that the appointment of a permanent deputy- governor " would give to the decision of the Bank that fore- sight, that quickness, and that consistency in which those decisions are undeniably now deficient," and, it should be added, would secure the continuity in the management which is so much needed. Much must necessarily be left to the individual authority of the governor, who is usually a cautious man, with a well-trained business mind ; but — as an example it is a most dangerous thing that one governor of the Bank should be able to say that he will, in time of pressure, make advances on Consols, and that another should, under similar circum- stances, be at liberty to decline to do so. A settled sound policy, firmly carried out, is needed, and this should be secured. Mr. Bagehot's remarks appeared some thirty years since. Few persons, however, remember that the subject was under the consideration of the Select Committee of the House of Lords appointed to consider the Commercial Distress which cul- minated in the panic of 1847. The report of that Committee, published in 1848, reprinted in 1857, is a singularly able and well-reasoned document. The Bank Act of 1844, a new and comparatively untried measure in 1848, came naturally under discussion. The question whether any remedial measures to meet the serious evils which followed the crisis of 1847 were possible was considered by the Committee. I need not apologise for quoting from their remarks, keeping the formal arrangement of capital letters in the document, which looks so strange to modern eyes. They entered on this branch of their subject with a recognition of "the Duty and Obligation of maintaining at all Times the practical Convertibility of the Bank Note." They considered this the first and most essential object to be kept constantly in view. The practical questions which arose were, " Whether this great Benefit is attained with CH. VI] HOUSE OF LORDS' CRITICISM ON BANK SYSTEM 59 Certainty? Whether it is attained by proper Means, and whether the restrictions of the Act of 1844 are not attended with grievous and unnecessary Evils of a collateral Kind?" That many of the provisions of that Act were judicious was readily accepted by the Committee, but the attempt " to enforce by Law, under all Circumstances, one fixed and inflexible Rule for the Management of a national Bank of Issue, seems incon- sistent with the best written Authorities, with the general Principles of Economic Science, as well as with the Testimony of many Witnesses of Practical Knowledge and Experience." ... " It is difficult, in the Judgment of the Committee, to appeal to more demonstrative Evidence on this Subject than is to be found in the Treasury Letter of the 25th October [1847]. That Letter was a practical Repeal by an Act of Authority of the restrictive Clauses of the Act. It appears impossible at once to defend the restrictive Provisions of this Act, and to justify the Letter, which in this respect abrogated, or at least suspended, those very restrictive Provisions. The Committee consider that those Restrictions materially aggravated the Pressure and produced the Panic of October, 1 847. But even if those Restrictions were originally defensible when enacted, their Hold on Opinion, as well as their Authority in Practice, had been materially impaired by the Letter by which they were superseded — by its acknowledged Necessity and by its un- deniable Success. The Precedent is established, and its Appli- cation will inevitably be called for on other occasions." The report continues, " To leave these Cases, when they do arise, to be dealt with by the irregular Exercise of the mere Authority of the Crown and its Advisers, setting aside . . . the express provisions of a distinct Statute, appears wholly inconsistent with that Fixity and Order which it is, or ought to be, the Object of all Law to secure." Two suggestions were "made to the Committee ; the one an absolute Repeal of the Act of 1844, the other a Continuance of the Act, accompanied by a Power of Relaxation." As the Committee were of opinion that many of the provisions of the Act were judicious, it was the second proposition which they advocated. They discussed the plans which had been suggested by which such a relaxing power might be exercised. These resolved themselves prac- 6o RATE OF DISCOUNT OF THE BANK OF ENGLAND [ch. vi tically into three, " a legalised Authority vested in the Govern- ment ; in the Government and in the Bank conjointly ; or in the Bank of England alone. . . ." The " third proposal (which in the Judgment of the Committee is preferable to either of the two first), namely, vesting this Discretion in the Bank of England, cannot be disposed of without giving some Con- sideration to the Constitution of the Bank of England. The Objections which have been often urged against the Bank, more especially if entrusted with a Discretion like that now under Consideration, are a Want of Permanence and of Con- sistency derived from its System of periodical Elections of Governors and Deputy-Governors — the evil Consequences of filling those high and important Offices as well as the Appoint- ments to the Committee of Treasury, by a mere Rotation of Seniority — and the intimate Connection subsisting between the Directors and the Commercial World of London, which may cast on them a Degree of Pressure difficult at Times to be resisted. It appears further to be apparent from the evidence that the immediate pecuniary Interest of the Proprietors as a Trading Company may at Times supersede or control larger and higher Considerations. This ought not to be . . . No narrow Views of the mere pecuniary Interests of its Proprietory should exclusively control its Action." These remarks, made by a Committee of the House of Lords now more than half a century since, show for what length of time the subject of the constitution of the governing body of the Bank has been under consideration. The same points which required attention in 1848, the want of per- manence and consistency in the management, the danger that the immediate pecuniary interests of the proprietors as a trading company might supersede larger and higher considerations were felt as strongly immediately after the passing of the Act of 1 844 as they could be now. No personal criticism, of course, is intended in these remarks ; they apply naturally to the circum- stances under which the management of the Bank is carried on. The length of time that has elapsed doubtless shows how difficult it is to arrive at any satisfactory settlement of the question, which is now more important than at any previous period of our business history. CH. vi] STANDARD RATE FOR MONEY NEEDED 6i A distinct statement of policy on the part of the Bank as to the course of action they would follow in any time of business pressure, as well as on many other points, is now greatly needed. The Bank may carry out habitually the decision it is understood to have arrived at in 1878, and admit that it cannot fix a definite rate for advances. In this case it will be difficult to establish any other representative body in London whose resolutions as to the rate to be charged on bills would carry exactly the same weight as the decisions of an independent body, such as the directors of the Bank. The inconvenience, however, of there being no recognised standard for the rate to be charged for money would be very great. It is far safest for all bankers, and for those who do business with them, that there should be such a standard. Since the Bank has let it be known that it does not mean to be guided by its own rate at all times, it may become needful to consider what standard can be established as a substitute for that guidance which will no longer exist exactly in the same form for the future, and what is to take the place of the public notice of the Bank rate. The bankers and bill-brokers of the metropolis seem the fittest persons to judge of the value of money, and the decision of a committee appointed by them, working together with repre- sentatives of the Bank, would be the best substitute that could be found for the decision of the Bank Court. It would, in fact, be the opinion of that court, strengthened by the judgment of those who had the best means of knowing what rate should be charged. This opinion would be more authoritative than that of the Bank of England alone. The rate to be allowed on deposits would naturally follow. This should be fixed not only for London, but for the country districts as well. Such an arrangement would tend to check any undesirable competition for deposits, and would tend to a uniformity of action between all the bankers of the country generally, and of the metropolis in particular. All the banks would be repre- sented on the committee proposed, and their representatives would concur in the rate to be recommended. Much has been said on both sides of the question as to whether the allowing interest on deposits, and the consequent enormous accumulation of money in the hands of banks, is a desirable thing or not ; 62 RATE OF DISCOUNT OF THE BANK OF ENGLAND [cH. vi but the allowing interest on deposits is so entirely the rule that the question is now not whether the practice is or is not a desirable one, but how it can best be regulated for the general advantage. Again, such an arrangement would tend to check an unduly high rate of interest being allowed on deposits. The rate would be known as that which a representative and prudent body of bankers thought it safe to adopt. Any bank deviating from the rule would be bound, as it were, to show cause why it did not follow the example set by such a body of men. The Banking Committee would not be likely to re- commend an unduly high rate. Such a rate is dangerous for two reasons : the one, because an unduly high rate of interest has a tendency to cause those who allow it to seek unsafe but highly-paying securities ; the other, because it has a tendency to cause reserves to be pared down to a minimum. While speaking on this subject, it is well to mention that every now and then it is understood that banks have made no profit whatever on the sums they held on deposit. No doubt any bank so circumstanced holds other sums belong- ing to its customers on which no interest is allowed, and from which and its other resources it derives the means of meeting its expenses and paying its dividend. But to have the custody of vast sums, with all the attendant risks, without any resulting profit to set against these, cannot be a desirable or a safe thing. In part the plan proposed here has been carried out for some considerable time. A committee, composed of represen- tatives of the metropolitan joint stock banks, meets when a change in the Bank rate is announced, and fixes the rate to be allowed on deposits in London. It is desirable that this arrangement should be carried further, and that a uniform rate should be arranged at these meetings for all deposits held by banks whether in London or in the country. To conclude, fixing a rate can hardly be separated from the custody of the reserve. The metropolitan banks might have elected, now that the Bank rate stands in so altered a position, to work without a recognised rate at all as to allowance of interest on deposits. But the inconvenience of such a course would have been so great that they have been compelled to CH. vi] NEW YORK BANKS PUBLISH RESERVES 63 devise the method mentioned above of establishing a recognised standard, which in time may, it is to be hoped, be carried further till it includes all the banking offices throughout the country. A further advantage of the method here sketched out would be that it would facilitate the formation and main- tenance of a suitable reserve. The maintenance of such a reserve is a duty inseparable from the functions of the body on which lies the responsibility of fixing that rate which is the recognised standard for the rest of the community. The pub- lication of the balances kept by the Clearing Bankers with the Bank of England would be an assistance to the attainment of this. In reference to this question, it may be mentioned by way of illustration that the Associated Banks of New York habitually publish weekly the average amount of their own reserves in specie and legal tender notes. By the National Bank Acts of the United States, which govern the administration of these banks, a fixed legal minimum has to be held in this manner. It is therefore a far more serious thing for the Associated Banks of New York to publish their figures, which may show that their reserves are below the legal limit, than it would be for the English banks to publish the amount of their balances with the Bank of England, which they keep at the point which each bank fixes for itself. In the case of the American banks the legal minimum is a strict and rigid line. In the case of the English banks, the amount is left to their own discretion. The practice of the American banks is merely quoted here by way of illustration. Their action is a proof that publication tends towards safety and need not be regarded as any occasion for alarm. CHAPTER VII BILLS DISCOUNTED AND TEMPORARY ADVANCES OF THE BANK OF ENGLAND Capital, etc., of Bank of England JJi millions . . . . 64 Deposits held by Bank how employed . 64 Division of Securities held by Bank into "Government" and "other" securities 64 Mr. Thomson Hankey's remarks on Investment of Deposits of Bank . 65 Amount of Railway Debentures, about 4 millions in 1865 . . . 65 Fluctuations in the amount of Bills dis- counted . . . . 66 Estimated amount of Bills in circulation, including foreign bills . . 66-67 Influence of Bank of England on Dis- count Market formerly greater than at present . . . . 67 PAGE Bills discounted and " other" securities . 67 Discounters of Bills have recourse to Bank mainly in times of difficulty and pressure 67 Temporary advances made by the Bank of England indicate immediate wants of business . . . . 67 Fluctuations in temporary advances . 67-68 Fluctuations from week to week . . 68 Influence of periods of pressure distinctly marked . . . . 68 Desirability of continuing information as to Bills Discounted and Temporary Advances from 1875 onwards . . 68 Bank of England in same position as any other bank with regard to its private business . . . . 68 The manner in which the deposits held by the Bank are em- ployed requires our attention. The capital and accumulated and undivided profits of the Bank of England (the " rest ") amount together to about 17^ millions. The securities held by the Bank of England are divided in the usual weekly statements between the two heads of " Government " and " other " securities. It has not been thought necessary to make any further analysis of the Govern- ment securities held by the Bank than that given in Chapter II., p. 27, as a large proportion of these securities, and, in par- ticular, those held in the circulation department, are so per- manent in amount for long periods that no detailed statement appeared likely to be generally useful. The "other" securities are not included among the statements of monthly averages 64 CH. vii] DISCOUNTS AND TEMPORARY ADVANCES 65 on which a great part of this analysis is based, but as an investigation into their amount will be of service, the yearly averages have been tabulated from the ordinary weekly returns. The total annual average amount of the " other " securities will be found in col. 26 of Table 3, p. 13. The increase in the sums thus held is large, and in a general way proportionate to the increase in the deposits. Mr. Thomson Hankey intimated, in his remarks on the working and management of the Bank of England, that, while the deposits of the Bank should be invested in good banking securities, such as bills of exchange, loans for short periods on good securities. Government stocks, etc., the capital may be invested in securities of a more permanent description. " With regard to the investment of the capital, no part of this is re- quired to be kept in reserve : all may be invested in interest- bearing securities, which should be of undoubted character, but not necessarily of the same readily convertible nature as that part which is held liable to recall of deposits." — Hankey, On Banking, pp. 13, 14. The bills discounted and temporary advances have been separated in the tabular statement from the remainder of the " other securities " to as late a date as the published returns permit. It will be observed that the portion of the "other securities" which does not consist of bills discounted or of temporary advances, the annual average of which is given in col. 28 of Table 3, p. 14, fluctuated less in amount for the years 1873 to 1875, the last for which the information can be given, than the "bills drscounted" or the "temporary advances." Guided by Mr. Thomson Hankey's remarks, we may sup- pose the sums indicated in col. 26 to be invested in loans to corporations for local improvements, to railways on deben- ture stock, in securities of colonial governments, and in other securities more or less of a permanent character. Mr. H. L. Holland, deputy -governor of the Bank, stated in 1865 that the amount of railway debentures held at that time was about 4 millions. The fluctuations in the total amount of the " other " securities, as compared with those held in 1844, will be found marked in col. 27 of Table 3, p. 13. We now proceed to consider the amount of bills discounted F 66 BILLS DISCOUNTED AND TEMPORARY ADVANCES [ch. vii by the Bank of England. The yearly average of these, from 1844 to 1875, is given in col. 30 of Table 3, p. 14. Col. 31 contains the proportion of the yearly average to that of 1 844, and col. 32 shows the proportion of the bills discounted to the total of the "other" securities. The bills discounted never amounted to half of the total of the "other" securities. On average they were something like a third of these. The information about the amount ceases in 1875. The fluctuations in the amount of bills discounted was very considerable during the period over which our information extends. The amount for 1868 was only about one half that of 1866, and was very nearly similar to the average of 1845. There are larger fluctuations also shown in the weekly statements than those between these annual averages. In 1866 the highest amount was about 16 millions, the lowest about 7 millions. » 1867 „ 8 „ 4^ „ » 1868 „ 7 1. 4 II If 1869 „ 7 II 4 II I. 1870 „ 10 „ s „ II 1871 „ II „ 4 „ II 1872 „ 9 „ 4 „ .1 1873 „ 12 „ 4 „ II 1874 „ 6 „ 3 „ II 187s II 6 11 2 >i There was a considerable increase in this branch of the business of the Bank between 1844 and 1875, after which year no information as to the amount of the bills discounted has been published ; but it will be observed that the average of the three years, 1845-47, rather exceeded the average of the three years 1873-75, and the whole amount, though large, can form but a very small part of the total amount of bills, both inland and foreign, in circulation. The amount of these bills in circulation, including foreign bills, was estimated by myself as being from 300 to 350 millions in 1873. The total now in circulation (in 1902) probably scarcely exceeds, if it even reaches, the smaller of these figures. Mr. Newmarch's estimate in 1851 was that the corresponding amounts of bills in circulation then were from 180 to 200 millions. During the twenty years between 1850 and 1870 they had largely increased, but it is not believed that the amount of bills now in circulation has kept up at all in proportion to the increase CH. vii] INFLUENCE OF BANK LESS THAN FORMERLY 67 in business generally. The difference in the arrangements of business nowadays and those existing in 1873, and the manner in which the official returns as to bill stamps are now made up, render it difficult to form any reliable estimate of the account of bills in circulation. The position, speaking broadly, appears to be that there are fewer bills now afloat than before in proportion to the amount of banking money held, and that there is a far keener competition for them. The influence of the Bank of England in the discount market has in times past been considerable ; but its influence in this direction would not appear to be so large as in some other portions of its business, since its discounts had not increased in the same proportion as the bills themselves, nor had the discounts of the Bank continued to increase during the later years in which the published returns enable us to trace the business of the Bank in this particular. A large portion of the deposits, it is believed, has been invested in more permanent securities. The proportion of bills dis- counted to "other" securities is given in col. 32 of Table 3, p. 14, and it will be observed that the proportion of the re- sources of the Bank placed in bills rather diminished in the later years over which our information extends. The table exemplifies the fact, which is generally known, that it is in times of difficulty and pressure that discounters of bills have recourse to the Bank. In 1847, 1857, and 1866 the amounts were large. There are beyond doubt private houses, as well as public companies, who do a larger business of this description than the Bank of England. In ordinary seasons the outside market is willing to accommodate its customers on slightly lower terms ; and, in discounting bills, those who do the business at the lowest figure are sure to have the preference. The immediate wants of business are, perhaps, to be found most distincriy indicated among the temporary advances made by the Bank of England, shown in col. 33 of Table 3, p. 14. No branch of business of the Bank appears to undergo greater fluctuations than this one, and in none are the influences of periods of pressure more distinctly marked. The amount for 1872 was three times as large as that in 1844. The business done in 1852 was not a sixth part of that done twenty years later. 68 BILLS DISCOUNTED AND TEMPORARY ADVANCES [ch. vii The steady growth of this branch of the business was very re- markable during the last ten years of which the particulars can be given. The annual averages will be found in col. 33 of Table 3, p. 14, and the proportion of each year to the amount in 1844 is given in col. 34. The fluctuations from week to week are far greater than those shown by the yearly averages. In 1866 the highest amount was about 8 milHons, the lowest about i million. 1867 „ 4 „ I 1868 „ 4 1869 „ 5 1870 „ 9 1871 „ 6 1872 „ 10 1873 » 7 1874 „ 8 1875 .. 9 The extension of the scale on which business has pro- ceeded is curiously marked by the increase in the fluctuations during the later years in which this information was given. The requirements of occasional borrowers were actually greater, and the yearly averages higher, in the years 1870 and 1872 than even in the panic year of 1866. It is much to be regretted that the information as to the amounts of bills discounted and of the temporary advances, given in the returns up to 1875, is now no longer supplied, and that it is not possible to trace this subject any further. After all, the Bank of England is, with respect to its private business, exactly in the same position as any other bank. It has only a certain definite sum which it can lend, and this it must husband, and not make advances which do not naturally turn themselves into money — as those made on good bills do — on the same terms as advances of the class we have been speaking of The resources of the Bank are very considerable ; but if it made over-large advances on securities of a fixed character, it would experience the inconvenience of doing this just as any other bank would do. CHAPTER VIII NOTE CIRCULATION OF THE BANK OF ENGLAND, BULLION HELD IN THE ISSUE DEPARTMENT, AND THE ENGLISH COUNTRY NOTE CIRCULATION Note Circulation of the Bank of England, Bullion held in the Issue Department, and the English Country Note Circu- lation. Description of Table 6 69-72 Table 6. Monthly Averages of Note Circulation of Bank of England, 1845- 1900 . ... Table 7. Monthly Averages of Bullion in the Issue Department 1845-1900 Increase in Note Circulation of the Bank of England , ... Bank of England Notes in Circulation in London and the Provinces. These notes take the place of lapsed country note issues . ... Increase in Note Circulation compared with increase in Metallic Circulation . Mr. Newmarch's estimate of Metallic Circulation . ... Other estimates of this Fluctuations in Bank Note Circulation. Times of diminution, 1879- 1885 ; Times of increase, 1894-1900 . Bank Act of 1844 intended to suppress English Country Note Circulation Disadvantages of this Composition of Circulation of Bank of England Notes . . 74-76 Table 8. Monthly Averages of English Country Note Circulation, 1845-1900 . 75 70 71 72 PAGE Increase in use of smaller notes . . 76 Bullion held by Bank . . . 76 Increase in Bullion held . . . 76 Proportion of Annual Average of Bullion and Annual Average of Banking Lia- bilities . . . . 76 Proportion of Bullion held to Deposits and Circulation . . 76-78 Relation between Bullion held and Bank Rate . . . . 76 Table 9. Showing Composition of Bank of England Note Circulation, 1856-76 77 Strength of the Bank dependent on Pro- portion borne by Specie to Total Lia- bilities . . . . 78 Proportion smaller in 1900 than in 1894 . 78 Separation of Issue Department from Banking Department ; some results of this . . . . 78 Silver Bullion formerly held by the Bank 78 Question as to Desirability of the Bank again holding Silver Bullion in con- nection with low quotation for Indian Exchanges . . • • 79 Silver more distinctly " money " in Europe in 1844 than at present . . . 79 Table 10. Annual Averages of Silver Bullion held in Issue Department of Bank of England, and proportion of the same to the Gold Bullion and Coin held during the years 1844-53 ^n» 37, Not including those held in the Banking Department CH. VIIl] BULLION IN ISSUE DEPARTMENT 71 TABLE 7. Monthly Averages of Bullion in the Issue Department of the Bank of England, from 1845-1900, divided into groups of Ten Years, 1845-54, 1855-64, 1865-74, 1875-84, 1885-94, a°d ol Six Years, 1895-1900, with Summary Table, 1845-1900. 1845-54. 1855-64. 1865-74. 1876-84. Month. Average for the Ten Years, ;£i4,62S,ooo. Av.of Ten Years = 100. Average for the Ten Years, ^£13,645,000. Av.of Ten Years = 100. Average for the Ten Years, ;£i9,356,ooo. Av.of Ten Years = 100. Average for the Ten Years ;S24,436,ooo. Av.of Ten Years = 100. January . February . March . April May June July . . August . September October . November December £ 14,815,000 14,833,000 14,996,000 14,372,000 14,175.000 14,839,000 14,945,000 14,637,000 14,557,000 14,111,000 14,394.000 14,824,000 102 gS 97 102 102 100 100 g6 9S lOI £ 13,112,000 13.354.000 13,789,000 13,714.000 13,634,000 14,263,000 14,256,000 14,102,000 14,170,000 13,438,000 12,778,000 13,132,000 9t g8 lOI 100 lOI 10s 104 103 104. gS g6 £ 19,236,000 19,138,000 19,169,000 18,650,000 18,345,000 19,928,000 20,212,000 19,935.000 20,196,000 18,881,000 18,903,000 19,685,000 99 99 95 103 J04. 103 104 ^i gS 102 £ 23,206,000 23,620,000 24,291,000 24,398,000 24,160,000 25,218,000 26,049,000 25,767,000 25,690,000 24,458,000 23,268,000 23,109,000 95 97 99 100 99 100 106 105 100 95 95 Difference : Highest and Lowest Month, ;£88s,ooo. Mean of extreme Variations for 1845-54, 3-57. Difference: Highest and Lowest Month, ;£r,4Bs,ooo. Mean of extreme Variations for 1855-64, 5-57. Difference : Highest and Lowest Month, ;£:, 867,000. Mean of extreme Variations for 1865-74, 4'57. Difference : Highest and Lowest Month, ;£2,940,000. Mean of extreme Variations for 1875-84, 5 '57= 1885-94. 1895-1900. 1845-1900. Month. Average for the Ten Years, ;£22,883,000. Average of Ten Years, = 100. Average for the Six Years, ;£34,'49.ooo. Average of Six Years, = 100. Average for the Fifty-six Years, ,£20,613,000. Average of Fifty-six Years, = 100. January February March April May Tune July August September October November December £ 21,020,000 22,491,000 23,339,000 22,823,000 22,634,000 24,578,000 24,929,000 23,924,000 23,563,000 22,052,000 21,609,000 21,641,000 9^ gS J02 100 99 107 log 105 g6 94 95 £ 33,690,000 35,476,000 35,470,000 33,512,000 34,249,000 35,197,000 35,023,000 35,205,000 35,557,000 32,806,000 32,035,000 31,575,000 99 104 104 gS 100 103 103 103 104 g6 94 g2 £ 19,929,000 20,486,000 20,869,000 20,368,000 20,267,000 21,419,000 21,679,000 21,337,000 21,341,000 20,112,000 19,674,000 19,881,000 97 99 lOI g8 104 105 ^03 103 gS g6 Difference : Highest and Lowest Month, ^£3,909,000. Mean of extreme Variations for 1885-94, 8-57. Difference: Highest and Lowest Month, ;£3,982,ooo. Mean of extreme Varia- tions for 1895-1900, 67o Difference; Highest and Lowest Month, ,£2,005,000. Mean of extreme Varia- tions for 1845-1900, 5% Gold Bullion in the Issue Department of the Bank of England. Difference hetween Mean of the the Highest Month and extreme Variations the Lowest Month. during each period. £ 7. 1845-54 885,000 S-5 1855-64 1,485,000 55 1865-74 1,867,000 4-5 1876-84 2,940,000 55 1885-94 3,909,000 P 1895-1900 . 3,982,000 6 1845-1900 . 2,005,000 5 72 NOTE CIRCULATION AND BULLION HELD [ch. viii to 1900 — with a summary table of the whole period. This shows how generally equable the note circulation of the Bank is. The highest months in the returns from July to October do not correspond with the highest months in the table of the rate of discount charged (Table 12, p. 97). They no doubt represent a demand arising from the annual "Autumnal Drain" described in Chapter XIV., Table 20, p. 138. Annual averages of the notes held by the public will be found in cols. 35, p. 14, and 37, 39, p. 15, of Table 3, which give the country circulation, the metropolitan circulation of the Bank of England, and the amount of both these united. The ex- tension of this portion of the business of the Bank was very small for more than twenty years. On average there had been hardly any increase up to 1864. Since then there has been a gradual growth, which advanced to 45 per cent, in 1900. The notes held by the public are issued partly in London, partly at the provincial branches of the Bank. The circula- tion has been divided under these two heads down to the close of 1 88 1. The returns accessible do not continue this division to a later date. Up to 1875 the increase in the circulation, as will be seen by col. 35, p. 14, took place rather in the country than in the London circulation, which will be found in col. 37, p. 15. While the provincial circulation in 1844 formed only 32 per cent, of the total circulation of the Bank, it formed in 1873 and 1874 about 39 per cent, and from 1878 to 1881 the provincial circulation formed 35 per cent, of the total. The whole note circulation of England and Wales, including the notes issued by the private and joint stock banks, was ;^28,420,ooo in 1844, ;if32,5oo,ooo in 1877, ;^32,40o,ooo in 1878, and ;^30,638,ooo in 1900, divided at that date between ;^29,396,ooo at the Bank of England and ^1,242,000 at the English country issuing banks. Hence the Bank of England notes issued at the country branches may in some degree have taken the place of lapsed local note issues, and this may account for the greater increase of the provincial than of the metropolitan note circulation. The total increase is, however, small — smaller than the augmentation in any other portion of the business of the Bank of England which these returns enable us to trace, and far smaller than the increase in the metallic CH. vm] FLUCTUATIONS IN CIRCULATION 1879-1900 73 circulation of the country, which was estimated as being about 105 millions in 1872, and from ;^ioo,ooo,ooo to ;ifi 10,000,000 in 1883,* by Mr. Newmarch as ;^36,ooo,ooo in 1844,! by Sir R. Peel as between ;^30,ooo,ooo and ^"35, 000,000 (H. of Commons, April 25th, 1845). While, therefore, the coin in circulation has increased something like seventy millions, the total note circulation of England and Wales was in 1900 only two millions larger than it was in 1844. It is also quite possible that this increase, small as it is, may prove to be only tem- porary, as fluctuations of from one and a half millions to two millions, and even of larger amounts, are not uncommon be- tween the average of one year and another in the note circu- lation of the Bank of England. The figures for the years from 1879 to 1885 are examples of this in the way of diminution, and those from 1894 to 1900 in the way of increase. Year. 1879 Notes of Bank of England held by the Public. Average. ;^29,2I2,000 Year. 1894 Notes of Bank of England held by the Public. Average. ;^25,30O,000 1880 26,915,000 1895 25,800,000 1881 26,321,000 1896 26,500,000 1882 25,985.000 1897 27,200,000 1883 25,568,000 1898 27,400,000 1884 25.358,000 1899 27,900,000 188s 24,667,000 1900 29,400,000 Table 8, p. 75, contains the averages of the English country note circulation from 1845 to 1900, divided into periods corresponding to those into which the other tables contained in this volume are arranged. The statement is brought in here, as this will be convenient to those who desire to see the details of the manner in which the note circulation of England is made up. Under the operation of the Act of 1844 the country note circulation has dwindled till, from being * Estimates based on Professor Jevons's statement, Investigations in Currency and Finance, 1884, p. 266 et seq. ; on statement of " Coinage of Gold for Twenty-four Years," Economist, 29th June, 1872 ; and on papers read by R. H. Inglis Palgrave, before the Bankers' Institute, February, 1883, on The Deficiency of Weight in our Gold Coinage, with a Proposal for its Reform, and November, 1884, on the Gold Coinage : Position of Matters at the Present Time. t TOOKE and Newmarch's History of Prices, vol. vi. p. 701. 74 NOTE CIRCULATION OF THE BANK OF ENGLAND [cH. vm (1845 to 1847) more than ;^7,ooo,ooo, it is now (1902) less than ;^87 5,000. The note circulation of the Bank of England has thus apparently hardly filled the void which the re- duction of the country note circulation has left ; and if the amount of the notes of the Bank of England held by the other banks in England as "till money" could be separated from the remainder, it is probable that the total amount of notes actually in the hands of the public is smaller now than it was some fifty years since. Nor is it advisable to leave this part of the subject without an expression of regret at the policy followed in framing the Act of 1844, which, instead of strengthening the country note circulation, was designed to suppress it, thereby increasing the demands on the reserve of the Bank at times when the note circulation tends naturally to expand, and simultaneously depriving English banks of a branch of their business particularly useful in the establishment of small branches in remote districts, and thus developing business and trade in places where this assistance is most needed. A reasonable stamp duty might have been charged for the exercise of this privilege, which might have produced a larger revenue to the Government than that re- ceived from the note circulation of the Bank, issued against securities under the provisions of the Act of 1844, beyond the ;^i4,ooo,ooo originally permitted by that Act. The notes could easily have been amply secured, and an advantage to business maintained. Scotland and Ireland have retained their provincial note issues. In England a different course has been followed, to the disadvantage of the country. The fluctuations in the English country note circulation have been small ; they do not exactly follow those shown in the circulation of the Bank of England, partly perhaps be- cause that has been more in the metropolis, while the country note issue was largely among the agricultural districts. Table 9, p. 'j'j, shows the amounts and the proportions of the different denominations of notes composing the circu- lation of the Bank of England for the years 1856-76, the earliest and the latest dates available. The large notes, it will be seen, formed in 1876 a smaller part of the whole circulation than they did twenty years previously. The notes from £20 to CH. vm] AVERAGES OF COUNTRY NOTE CIRCULATION 75 TABLE 8. Monthly Averages of Country Note Circulation, England, from 1845- 1900, in groups of Ten Years, 1845-54, 1855-64, 1865-74, 1875-84, 1885-94, and of Six Years, 1895-1900, with Summary Table, 1845-1900. 1845-54. 1855-64. 1865-74. 1875-84. Month. Average for the Ten Years, ;£6,794,ooo. Av.of Ten Years = 100. Average for the Ten Years, ;£6,344,ooo. Average of Ten Years= 100. Average for the Ten Years, ;£5,iz8,ooo. Average of Ten Years = lOO. Average for the Ten Years, ;£3,888,ooo. Average of Ten Years = xoo. January February . March April . May . June . July . . August September . October November . December . £ 6,862,000 6,731,000 6,748,000 7,117,000 7,002,000 6,676,000 6,658,000 6,494,000 6,625,000 7,130,000 6,885,000 6,601,000 lOI 99 99 ^05 103 ^t gS los lOI 97 £ 6,415.000 6,235,000 6,302,000 6,640,000 6,508,000 6,251,000 6,170,000 6,062,000 6,216,000 6,645,000 6,510,000 6,179,000 lOI 9S 99 los 103 gS 97 ^i 9S los 103 97 £ 5,268,000 5,112,000 5,085,000 5,375,000 5,272,000 4,963,000 4,886,000 4,826,000 4,955,000 5.375.000 5,236,000 5,061,000 103 100 99 los J^o3 97 95 94 97 'OS 102 99 £ 4,075,000 3,832,000 3,822,000 4,087,000 4,048,000 3,843,000 3,772.000 3,644,000 3,727,000 4,058,000 3,971,000 3,775,000 gS 105 104 99 97 96 J04. 102 97 Difference : Highest and Lowest Month, £636^000, Mean of extreme Variations for 1845-54,4-3% Difference : Highest and Lowest Month, ;£583,ooo. Mean of extreme Varia- tions for 1855-64, 5 % Difference : Highest and Lowest Month, ;£S49,ooo. Mean of extreme Varia< tions for 1865-74, 5*5% Difference : Highest and Lowest Month, i;443,oco. Mean of extreme Varia- tions for 1875-84, 5'5% 1885-94. 1895-1900. 1845-1900. Average for Average of Average for Average of Average for the Average of Fifty-six Years =100. the Ten Years, Ten Years the Six Years, Six Years Fifty-six Years, ;£3, 366,000. = 100. £1,446,900. = 100. ;£4.533.ooo. £ £ £ fanuary 2,432,800 103 1,474,000 102 4,639,000 102 February 2,335.100 99 1,438,000 99 4,484,000 99 March . 2,393,800 lOI 1,482,700 102 4,507,000 100 April . 2.479.900 los i,SS4.5°o 108 4,756,000 105 May 2,478.100 los 1,549,300 107 4,685,000 103 June . 2,353,400 99 1,457.700 lOI 4,457,000 gS July . . 2,315,100 98 1,384,500 96 4,402,000 97 August . 2,217,900 94 1,314,300 9' 4,291,000 95 September . 2,222,200 94 I.3S4.30O 94 4,385,000 97 October 2,420,000 J02 1,464,300 lOI 4,733,000 104 November . 2,417,000 102 1,482,200 102 4,627,000 102 December 2,327,300 9S 1,407.000 97 4,426,000 g8 Difference: t iighest and Lowe St Month, Difference : H ighest and Difference : H ighest and j£a62,ooo. Lowest Month, £ 240,000. Lowest Month, i ;46s,ooo. erne Variations fo r 1885-94, Mean of extr erne Varia- Mean of extr erne Varia- 5-5 7. tions for 1895-190 0, 8-5 V. tions for iS4s-ig< », 57. 76 NOTE CIRCULATION AND BULLION HELD [ch. vin ;^ioo remained comparatively stationary; the greater part of the increase was among the smaller notes, especially among those for ;^5. These, doubtless, as mentioned previously, in some degree have taken the place of the lapsed English country issues. To complete this analysis, the annual average of the total coin and bullion held by the Bank has been included. This average will be found in col. 41, Table 3, p. 15 ; the columns marked 42, 43, 44, and 45 show the proportions which the bullion has borne to the amount held in 1844, to the liabilities on deposits and bank post bills, to the note circulation, and to the total liabilities under these two heads combined. The pro- portion of the bullion to the liabilities is smaller now than it was in the earlier years over which this inquiry extends, while the amount of bullion held has more than doubled (Table 3, col. 42, p. 15). The monthly averages of the bullion held in the Issue Department are given in Table 7, p. 71. A considerable increase, but smaller on the whole than that in the reserve and than that in the deposits, will be observed to have taken place in the bullion held. It has been mentioned that there appears to be no general relation whatever between the amount of notes issued and the rate of interest charged. Nor is it easy to trace an exact relation between the amount of bullion held and the Bank rate. The average held in 1868 was more than 20 millions, with a discount rate of 2 per cent. ; the holding in 1873 '^^^ about 22 millions, with a rate of 4f per cent. ; the average held in 1876 was 28 millions, with a rate of about 2^ per cent. ; the average was, in round figures, 26 millions in 1893, with a rate of about 3 per cent, and 33 millions in 1898, with a rate of 3|- per cent.; and the differences shown by the weekly returns are greater still. Thus 7 per cent, was charged on 9th November, 1872, with £1^,^50,000 bullion held on the date of the nearest return, while 3 per cent, was charged on 4th November, 1869, with ;^ 18, 500,000, more than a million less, held in a similar way. Again, 3 per cent. was charged loth February, 1875, with 20 millions of bullion, and 5 per cent, was charged 17th October, 1877, with nearly 23 millions of bullion. Though the total amount of bullion held by the Bank is a very important thing, the rate of CH. viii] COMPOSITION OF NOTE CIRCULATION 77 TABLE 9.— Table shomng Composition of Bank of England Note Circulation. Divided according to the Denomination of the Notes in Hands of the Public from 1856 to 1876, the latest date to which this information can be given. t,i Notes. Propor- tion per Cent, to 1856. 1856 = 100. Propor- tion per Cent. of;£5 Notes to Total Circula- tion. t,\a Notes. Propor- tion per Cent, to 1856. 1856= 100. Propor- tion per Cent. of;£io Notes to Total Circula- tion. ;{;20tO ;£lOO Notes. Propor- tion per Cent, to 1856. 1856= too. Propor- tion per Cent. to ;£xoo Notes to Total Circula- tion. 1856 1857 1858 1859 1880 1861 1862 1863 1864 1865 1866 1867 1868 1869 1870 1871 1872 1873 1874 1875 1876 6,362,cxx) 6,386,000 6,299,000 6,678,000 7,079,000 6,673,000 6,799,000 6,7SS,ooo 7,099,000 7,403.000 8,153,000 8,290,000 8,429,000 8,572,000 8,695,000 9,182,000 9,704,000 10,045,000 10,474,000 10,877,000 10,920,000 100 100 99 los III los 107 106 IJZ lib 128 130 132 '35 137 '45 'S3 164 171 '72 7. 33 34 32 32 33 33 33 33 35 35 35 35 35 i 39 40 40 40 3,928,000 3,959,000 3,896,000 4,145,000 4,280,000 4,045,000 4,080,000 3,949,000 3,966,000 4,085,000 4,462,000 4,492,000 4,562,000 4,514,000 4,436,000 4,592,000 4,712.000 4,716,000 4,790,000 4,934,000 5,003,000 700 101 99 'OS log 103 104 100 lOI 104 "3 lib "S "3 "7 120 120 122 12b 127 7. 21 21 20 20 20 20 19 19 19 19 19 19 19 19 19 19 19 18 18 18 18 5,474,000 5,530,000 5,652,000 6,121,000 6,331,000 5,947,000 6,172,000 6,142,000 5,996,000 6,153,000 6,957,000 7,020,000 7,234,000 6,940,000 6,804,000 7,272,000 7,373,000 7,313,000 7,435,000 7,740,000 7,987,000 100 101 103 112 lib 108 "3 112 log 112 127 128 132 127 124 '33 '34 '33 '36 141 '45 7. 29 29 29 29 30 30 30 30 29 29 30 30 30 30 29 30 29 *i 28 28 29 ;eJOO to ;£5oo Notes. Propor- tion per Cent, to 1856. 1856= 100. Propor- tion per Cent, of ;f3oo to Notes to Total Circula- tion. ;ei,000 Notes. Propor- t tionper c Cent, to J 1856. J 1856= ICO. ^ ropor- onper ent. of Ci.ooo otesto Total ircula- tion. Total Circulation. Propor- tion per Cent, of Total Circula- tion to 1856. J 836= 100. 1856 ... 1857 ... 1858 ... 1859 ... 1860 ... 1861 ... 1862 ... 1863 ... 1864 ... 1865 ... 1886 ... 1867 ... 1868 ... 1869 ... 1870 ... 1871 ... 1872 ... 1873 ... 1874 ... 1875 ... 1876 ... 1,375,000 1,365,000 1,590,000 1,610,000 1,551,000 1,444,000 1,697,000 1,740,000 1,676,000 1,694,000 1,831,000 1,827,000 1,867,000 1,761,000 1,701,000 1,774,000 1,851,000 1,784,000 1,810,000 1,947,000 1,984,000 JOO I'll "7 "3 'OS '23 127 122 123 '33 '33 '3(> 128 124. i2g '3S 130 132 141 '44 7, 7 1 8 7 8 8 8 8 8 8 1,865,000 1,796,000 2,318,000 2,256,000 2,029,000 1,911,000 2,098,000 2,089,000 1,849,000 1,761,000 1,795,000 1,834,000 1,825,000 1,667,000 1,676,000 1,783,000 1,885,000 1,810,000 1, 775,000 1,849,000 1,839,000 TOO 96 124 121 log 102 112 112 99 ^i 9^ Z^ 89 gb lOI 97 95 ^l gS 7. 10 9 II II ID 10 10 10 9 I 8 8 7 7 7 7 7 7 I 19,004,000 19,036,000 19,765,000 20,810,000 21,270,000 20,020,000 20,846,000 20,675,000 20,586,000 21,096,000 23,198,000 23,463,000 23,917,000 23,454,000 23,312,000 24,603,000 25,525,000 25,668,000 26,284,000 ' 27,347,000 27,733,000 700 700 104 log 112 'OS log 108 108 III 122 123 12b 123 '23 '30 '34 '3S 144 146 Note.— For years 1856 to 1859, inclusive, these averages represent the first 15 weeks of each year ; from i860 to 1876, inclusive, the averages are of the virhole circulation of the year. 78 AVERAGE OF BULLION HELD BY THE BANK [ch. viii discount charged does not appear to be usually regulated by it alone. To render this more clear, the percentage borne by the annual average of the total coin and bullion held by the Bank of England to the annual average of the banking liabilities has been stated in col. 43 of Table 3, p. 1 5. The fluctuations shown are considerable; the proportion, however, hardly has had a tendency to increase, except in the years 1875-6. In 1852 the average of bullion was 2 per cent, more than the average of the banking liabilities. In 1847, 1856, 1864, and 1866 the average bullion held amounted to 65 per cent, of the banking liabilities. In 1857 it was only 57 per cent, of these. In 1900 it was 67 per cent. But though, generally speaking, the years when the average of bullion is low are those when the rate of interest is high, yet it is not possible to trace the same connection between the bullion and the rate of interest as between the banking reserve and the rate of interest. The proportion of the total coin and bullion held to the liabilities and circulation united is given in col. 45 of Table 3, p. 15. Though this point sometimes escapes observation, owing to the separation of the Issue Department from the Banking Department of the Bank, yet it deserves the most serious consideration. The strength of the Bank, in any period of pressure, depends largely on the proportion which the specie held bears to its total liabilities. It will be observed that the proportion which the bullion held bore to the liabilities and circulation united was the same in 1900 as it had been in 1844, and smaller than in the years between 1894 and 1897. What the accounts of the Bank would look like if the separation of the two departments did not take place is shown in the arrangement of the balance sheet printed in Table 40, p. 207. The Bank of England has sometimes held a considerable amount of silver bullion. The Bank is empowered by the third clause of the Act of 1844 to retain in the Issue Department an amount of silver bullion not exceeding one-fourth part of the o-old coin and bullion held. The Bank has never held so largre a proportion as this. The largest amount which it has held was ;i^2, 727,000 on October 3rd, 1846, when the gold bullion CH. viii] SILVER BULLION AT BANK OF ENGLAND 79 was quoted at ;^ 12,632,000, For the years from 1844 to ^^47 the silver bullion formed, however, a considerable fraction of the total amount of bullion held, and the annual averages from 1844 to 1853 are given in Table 10, p. 80. On August 20th, 1853, the silver bullion ceased to be quoted in the returns of the Bank of England, except during the period from November 28th, i860, to July 3rd, 1 86 1, when the Bank held some silver bullion, as shown in Table 10, p. 80. The heading and the space for the entry appeared weekly, however, in the return for many years afterwards. The question whether it might not be desirable that the Bank of England should hold silver bullion again was dis- cussed, some years since, in connection with the low quotation for the Indian exchanges. Should such an operation ever be undertaken by the Bank again, it may be supposed that it would not be done except under a guarantee from the Govern- ment, on whose behalf the business would be carried out. When the Bank Act was passed in 1844, "silver" was far more distinctly "money" throughout Europe than it is at the present time. 8o NOTE CIRCULATION AND BULLION HELD [ch. viii TABLE 10.— SILVER BULLION HELD BY THE BANK OF ENGLAND, 1844-53, 1860-61. Annual Averag^es of Silver Bullion Held in the Issue Department of the Bank of England and Proportion of the Same to the Gold Bullion and Coin Held during the Years 1844-53. Annual Year. Annual Average of Silver Bullion. Proportion per Cent, of Silver Bullion to Total Bullion Held. Average of Bullion, in- cluding. Gold and Silver Coin in Bank. ing Depart- ment. Proportion per Cent, of Gold and Coin to Total Bullion Held. Annual Average of Total Bullion and Coin. £ % £. % £ 1844 1,640,000 II 13,024,000 89 14,664,000 1845 1,511,000 10 13,732,000 90 15,243,000 1846 2,169,000 15 iz,6i6,ooo 8S 14,785,000 1847 1,373,000 13 9,055,000 87 10,428,000 1848 1,125,000 8 12,747,000 g2 13,872,000 1849 336,000 z 14,825,000 98 15,161,000 1850 195,000 1 16,441,000 99 16,636,000 1851 34,000 — 14,530,000 100 14,564,000 1852 28,000 — 20,559,000 100 20,587,000 1853 19,000 — 17,497,000 100 17,516,000 Gold Coin and Bullion and Silver Bullion in the Issue Department of the Bank of England, 18G0 and 1861. Year. Gold. Silver. Year. Gold. Silver. £ £, £ £. 1860. Nov. 28 12,725,000 336.000 1861. March 20 10,981,000 848,000 Dec. 6 12,419,000 511,000 it 27 11,054,000 848,000 }) 12 11,768,000 876,000 April 3 11,345,000 848,000 »» 19 11,456,000 1,114,000 M 10 11,525,000 848,000 If 26 10,640,000 1,454.000 >f 17 11,520,000 848,000 1861. Jan. 2 10,292,000 1,664,000 ») 24 11,437,000 890,000 )) 9 9,870,000 1,627,000 May 1 11,326,000 713.000 it 16 9.S3S>ooo 1,470,000 >l 8 11,302,000 713,000 )» 23 9,344,000 1,445.000 f > 16 10,883,000 663,000 30 9,560,000 1,282,000 >l 22 10,597,000 564.000 Feb. 6 9,745.000 1,268,000 »» 29 10,825,000 512,000 >» 13 9,903,000 848,000 June 5 10,658,000 412,000 If 20 10,240,000 848,000 »» 12 10,748,000 362,000 11 27 10,521,000 848,000 i> 19 11,155,000 262,000 March 6 10,303,000 848,000 i» 26 11,466,000 212,000 ti 13 10,596,000 848,000 July 3 11,150,000 71,000 CHAPTER IX THE RESERVE AND THE LIABILITIES OF THE BANK OF ENGLAND Proportion of Specie to Liabilities at the Banks of France, Germany, Holland, and Belgium . . . 81-84 Table 11. Monthly Averages of Lia- bilities and Reserve of the Bank of England, 1845-1900 . . 82-83 Division of Bank of England Account into Issue Department and Banking Department . . . . 84 Reserve of Notes represents the greater part of specie at command of the Bank 84 Reserve of Bank smaller than Coin and Bullion held . . . . 84 Fluctuations in the proportion of the Reserve to the Liabilities . 84-85 Description of Table 11. . 84-85 Comparison of Table 11 with Table 12 (Monthly Averages of Minimum Rate of Discount at Bank of England) and with Table 37 and Table 38 . .85 Summary of proportion of Reserve to Liabilities between 1845- 1900 . . 86 Number of Variations in the Rate of Discount between 1845-igoo . . 86 Mean of the Extreme Variations between 1845 and 1900 . . . 86 Years with greatest Fluctuations in the Rate, 1845-1900 . . . 87 Difference between Rate in Highest and Lowest Month and Mean of Extreme Variations, 1845- 1900 . Proportion of Reserve to Liabilities con- nected in general way with Fluctua- tions in the Rate charged Average Rate for each month during the fifty-six years, 1845- 1900 Proportion of Reserve to Liabilities at three dates of sharp pressure, 1847, 1857, and 1866 Act of 1844 only infringed in 1857 . Particulars of what occurred in these crises and also in 1890 . . 89-90 Low Bank Reserve accompanied by a, High Rate of Interest . General Averages of the proportions of Reserve to Liabilities and of London Bankers' Balances to Reserve when rates specified were charged, 1844- 1878 . ... Act to Indemnify Bank of England for excess issue over limit allowed in Bank Act, 1844, 1857 . . 91 Bill proposed by Lord Sherbrooke (Mr. Lowe) in 1873 to allow excess issue . . . 93-94 87 87 88 89 89 90 90 93 In considering the amount of the reserve of the Bank of England — that is, of the resources which it can employ to meet any demand for cash which may be made on it — a different course, owing to the form of accoimt which was ordained by the Bank Act of 1844, has to be followed from that which has to be used in examining the position of almost every other bank in the world.* In the case of the Bank of France, in that of the * The National Bank of Egypt divides its accounts in the same manner. G 81 82 LIABILITIES AND RESERVE, 1845-1900 [CH. IX TABLE II. Monthly Averages of Liabilities and Reserve of the Bank of England, 1845-1900. Liabilities : Average Average of Reserve : Average Average of Proportion of Average of 1846-64. for the Ten Years, Ten Years for the Ten Years. Ten Years Reserve to Ten Years i£l7,766,34i. = 100. £9,211,255. = 100. Liabilities 52% 5»7o="oo. January. ;^i7,920,30o lOI ;^9.I47.300 99 SI 98 ! February 17,891,200 lOI 9,545.800 103 S3 102 March . 19,386,000 log 10,186,100 III S3 102 April 17,608,300 99 8,510,600 g2 48 92 May 16,678,500 94 8,681,600 94 S2 100 June 18,416,100 104. 9,902,300 108 S4 104 July . . 17,076,700 gb 8,927,600 97 S2 100 August . 16,363,800 g2 8,897,300 gb S4 104 September 17,828,200 100 9,510,300 103 S3 102 October 17,284,100 97 8,189,000 89 47 90 November 17,269,900 97 8,843,400 gb SI 98 December 19,473.000 no 10,193,800 III 52 100 Difiference : Highest and Lowest Month, ;£3,iog,ooo. Difference : Highest and Lowest Month, £2,004,000. Mean of extreme Variations for 1845-54, qVo* Mean of extreme Variations for 1845-54, ^^ L- Liabilities : Average Average of Reserve : Average Average of Proportion of Average of 1866-64. for the Ten Years, Ten Years for the Ten Years, Ten Years Reserve to Ten Years ;£20,OIO,683. = 100. £8,487,116. = 100. Liabilities 427o 427o = 100 January. ;£'2O,OI9,O0O 100 ;^8,o3i,ooo 95 40 95 February 19,855,100 99 8,756,100 103 44 105 March . 20,968,300 los 9,429,100 III 45 107 April . 20,056,900 100 8,187,400 gb 41 98 May 19,479.800 97 8,395,000 99 43 102 June 20,762,500 104 9,444,000 lit 45 107 July . . 19,719.400 98 8,410,800 99 43 102 August . 19,106,100 95 8,435.600 99 44 105 September 20,312,200 lOI 9,018,400 10b 44 105 October. 19,527,500 97 7,405,700 87 38 90 November 19,363,600 97 7,490,200 88 39 93 December 20,957,800 105 8,842,700 104 42 100 Difference; Highest and Lowest Month, £1,862,000. Mean of extreme Variations for 1855-64, 5% Difference : Highest and Lowest Month, £2,038,000. Mean of extreme Variations for 1855-64, 127, Liabilities : Average Average of Ten Years Reserve : Average Average of Proportion of Average of 1865-74. for the Ten Years, for the Ten Years, Ten Years Reserve to Ten Years £25.835,283. = 100. £",177,150. = 100. Liabilities 437.. 437. =100. January. ;£'2S.749.40O 700 ^^11,323,900 101 44 102 February 25,346,400 g8 11,862,300 lob 47 109 March . 27,520,100 106 12,138,200 108 44 102 April 26,364,900 102 10,407,600 93 39 91 May 26,046,800 lOI 10,062,900 go 38 88 fune 27,793,600 107 11,961,200 107 43 100 July . . 26,505,000 102 11,146,700 100 42 98 August . 24,792,300 gb 11,172,300 100 45 105 September 25,541,700 99 11,758,800 105 4b 107 October 24,646,600 9S 9,688,900 87 39 91 November 24,081,900 93 10,643,700 93 44 102 December 25,634,700 99 11,959,300 107 47 109 Difference : Highest and Lowest Month, ;^3, 712,000. Difference : Highest and Lowest Month, £2,4^ 9,000. Mean of extreme Variations for 1865-74, j 1^ Mean of extreme Variations for 1865-74, ro"57 Liabilities : Average Average of Reserve; Average Average of Proportion of Average of 1876-84. for the Ten Years, Ten Years for the Ten Years, Ten Years Reserve to Ten Years £30,885,000. = 100. £13,669,000. = 100. Liabilities 447o 447. =100. January. i:30,544.ooo 99 ;f 12, 102,500 go 40 91 February 30,582,000 99 13.453.700 99 37 84 March . 33,675,000 log 14,648,200 107 43 98 April 31,523,000 102 "3.573.60O 99 43 98 May 30,334,000 g8 13,332,700 gb 44 100 June 31,764,000 103 14,695,300 108 46 105 July . . 32,018,000 104 14,715.800 108 4b 105 August . 30,209,000 98 14,492,200 lob 48 109 September 30,426,000 99 14,939,000 log 49 111 October. 30,980,000 100 12,909,600 93 42 95 November . 28,622,000 93 12,562,400 g2 44 100 December 29,942,000 97 12,486,300 91 42 95 Difference : Highest and Lowest Month, ^£5, 053,000. Difference : Highest and Lowest Month, £2,8 37,000, Mean of extreme Variations for 1875-84, 87,, Mean of extreme Variations for 1875-84, 9*57 CH. ix] MONTHLY AVERAGES, LIABILITIES AND RESERVE 83 TABLE II {continued). Monthly Averages of Liabilities and Reserve of the Bank of England, 1845-1900, with Summary Table, 1845-1900. Liabilities ; Average Average Reserve: Average Average ofl Proportion of Average of 1885-94. for the Ten Years, Ten Year- for the Ten Years, Ten Year Reserve to Ten Years ;£34,i99,ooo. = 100 ,£15,480,000. = 100. Liabilities 45°/ 457o=roo. January . ;^33.954.ooo 99 ;^i3,768,ooo 89 4' 91 February 33,814,000 99 16,127,000 104 48 107 March . 37,068,000 108 17,056,000 no 4b 102 April . 34,938,000 102 15,561,000 lOI 44 98 May 34,370,000 lOt 15,241,000 98 44 98 June 35,776,000 105 17,200,000 III 48 107 July . . 36,472,000 107 16,200,000 105 44 98 August . 33> 477,000 98 15,578,000 102 ^ 102 September . 32,603,000 95 15,854,000 102 49 109 October. 33,804,000 99 14,139,000 9' 42 93 November 31,867,000 93 14,465.000 93 45 100 December 32,245,000 94 14,572,000 94 45 100 Difference : Highest and Lowest Month, ;£5,2oi,ooo. Difference : Highest and Lowest Month, ;£3,432,ooo. Mean of extreme Variations for 1885-94, 7*57o Mean of extreme Variations for 1885-94, rr% Liabilities : Average PiSVi^Z^ of Reserve; Average Average of Proportion of Average of 1895-1900. for the Six Years, Six Years for the Six Years, Six Years Reserve to Six Years ;£si,3o6,ooo. = 100. ;£25, 890,000. = 100. Liabilities 50% 5oZ=ioo- January . ;^S2,OS5,000 ZOl ^^25,906,000 100 50 100 February 53,019,000 103 28,437,000 no 53 108 March . 55,145,000 107 28,299,000 109 5^ 102 April . 50,927,000 99 25,329,000 98 50 100 May 51,774,000 lOI 26,120,000 101 5' 102 June 52,813,000 103 26,929,000 104. 51 102 July . . 52,809,000 103 25.939.000 100 49 98 August . 51,442,000 100 26,136,000 101 51 102 September 50,)!32,ooo 98 26,845,000 104 54 108 October. 49,860,000 97 23,908,000 92 48 96 November 47,640,000 93 23,770,000 92 50 100 December 48,057,000 94 23,065,000 89 48 96 Difference : Highest and Lowest Month, ;C7)5o5>ooo* Difference : Highest and Lowest Month, ;£5,372,ooo. Mean of extreme Variations for 1895-igoo, 7% Mean of extreme Variations for 1895-1900, 10*5% Liabilities :_ Average Average of Reserve: Average Average of Proportion of Average of 1846-1900. for the Fifty-six Fifty-six for the Fifty-six Fifty-six Reserve to 56 Years Years, ;^28,478,ooo. Years = ICO Years, ;£i3,i33,ooo. Years = loo Liabilities 46% 4676=100. January. ;f 28,467,000 100 ;^r2, 485,000 9S 44 96 February 28,447,000 100 13,715,000 104 48 104 March . 30,662,000 108 14,364,000 109 47 102 April 28,758,000 ZOI 12,756,000 97 44 96 May 28,209,000 99 12,747,000 97 45 98 une 29^678,000 104 14,171,000 108 48 104 '. uiy • 29,192,000 102 13,386,000 103 46 100 August , 27,645,000 97 13,260,000 101 4S 104 September . 27,998,000 g8 13,783,000 los 49 106 October. 27,885,000 98 11,904,000 91 43 93 November 26,748,000 94 12,190,000 93 46 100 December 28,051,000 99 12,838,000 98 46 100 Difference : Highest and Lowest Month, ^£3,914,000. Difference : Highest and Lowest Month, ;£2,46o,ooo. Mean of extreme Variations for 1845-igcx), 7% Mean of extreme Variations for 1845-igoo, 9% 84 RESERVE AND LIABILITIES OF THE BANK [ch. ix Bank of Germany, of Holland and of Belgium, the amount of specie held by those banks is the first point to be compared with the liabilities. In their case the proportion between these two items is the main thing to be estimated, but with the Bank of England, owing to the division of the account into two parts — the Issue Department and the Banking Department — it is the amount of the reserve, that is to say, the amount of notes and coin held in the Banking Department, which has to be compared with the amount of the liabilities in that department in order to ascertain the specie which the Bank can dispose of in case of any pressure. The reserve of notes represents the greater part of the amount of gold at the command of the Bank ; this is not the whole amount of coin and bullion held, but only a part of it. The annual averages of these two items will be found in cols. 21 and 41 of Table 3, pp. 13, 15. The amount of the reserve of the Bank, col. 21 of this table, is considerably smaller than that of the bullion in the Issue Department, col. 41. The columns of proportional figures in Table 3 enable the reader to follow what the course of events has been ; thus, by comparing col. 12 with col. 22, p. 13, the reader is able to see at a glance that while the liabilities on deposits and bank post bills have increased nearly 3|- times between the years 1844 to 1900, the proportional numbers running from 100 to 345, the reserve has only increased 2^ times during the same period, the corresponding proportional numbers running from 100 to 251. Col. 23 shows this again in another manner. It contains a statement of the average yearly proportion of the reserve to the liabilities mentioned — namely, those on deposits and bank post bills collectively. The amount of the circulation is omitted from the estimate of the liabilities at this point because it is always assumed that the notes are sufficiently provided for by the specie and securities in the Issue Department. One of the first points which will strike the observer is that on average the amount of the proportion of the reserve to the liabilities became smaller for the years between 1855-94 than it had been in the years 1845-54, and that in the years 1895- 1900 the proportion closely resembled that in 1845-54. To make the course of events clear, the averages of the liabilities and the reserve have CH. IX] PERIODIC FLUCTUATIONS 85 been recorded in a separate table — Table 11, pp. 82, 83 — which gives the averages for each month in decennial groups with columns of proportional figures showing the proportion of the liabilities in each month to the average for the ten years, and the proportion of the reserve in the same manner for each period of ten years from 1845 to 1900, divided in the same way as all the other tables are throughout this volume. This table shows the proportion per cent, of the reserve to the liabilities during each month, and it contains the monthly proportion of this percentage for each month to the average for the year. The last division of this table, which extends from 1 845-1 900, contains a statement of the proportion of the reserve to the liabilities during the whole period under notice. A column has been added, which shows the proportion of the reserve to the liabilities for each month, and a further column is supplied which exhibits the fluctuations of the difference between the reserve and the liabilities, taking the average of these as equal to 100. A study of all these four columns of proportional figures is necessary to enable us to follow the history of what has occurred. In doing this, the footnotes to the divisions, 1845-54 to 1895- 1900, as to the difference between highest and lowest months and mean of extreme variations, will be an assistance. On average, it will be seen, by reference to the figures for the fifty-six years from 1844 to 1900, that the liabilities have been at their lowest point in the month of November, and that the proportion of the reserve to the liabilities has been at the lowest point during October and at a low point in November and December. The proportions of the monthly fluctuations during each year are also interesting. They trace to a great extent the financial history of each year. It will be necessary to compare with this table Table 1 2, p. 97, which shows the monthly averages of the minimum rate of discount of the Bank of England for the same period, divided into corresponding groups and dealt with in the same manner ; and also Table 37, p. 196, which gives the number of variations in the rate of discount, and Table 38, p. 197, which shows the lowest and highest rate charged and the extent of the fluctua- tions during each year. These two tables last mentioned contain similar information for the Banks of France, Germany, 86 RESERVE AND LIABILITIES OF THE BANK [ch. ix Holland, and Belgium. They will be useful also when we come to consider the rates which are charged by the other great banks of Europe, but at the present time we will confine our observations to the Bank of England. It will be observed that The Proportions of the Reserve to the Liabilities, 1845-1900, Table ^i,pp. 82, 83, were — 52 per cent. 1855-64 . • 5" . 42 1865-74 . • 43 1875-84 . ■ 44 1885-94 . • 45 1895-1900 . ■ 50 Thus in the last period (1895-1900) the proportion of the reserve to the liabilities corresponds closely to what it was in the first period (1845-54). The number of variations in the rate charged by the Bank of England was the same in each of these two periods, 1845-54 and in 1 895-1 900. The particulars are as follows : — Number of Variations in the Rate of Discount, 1 845-1 900, Table 13,/. 98. 1855-64 . . 89 1865-74 • 113 1875-84 . 66 1885-94 ■ 77 1895-1900 . 27 The correspondence of the number of variations in the last and in the first divisions of this table is fortuitous. The number of years in the first division was ten, and in the last only six. The tendency to fluctuation was greater in the later period than in the earlier one ; it likewise increased much in the intermediate years. The variations between the highest and lowest rates have also been considerable. They have increased in intensity in the same manner as the fluctuations have increased in number. Mean of the Extreme Variations between 1845-1900, Table 12, p. 97. 1845-54 7 per cent 1855-64 • 115 ., 1865-74 ■ 17-5 ., 1875-84 • • i8-5 „ 1885-94 • 25 1895-1900 ■ 21-5 „ CH. IX] FLUCTUATIONS AND VARIATIONS IN RATE 87 The greatest fluctuation in the corresponding period is as follows. The year in which it occurred is also mentioned in this case : — Greatest Fluctuation in Rate during Periods mentioned, Table 38,/. 197. 1845-54 1847 . . . 5 per cent. ^855-64 . . 1858 . . . s-s .. 1865-74 . 1866 ... 6-5 „ 1875-84 . . 1878 . . . 4 „ 1885-94 1889 • • . 3-5 » 1895-1900 . . . {^«99| . . . 3 „ The difference between the rate charged in the highest and lowest month of the same groups and the mean of the extreme variations for the same is shown in the following statement. These also show an increase in intensity. Fluctuations between Rate in Months in Periods mentioned. Table 12, p. 97. Difference betw een Highest Mean of the Extreme Year. and Lowest Month, Variations. £ s. d. 1845-54 9 5 • 7 per cent. 1855-64 I I 7 ■ "•5 >. 1865-74 . I 6 6 . 17s » 1875-84 • I 3 8 . ■ i8-5 „ 1885-94 I 12 I 25 .. 1895-1900 . I 6 I 21-5 .. On the whole, the fluctuations between one month and another have tended to be more severe of recent years, though they were less severe in 1 895-1 900 than in 1885-94. While there can be no doubt that the proportion of the reserve to the liabilities is connected in a general way with the rate that is charged, yet it will be seen from this sum- mary that it is not the sole cause which regulates the fluctuations in the rate. The general principle, however, applies — the larger the reserve has been, the smaller the number of fluctuations, and in a degree the severity of those fluctuations corresponds. It should be noted that of late years, since 1865, the differences between the rates charged in the highest and lowest month have largely increased. Taking the period as a whole, and arranging the months for the period 1 845- 1 900 from the lowest month to the highest, the particulars are as follows :— 88 RESERVE AND LIABILITIES OF THE BANK [ch. ix Average Rate for each Month, 1845-1900, Table 12, p. 97, arranged from lowest month to highest. Fifty-six Years, Average Rate for Average Rate, 1845-1900. Months named. £i 12s. = 100, £ s. d. July ... 3 4 6 ... 89 August 364 92 June 3 6 7 92 September • 3 6 7 92 April 3 6 10 93 March 390 96 May 3 II 99 February 3 " 3 99 October 3 17 3 108 January 3 19 I no December 4 I 10 113 November . 438 116 As the memories of many men of business hardly go back as far as the last severe crisis, the Act required to indemnify the Bank of England in respect of their issues of notes in excess of the legal limit made in November, 1857, is printed at the end of this chapter, and with it the bill introduced into the House of Commons in 1873 by Mr. Lowe, afterwards Lord Sherbrooke, the Chancellor of the Exchequer, The first of these documents will show the force of the legal impediments to an extension of the note issue of the Bank beyond the limit fixed by the Act of 1844, and the second what was considered necessary in 1873 to justify an extension of the limit. That the bill proposed by Mr. Lowe did not pass into law need not be a matter of regret. The requirements of the bill were pedantic and unpractical. The imposition of a charge for discounts of a rate of 12 per cent., a rate never yet authori- tatively attained during our sharpest panics, was enough to mark the proposal as impracticable. In times of pressure the right course is to endeavour to allay alarm, not to inflame it. With any charge beyond 5 per cent, the public becomes uneasy. A moderate rate for the excess issue like that charged at the Bank of Germany (Chapter XVL, p. 154) is more advantageous both for the Bank, the revenue, and the public. The proportion of the reserve to the liabilities and to CH. ix] HIGH RATES IN TIMES OF PRESSURE 89 the bankers' balances was as follows during the sharpest pressure of the crises of 1847, 1857, and 1866 : — October 30th, 1847. — Reserve 12 per cent, of the liabilities, and only sufficient to meet 81 per cent, of the bankers' balances. Bank rate 8 per cent. November i ith, 1857. — Reserve 7 per cent, of the liabilities, and only sufficient to meet 30 per cent, of the bankers' balances. Bank rate 10 per cent. May 1 6th, 1866. — Reserve 5 per cent, of the liabilities, and only sufficient to meet 15 per cent, of the bankers' balances. Bank rate 10 per cent. The increased severity of each crisis is marked in the smaller proportion of the reserve both to the liabilities and the bankers' balances on each of the later occasions. The principle of the Act of 1844 was actually infringed only in the panic of 1857. The particulars of what occurred in 1857 are given, as incorrect statements are not infrequent. Those for 1847, 1866, and 1890 are added by way of illustration. Year and Month. Gold Bullion in Issue Depart- ment of Bank. Reserve of Notes. Rate of Dis- count percent. Year and Month. Gold Bullion in Issue Depart- ment of Bank. Reserve of Notes. Rate of Dis- count percent. 1847. £ £ 1857. £ £ Oct. 16 7,990,000 2,630,000 5i Dec. 16 8,926,000 5,757.000 10 „ 23 7,865,000 1,547,000 8 „ 23 10,209,000 7,426,000 10 „ 30 8,009,000 1,177,000 8 „ 30 10,905,000 6,065,000 8 Nov. 6 8,426,000 2,030,000 8 1866. „ 13 8,848,000 2,798,000 8 Mar. 21 I3,SS4;000 7,918,000 6 „ 20 9,526,000 4,228,000 8 „ 28 13,503,000 6,881,000 6 1857. Apr. 4 13,486,000 6,153,000 6 Oct. 3 10,078,000 4,606,000 54 ,, 11 13,363,000 6,318,000 6 „ 10 9,539,000 4,024,000 „ 18 13,042,000 5,738,000 6 ,, 17 8,925,000 3,217,000 7 „ 25 13,005,000 5,844,000 6 „ 24 8,777,000 3,486,000 8 May 2 12,712,000 4,839,000^ 6 „ 31 8,155,000 2,258,000 8 ,. 9 12,295,000 4,950,000 8 Nov. 4 7,947,000 2,155,000 8 „ 16 11,851,000 731,000 10 „ 11 6,666,000 958,000 10 „ 23 11,300,000 831,000 10 „ 18 6,080,000 1,148,000* 10 „ 30 11,434,000 415,000 10 „ 25 6,784,000 1,919,000 10 Tune 6 12,620,000 2,167,000 10 Dec. 2 6,896,000 2,268,000 10 „ 13 13,696,000 2,729,000 10 „ 9 7,568,000 3,900,000 10 „ 20 14,174,000 4,067,000 lOt * ;^2,ooo,ooo was, under authority of Treasury letter, Nov. 12th, 1857, added to the securities in the Issue Department in the returns from Nov. i8th to Dec. 23rd, 1857, both inclusive. The strict limits of the Act of 1844 were only exceeded in the returns of i8th and 25th Nov., 1857. — Palgrave, Dictionary of Political Economy, vol. i. art. by Mr. W. Fowler, "Crises," pp. 462-6. t Reduced to 8 per cent. August 6th. 90 RESERVE AND LIABILITIES OF THE BANK [ch. ix Figures from Nearest Return. Date. Gold Bullion in Bank in both departments. Reserve of Notes. Rate of Discount per cent. 1890. Oct. 15 „ 29 Nov. 12 „ 19 ,. 26 Dec. 10 „ 17 „ 24 19.793.000 i9.7S9.ooo 19,137,000 22,558,000 24,683,000 24,832,000 24,375,000 23,338,000 i, 10,275,000 10,600,000 10,024,000 13,378,000 15,309,000 15,904,000 15,797,000 14,205,000 5 \ 6 6 5 5 5 The general averages of the proportions of the reserve to the Habilities and of the London bankers' balances to the reserve when the various rates specified were charged between the years 1844 and 1878 are given in the table which follows. This statement has not been carried further, because since the amounts of the London bankers' balances have not been published since 1877, it is not possible now to make any similar statement up to a later date complete. It will be observed, however, that in general the principle that a low figure for the reserve accompanies a high rate of interest holds good. There does not appear to be any corresponding connection between the proportions which the bankers' balances bear to the reserve and the rate charged. General Averages of the Proportions of the Reserve TO THE Liabilities, and of the London Bankers' Balances to the Reserve, when the various Rates specified were charged — 1844 to 1878. Bank Rate of Discount per cent. Times Charged. Average Proportion per Cent, of Reserve to Liabilities. Average Proportion per Cent, of London Bankers' Balances to Reserve. 10 2 18 86 9 s s8 73 8 IS 30 78 7 21 32 67 6i 2 zg 53 6 28 36 61 Si 6 37 66 5 33 36 67 4i 20 43 58 4 40 5(> 64 3i 30 4S 56 3 3S 4S 57 2i 18 SO 50 2i I 59 38 2 8 SO 73 Number of changes in rate . . . } 264 — — CH. IX] INDEMNITY TO BANK— EXCESS ISSUES— ACT 1857 91 The following is the Act required to indemnify the Bank of England against the legal risks it ran by exceeding the limits of issue prescribed by the Bank Act of 1844 in 1857 :— Anno Vicesimo Prima Victoria Eegina, Cap. i. An Act to indemnify the Governor and Company of the Bank of England in respect of certain Issues of their Notes, and to confirm such Issues, and to authorize further Issues for a Time to be limited. [12th December, 1857.] Whereas by the Act of the Session holden in the Seventh and Eighth 7 & 8 Vict. Years of Her Majesty, Chapter Thirty-two, " to regulate the Issue of =• 32. Bank Notes and for giving to the Governor and Company of the Bank of England certain Privileges for a limited Period," the Governor and Company of the Bank of England are prohibited from issuing Bank of England Notes either in the Banking Department of the Bank of England or to any Persons or Person whatsoever, save in exchange for other Bank of England Notes, or for Gold Coin, or for Gold or Silver Bullion received or purchased for the Issue Department of the said Bank under the Provisions of that Act, or in exchange for Securities acquired and taken in the said Issue Department under the Provisions therein con- tained : And whereas under the said Act and an Order in Council issued under the Provisions thereof the Amount of Securities to be acquired and taken in the said Issue Department stands limited not to exceed the Sum of Fourteen million four hundred and seventy-five thousand Pounds : And whereas by a Letter dated the Twelfth Day of November last the First Lord of the Treasury and the Chancellor of the Exchequer informed the Governor and the Deputy Governor of the Bank of England that Her Majesty's Government had observed with great Concern the serious Consequences which had ensued from the recent Failure of certain Joint Stock Banks in England and Scotland, as well as of certain large mer- cantile Firms chiefly connected with the American Trade; that the Discredit and Distrust which had resulted from these Events, and the Withdrawal of a large Amount of the Paper Circulation authorized by the existing Bank Acts, appeared to Her Majesty's Government to render it necessary for them to inform the Bank of England that if they should be unable in the present Emergency to meet the Demands for Discounts and Advances upon approved Securities without exceeding the Limits of their Circulation prescribed by the Act of One thousand eight hundred and forty-four, the Government would be prepared to propose to Parliament upon its meeting a Bill of Indemnity for any Excess so issued ; and that, in order to prevent that temporary Relaxation of the Law being extended beyond the actual Necessities of the Occasion, Her Majesty's Government were of opinion that the Bank Terms of Discount should not be reduced below their then present Rate ; And whereas the Governor and Company 92 RESERVE AND LIABILITIES OF THE BANK [ch. ix Issues of Bank oi England Notes since 1 2th Nov.,i8s7, in excess of those authorized by Law confirmed and made valid. of the Bank of England have since the said Twelfth Day of November One thousand eight hundred and fifty-seven issued Bank of England Notes in exchange for Securities acquired and taken in the said Issue Department beyond the Amount limited by Law, and it is expedient that the Acts of the said Governor and Company in relation to the Matters aforesaid should be confirmed, and that the Restriction on the Amount of the Securities to be acquired and taken in the said Issue Department should be suspended for a limited Time : Be it therefore enacted by the Queen's most Excellent Majesty, by and with the Advice and Consent of the Lords Spiritual and Temporal, and Commons, in this present Parlia- ment assembled, and by the Authority of the same, as follows : I. All such Issues of Bank of England Notes as may have been made by the said Governor and Company, or by their Order or Direction, since the said Twelfth Day of November One thousand eight hundred and fifty- seven, although beyond the Amount authorized by Law, and all Acts necessary for the making of such Issues, and for the acquiring and taking since the said Twelfth Day of November One thousand eight hundred and fifty-seven Securities in the Issue Department of the Bank of England beyond the Amount authorized by Law, shall be confirmed and made valid; and the said Governor and Company, and all Persons who have been concerned in such Issues or in doing or advising any such Acts as aforesaid, are hereby indemnified and discharged in respect thereof, and all Indictments and Informations, Actions, Suits, Prosecutions, and Pro- ceedings whatsoever commenced or to be commenced against the said Governor and Company or any Person or Persons in relation to the Acts or Matter aforesaid, or any of them, are hereby discharged and made void. The Re- striction on the Amount of Securities to be taken in the Issue Depart- ment suspended. II. So much of the said Act of the Seventh and Eighth Years of Her Majesty as limits the Amount of the Securities to be acquired and taken in the Issue Department of the Bank of England shall be and be deemed to have been suspended as from the Twelfth Day of November One thousand eight hundred and fifty-seven, and shall continue suspended until the Expiration of Twenty-eight Days after the First Meeting or Sitting of Parliament in the Year One thousand eight hundred and fifty- eight, subject to the Proviso herein-after contained, and during such Sus- pension the Provisions of the said Act in relation to the Issue of Bank of England Notes shall be construed and take effect as if the Restriction on the Amount of Securities in the said Issue Department, and the Prohibi- tion of the Increase of such Amount and of the Issue of additional Bank of England Notes thereon, had not been contained in the said Act : Provided always, that if before the Expiration of the Time herein-before limited the Governor and Company of the Bank of England give public Notice that they have reduced the minimum Rate of Interest required by them below the Rate of Tender Centum per Annum, the said Suspension shall cease. CH. IX] EXCESS ISSUE— LORD SHERBROOKE— BILL OF 1873 93 III. Upon or before the Expiration or Cesser of the Suspension afore- The Issues said the Excess of Issues herein-before confirmed shall be reduced to the '" ^'"^^^^ Amount which would have been authorized by Law if this Act had not 'T ^V^' , J -I » . ducea on been passed ; and, subject to the Indemnity and Discharge hereby given, or before all the Provisions of the said recited Act shall, after such Expiration or the Expi- Cesser, be and remain in full Force. '^'•°" °^ the Sus- pension. The bill proposed by Lord Sherbrooke (then Mr. Robert Lowe) in 1873 to allow the Bank of England to exceed in certain contingencies the limits fixed for the issue by the Act of 1844 is printed here in full. (36 Vi'a.) Bank of England Notes. A Bill to provide for authorising in certain contingencies a tem- a-d. 1873. porary increase of the amount of Bank of England Notes issued in exchange for securities. Be it enacted by the Queen's most Excellent Majesty, by and with the advice and consent of the Lords Spiritual and Temporal, and Commons, in this present Parliament assembled, and by the authority of the same, as follows : I. Whenever the First Lord of Her Majesty's Treasury and the Power to Chancellor of the Exchequer after communication with the Governor a"*o"se and Deputy Governor of the Bank of England are satisfied — ands°eckl (i) That the minimum rate of interest then being charged by the c^"t.°^ Governor and Company of the Bank of England on discounts England and temporary advances is not less than twelve per cent, per notes, annum; and (2) That the foreign exchanges are favourable to this country ; and (3) That a large portion of the existing amount of Bank of England and other bank notes in circulation is rendered ineffective for its ordinary purpose by reason of internal panic : they may, by order under their hands, empower the issue department of the Bank of England to make, in excess of the authorised issue, a special and temporary issue of Bank of England notes, by delivering the same into the banking department in exchange for and on the credit of an equal amount of Government securities to be transferred to the issue department, and the said Governor and Company shall pay interest into the Exchequer on the amount of notes so issued by them at such rate, being not less than twelve per cent, per annum, as may from time to time be fixed by the First Lord of the Treasury and Chancellor of the Exchequer, and in addition thereto the amount of any further profit which they may derive from the said issue. 94 RESERVE AND LIABILITIES OF THE BANK [CH. IX Order may be re- scinded or varied. Remuner- ation to Bank for expense of special issue. Publica- tion and return of order to Parlia- ment. Construc- tion of Act and short title. 2. The First Lord of the Treasury and the Chancellor of the Exchequer may, if they think it expedient, by order under their hands, rescind and vary any order made in pursuance of this Act, and make any new order in pursuance of this Act. 3. There shall be paid to the said Governor and Company such sum, not exceeding the rate of two per cent, on the amount of such issue, as may be agreed upon between the said First Lord of the Treasury and Chancellor of the Exchequer on the one part, and the said Governor and Deputy Governor of the Bank of England on the other part, to be a fair allowance to the Bank for the risk, expense, and trouble incurred by it in making such issue. 4. A copy of every order made under this Act shall be forthwith published in such manner as the First Lord of the Treasury and the Chancellor of the Exchequer consider best calculated for giving public and general notice thereof, and shall be laid before both Houses of Parliament within fourteen days after it is made, or if Parliament be not then sitting, within fourteen days after the then next meeting of Parliament. 5. This Act may be cited as the Bank of England Notes Act, 1873, and shall be construed as one with the Act of the session of the seventh and eighth years of the reign of Her present Majesty, chapter thirty-two, intituled " An Act to regulate the issue of bank notes, and for giving to the Governor and Company of the Bank of England certain privileges for a limited period." [Sec. 3, in italics, is thus in the original print of the Bill.] CHAPTER X VARIATIONS IN THE RATE CHARGED BY THE BANK OF ENGLAND FROM 1844 TO 1900 The Rate of Discount a valuable index to the fluctuations in the Money Market . . ■ ■ 95 Description of Table 12 . . 95-96 Description of Table 13 . . 96-103 This Table and Tables 12, 14, 37, and 38, giving details as to Rate charged, form chart showing course of market value of money . . . . 96 Great difference in the course of business between one year and another . . 96 Variations in Rate in different years 96-101 Table iz. Monthly Averages of Minimum Rate of Discount of Bank of England, 184S-1900 . . • . 97 Table 13. Table of Changes in the Rate of Discount charged by the Bank of England, and the Number of Days at each Rate, in each year, 1844- igoo . . . 98-99 Table 14. Bank of England Rates of Discount, 1844-1900. The number of days at each Rate arranged from the highest number to the smallest, and also from the lowest rate to the highest 100 Facts shown in Table 1 3 brought together for reference in Table 14 . .101 Summary of examination of Tables of Rates . . . 101-103 A low rate prevalent before 1854; high rates more frequent latterly . . 102 Effect of Chinese-Japanese War indemnity (1895-96) on the value of money . 103 The vast growth of loanable capital in the country renders it more difficult for the Bank to maintain the needed hold over the market . . 103-104 Deposits of Banks and amount of Reserve of Bank of England . . . 104 The fluctuations in the Rates charged by the other Banks of Europe . . 105 Though the rate of discount charged by the Bank of England is, perhaps, no longer at the present time so exact a guide to the movements of the money market as formerly, yet it is still a most valuable index to the fluctuations in that market, and to the course of monetary affairs generally, and an examination into the variations of the rate charged is a necessary part of an analysis of the transactions of the Bank. The tables which will be found in this chapter have been prepared for the pur- pose of giving information on this point. Of these tables, the first, No. 12, p. 97, gives the average rate of discount charged month by month by the Bank of England from 1845 to 1900, in groups of ten years, 1845-54, 1855-64, 1865-74, 95 96 VARIATIONS IN RATE, BANK OF ENGLAND [ch. x 1875-84, 1885-94, for the six years 1 895-1900, and for the whole period, 1845 to 1900. The statement has been sub- divided thus into short periods to facilitate the study of the fluctuations in the rate by those who desire to give the subject close attention. It also shows the proportion which the rate charged in each month bore to the average rate of the decade. Table No. 13, pp. 98, 99, gives at one view a statement of the changes in the Bank rate from the date in 1844, when the Bank Act came into operation, to the close of the year 1900. It gives the number of changes of the rate in each year, and the total number of days at each rate in each year. Table 37, p. 196, shows the number of variations in the rate and the years in which these variations occurred, and Table 38, p. 197, shows the range of variation in each year. The Table 14, p. 100, gives the number of days at each rate, arranged from the lowest rate to the highest ; and the number of days at each rate, arranged from the greatest number of days which each rate lasted to the smallest. These tables thus form, collectively, a kind of rough chart, showing the course which the market value of money has taken during the entire period over which they extend. Some curious information can be gathered from examining them. First, there is a great difference, as will be seen from Table 13, pp. 98, 99, between the course of business in one year and another. In two years, 185 1 and 1895, no change is marked ; in four years, 1844, 1846, 1849, and 1850, there is but one alteration of the rate. It will be noted that these years in which so little fluctuation took place all occurred during the first seven years, between 1844 and 1850. By way of contrast, in one year, 1873, no less than twenty- four changes, one nearly every fortnight, are marked. Next, if we look down the column in the table giving the total number of changes in the Bank rate, we shall be struck with the fact of how much that number has increased. As far down as the year 1859 the changes are comparatively few in number. Yet the period from 1844 to 1859 included two panics, those of 1847 ^.nd 1857, both of them of considerable severity. In both of these years, 1847 and 1857, the changes in the Bank rate amounted to nine. This was considered in those days an almost unprecedented CH. x] MONTHLY AVERAGES, RATE OF DISCOUNT 97 TABLE 12. Monthly Averages of Minimum Rate of Discount of Bank of England 1845-1900, in groups of Ten Years, 1845-54, 1855-64, 1865-74, 1875-84, 1885-94, and of Six Years, 1895-1900, with Summary Table, 1845-1900. 1845-64. 1855-64. 1865-74. 1876-84. Month. Average for the Ten Years, £3 Ss. sd. Av.of Ten Years = 100. Average for the Ten Years, £^ lis. grf. Average of Ten Years = 100. Average for the Ten Years, £% i6j. \d. Average of Ten Years = 100. Average for the Ten Years, £i 3S. iid. Average of Ten Years = xoo. £ s. d. £ s. d. £ : d. £ s. d. January 3 5 8 qb 4 IS 8 los 3 17 8 10/ 3 17 5 121 February . 360 gb 4 16 S 104 3 12 9 96 3 5" 103 March 360 gb 4 12 S 100 3 10 I gz 3 I 7 96 Apni. 3 7 I gS 4 II 2 gH 3 II II 94 2 IS 8 87 May . 3 7 7 99 4 15 8 103 4 3 8 no 2 16 3 88 [une . 3 8 4 100 496 97 3 19 8 10$ 2 IS 2 86 July . . 380 99 4 4 5 9' 3 13 10 97 2 14 6 ss August 3 7 10 99 432 go 3 13 II 97 2 IS 9 87 September . 3 7 8 99 446 91 322 82 3 I 3 gb October . 3 10 10 104 4 12 4 99 3 19 II ro5 3 10 10 III November . 3 IS I no 5 4 9 "3 4 8 8 117 3 18 2 122 December . 3 10 10 104. S 3 3 III 3 19 1 104 3 IS 10 iig Difference : Highest and L owest Difference: Highest and Difference: Highest and Difference; Highest and Month, gj. 5d Lowest Month, £\ is. yd. Lowest Month, £i 6s. 6d, Lowest Month,]£i 3*. 8d. Mean of e^ ctreme Variatio IS for Mean of extreme Vari- Mean of extreme Vari- Mean of extreme Vari- «84S-S4. 7% ations for 1855-64, XI '57b ations for 1865-74, i7"s7o ations for 1875-84, iS'sV. 1886-94. 1896-1900. 1846-1900. Month. Average for Average of Average for Average of Average for the Average Rate of Fifty-six Years =100. the Ten Years, Ten Years the Six Years, Six Years Fifty-six Years, £1 y. »rf. = IOO. £3 OJ. 4rf. = 100. £3 121. £ s. d. £ s. d. £ s. d. January . 4 I I 128 3 6 S I/O 3 19 I I/O February 3 6 I 'OS 2 16 S 94 3 II 3 99 March 2 18 6 93 2 16 8 94 390 gb April 2 13 2 ii 2 17 8 96 3 6 10 93 May 2 14 2 86 2 17 4 9S 3 II 99 June 2 10 ID 81 2 10 7 84 367 g2 July 290 78 2 10 10 84 346 89 August 2 16 6 89 2 13 6 89 364 g2 September 3 4 4 102 2 15 S 92 367 g2 October . 3 10 I III 392 'IS 3 17 3 /08 November 3 16 9 122 3 13 4 121 438 //6 December 3 17 4 122 3 16 8 127 4 I ID "3 Difference: Highest and Lowest Month, Difference: Highest and Difference : Highest and £% lis. id. Lowest Month, £1 6s. id. Lowest Month, iqs. td. Mean of extreme Variations for 1885-94, Mean of extreme Vari- Mean of extreme Vari- ^57. ations for 1895-1900, 21 •57. ations for 1845-1900, i3'57. H 98 VARIATIONS IN RATE, BANK OF ENGLAND [ch. x TABLE 13. BANK OF ENGLAND Table of the Changes in the Rate of Discount Charg^ed by the since 5th September, 1844 (when the Bank Years. Number of Changes. 2% »i% 'iZ 3% 3iX 4% Rise. Fall. Total. Days. Days. Days. Days. Days. Days. 1841 — I I 117 — 1845 2 — 2 — 289 21 55 — 1846 — I I — — — 126 239 — 1847 6 3 9 — — — 14 7 U7 "1848 — 3 3 — — — 59 140 40 1849 — I I — — 39 326 — — 1850 I — I — — 360 5 — — 1851 Noch ange — — — 36s — — 1852 — 2 2 2S3 — "3 — — 1853 6 — 6 6 — 14 133 91 14 1854 I I 2 — — — — — 1855 4 4 8 — 84 7 1856 2 S 7 — — — — — 1857 6 3 9 — — — — — — 1858 — 6 6 — — 22 301 7 7 1859 2 3 5 — — 288 35 14 1860 8 3 II — — 19 12 226 1861 3 8 II — — 54 49 21 1862 2 3 S 98 — 147 120 — 1863 8 4 12 — 31 12 241 1864 7 8 IS — — — — 1865 8 8 16 — — — 42 21 98 1868 5 9 14 — — — II 42 1867 3 3 1 59 — 56 112 38 1868 2 2 324 — 14 28 — — 1869 3 4 7 — 77 183 21 49 1870 4 6 10 — — 93 223 9 12 1871 4 6 10 70 28 124 66 14 23 1872 9 5 14 — 123 76 50 1873 II 13 24 — — — 35 76 61 1874 6 7 13 — — 42 70 119 81 1875 5 7 12 56 — 21 84 147 43 . 1876 I 4 S 25s — — 14 14 62 1877 4 3 7 170 — 7 100 — 39 1878 6 4 ID 56 — 28 9" 28 21 1879 I 4 5 210 — 28 97 — 14 1880 I I 2 — — "75 191 — — 1881 4 2 6 — — 112 90 35 42 1882 3 3 6 — — — 147 — 42 1883 I 5 6 — — — 165 28 147 1884 4 3 7 112 — 77 80 35 7 1885 2 5 7 168 — 14 42 49 64 1886 4 3 7 78 — 77 62 56 77 1887 2 5 7 98 — 14 49 14 156 1888 4 5 9 56 — 91 91 7 33 1889 4 4 8 — 112 98 8 42 1890 4 7 II — — — 70 7 98 1891 4 6 ID — — 84 126 49 98 1892 I 3 4 176 — 21 149 20 1893 6 6 12 — — 147 134 21 42 1894 — 2 2 312 — 21 32 — — 1895 Noch ange — 365 — — — — — 1896 3 — 3 254 — 14 28 — 70 1897 2 4 6 133 — 56 141 H 21 1898 3 3 6 — 84 146 7 128 1899 4 2 6 — — 161 96 19 1900 I 5 6 — — — 35 21 284 184 216 400 3.409 28 2,997 4.907 1.739 2,698 CH. x] DAYS AT EACH RATE, 1844-1900, ENGLAND 99 TABLE 13 — continued. MINIMUM RATE OF DISCOUNT, 1844-1900. Bank of England, and the Number of Days at each Rate in each Year, Act came into Operation), to 31st December, 1900. 4}% 5% sU 6% 6i% 1% 8% 9% "% Total. Years. Days. Days. Days. Days. Days. Days. Days. Days. Days. Days. 14 \ 28 33 14 52 42 35 7 7 43 8 7 2 7 127 27 §3 281 102 35 14 63 49 25 39 21 7 40 47 45 14 7 21 49 103 16 86 15s 25 55 28 15 34 88 104 105 21 56 7 56 84 14 84 14 7 46 "~ 20 127 7 13 91 27 106 49 56 7 44 57 31 7 38 21 I 78 31 II 14 77 10 74 199 4 52 8 102 50 37 19 22 28 24 7 35 21 81 59 13 4 77 I 13 / 45 96 117 365 365 365 366 36S 36s 366 36s 36s 365 366 365 365 365 366 365 365 366 365 366 365 365 366 365 36s 365 366 365 365 36s 366 365 36s 366 36S 36s 36S 366 36s 365 365 366 365 365 36s 366 36S 36s 365 365 1844 1845 1846 1847 1848 1849 1850 1851 1852 1853 1854 1855 1856 1857 1858 1859 1860 1861 1862 1863 1864 1865 1866 1867 1868 1869 1870 1871 1872 1873 1874 1876 1876 1877 1878 1879 1880 1881 1882 1883 1884 1885 1886 1887 1888 1889 1890 1891 1892 1893 1894 1895 1896 1897 1898 1899 1§00 481 2,012 259 868 91 577 268 95 141 20,570 100 VARIATIONS IN RATE, BANK OF ENGLAND [ch. x TABLE 14. Bank of England— Rate of Discount— 1844-1900. The Number of Days at each Rate, arranged from the highest number to the smallest. Number of Days (20,570). Rate Per Cent. Number of Day5= 1,000 4,907 ... 3 ... 239 3.409 2 166 2.997 H 146 2,698 4 131 2,012 5 98 1.739 3i 84 868 6 43 577 7 28 481 4i 23 268 8 13 259 Si 13 141 10 7 95 9 5 91 6J 4 28 2I — 80,570 1,000 Bank of England— Rate of Discount— 1844-1900. The Number of Days at each Rate, arranged from the lowest rate to the highest. Rate Per Cent. Number of Days (20,570). Number of Days= 1,000. 2 . . . 3,409 ... 166 2i 28 — 'h a.997 146 3 4.907 239 3i 1.739 84 4 2,698 131 4i 481 23 5 2,012 98 Si 259 13 6 868 43 6i 91 4 7 577 28 8 268 13 9 95 6 10 . . . 141 .. . 7 20,570 1,000 CH. x] DETAILS OF VARIATIONS, BANK OF ENGLAND loi number of variations. If we exclude these two years, we shall find in the fifteen years under observation, namely, those from 1844 to 1859, only two years, 1855 and 1856, in the first of which the number of changes was eight, in the second seven ; two years besides, 1853 and 1858, in which they were six in number ; in one year, 1859, there were five changes; in one year, 1851, no change whatever was recorded ; in the remaining seven years the number of changes varied from one to three. But from i860 to 1874 a totally different state of things prevails. If we carry our eyes down this later part of the column we shall find that, with the exception of the year 1862, in which there were five changes, no year between i860 and 1874 has less than ten changes recorded as occurring in it, with the exception of those years which, like 1867 and 1868, were years of recovery from great commercial depression. In 1872 four- teen changes were recorded; in 1873, as mentioned before, no less than twenty-four; and in 1874 thirteen. Between 1875 and 1900 the yearly fluctuations were not so numerous. Both in 1875 and 1893 there were twelve, in 1890 there were eleven, in 1891 ten, in 1888 nine, in 1889 eight. In none of the remaining years did the changes exceed six or seven. In 1894 there were only two; in 1895, as in 185 1, there were none. The diminution in the number of fluctua- tions is a help to trade, as is a low rate of interest. If we examine Table 14, p. 100, in which the facts shown in Table 13, pp. 98, 99, have been brought together for facility of reference, we shall find that during the greater part of the time between 1844 and 1900 the rate charged by the Bank has been, comparatively speaking, a low one. Out of 20,570 days under consideration, the Bank rate stood at 3 per cent., or below it, during 11,341 — that is to say during more than half of the whole time. And if we take the rates up to 4 per cent, inclusive, which we may call moderate rates, as even 4 per cent, can hardly be called a high rate, we shall find that they comprise more than three-quarters of the whole. A column has been added to the table for facility of comparison, showing the proportionate part of the time which each rate has stood at, — reckoning the whole period as equalling 1,000. This column shows that during more than half of the whole time a rate of 102 VARIATIONS IN RATE, BANK OF ENGLAND [ch. x 3 per cent, and below has been charged, and that rates varying from 4^ per cent, upwards to lo per cent, have been in force during one-fifth of the whole period. The whole results may be summarised thus : From 1 844 to 1 900 a low rate, from 2 per cent, to 2^ per cent, was charged during 6,434 days, being more than one-quarter of the time ; a moderate rate, not exceeding 3 per cent., was charged during 11,341 days, more than half the time ; a rate not exceeding 4 per cent, was charged during 15,778 days, more than three-quarters of the time ; and during 4,792 days, little more than one-fifth of the time, a high rate of 4^ per cent, and upwards was charged. If we look to table No. 13, pp. 98, 99, again, we shall see the history of the difficult times between 1855 and 1873 expressed very clearly, the years in which the Bank rate exceeded 6 per cent., ranging from 6^ per cent, to 10 per cent., all, except 1847, falling within that period. Earlier than 1854 low rates generally prevailed. If we except the panic year, 1 847, we shall never find, down to the year 1853 inclusive, the rate exceeding 5 per cent. ; and indeed a 5 per cent, rate was then most rarely attained. In those days a 4 per cent, rate was one of unusual severity. In the latter part of the table higher rates have become more frequent. Though it may have been but for a week, yet during thirty-six out of the fifty-six years over which this table extends the Bank rate has reached 5 per cent. ; even in such a year as 1876, during which the average rate for the year was but a little more than half 5 per cent., being only £2 12s. \d. for the twelvemonth, and in 1877, in which the yearly average was only £2 I'&s., the same result occurred. Thus also during thirty-eight years the Bank rate has stood for some time, and frequently a long time, at 4 per cent. Yet the fact that 4 per cent, and even a lower rate has been charged for a considerable part of the year has not prevented the average for the whole year being high. Thus in 1866, when for a few days as low a rate as 3^^ per cent, was charged, the average rate for the whole year was £6 195., the highest recorded. Again, in 1873 the rate fluctuated between 3 per cent, and 9 per cent., with an average of £\ 15^. \od. Between 1873 ^'^^ 1900. however, the rate has never exceeded 6 per cent., though it has stood CH. xl LOANABLE CAPITAL AND CASH RESERVE 103 at that figure in eight years, namely, in 1874, 1875, 1878, 1882, 1889 (for one day), 1890, 1899, and 1900. During the years from 1891 to 1897 ^ow rates generally prevailed. In 1895 the rate stood at 2 per cent, without change, and including that year and 1894, 1896, and 1897 2 per cent, was charged for 1064 days, equivalent to nearly three years out of the seven between 1894 and 1900. This, however, has not prevented the fluctuations in the rate from being fre- quent and also distinctly marked. The variations have also become more extreme during the years from 1885 to 1900. The special circumstances connected with the Chinese- Japanese War indemnity and the large deposits hence made with the Bank of England in 1895-6 partly account for the abnormally low value of money at that time. This subject is mentioned in Chapter II., p. 18, in reference to the principal divisions of accounts of the Bank of England. The further consideration of this subject — the number, the extent, and the severity of the fluctuations in the rate charged at the Bank of England — will be continued in Chapter XX., p. 203, in which the same points will be taken up in reference to all the five banks whose operations are discussed in this volume. Meanwhile it is only right to refer to one cause of the greater susceptibility to fluctuation in the value of money in this country of recent years, namely, the vast growth of loanable capital in the country, and of the money held by banks and discount houses, in comparison with the reserve of ready money in the form of hard cash which is held against these liabilities. The real reserve in actual cash of the banks of the country is included in the reserve held by the Bank of England, and though that reserve, as compared .with the amounts held thirty years since, has been augmented of late, yet the reserve of the Bank has not been increased in proportion to the demands which may be made on it, and the average during the last four years dealt with in this statement, 1897- 1900, actually decreased. See Table 3, col. 23, p. 13. It is advisable in reference to this point to make a note of the sums held by the banks of the United Kingdom, and- to compare with these figures the amount of the reserve of the Bank of England. I04 VARIATIONS IN RATE, BANK OF ENGLAND [ch. x My own estimate in Notes on Banking, made in 1872, was that the amount of the capitals, deposits, and circulation of all the banks in the United Kingdom was at that date — 1872. 1894. 1895. 1896. 1897. 1898. 1899. 1900. 1901. ^£584,000,000 The deposits, current accounts, and note circulation of all the banks publishing accounts in the United Kingdom were — * ;£72 1,400,000 794,600,000 797,700,000 816,400,000 838,300,000 869,300,000 889,600,000 888,100,000 Average Reserve of the Bank of England. ;£l 2, 100,000 ;;£2S,800,000 29,900,000 34,600,000 25,100,000 22,900,000 21,200,000 21,400,000 24,046,000 Proportion per cent, of Reserve of Bank to Liabilities of all Banks to the Public. 358 3-75 4-33 307 2-73 2-44 241 271 Meanwhile as the amount of loanable capital outside the Bank of England has till recently increased in a larger propor- tion than the amount of loanable capital which the Bank holds, it has become more difficult for the Bank to maintain that influence over the market rate which it is needful for it to exert. The more close is the harmony existing between the market rate and the Bank rate, the more swiftly is the Bank able to influence the market rate, and thus to regulate the amount of its reserve. The more carefully the business of banking is conducted throughout the country the less will the danger be of those demands which arise through the results of inflation of business and overtrading. The influence which bankers .generally can exert over the business of the country is very great, and considering the extreme delicacy of our money market, the more needful it is that that influence should be continually exerted on the side of prudence. This statement will give our readers a general view of the fluctuations in the rate of interest charged by the Bank of England during the period from 1844 to 1900. We propose in the following chapters to carry the investigation somewhat further, and to examine also in some detail into the rates * See Banker^ Magazine, April, 1902. Waterlow and Sons, Limited, London. CH. x] RATES, FLUCTUATIONS AT OTHER BANKS 105 charged by the Bank of France, the Bank of Germany, the Bank of Holland, and the Bank of Belgium. Tables have been added, marked Table 41, p. 209, Table 45, p. 216, which show at one view the fluctuations in the rates of discount charged by these banks for the years under consideration ; Table 2)1 ^ P- 196, with the number of variations in the rates of discount; Table 38, p. 197, which shows the lowest and highest rates charged and the extent of the fluctuations ; Table 39, p. 198, with a summary of the number and extent of annual fluctuations in the rates charged ; and other tables illustrative of these details. These show generally what the course of these fluctuations has been. CHAPTER XI SOME OF THE CAUSES WHICH INFLUENCE THE RATE OF INTEREST CHARGED BY THE BANK OF ENGLAND Relation between the Reserve of the Bank of England and the current Rate of Interest . ... lo6 Tendency towards lower rates for money during the last thirty-six years . . lo6 Average Rates for groups of years, 1845- 1854, 1895-1900 . . 106-107 Influence of the different seasons of the year on the Fluctuations of the Rate and on business generally . .107 Business activity at certain seasons of the year . ... 107 Periodic increases of Scotch circulation . 107 Particulars of Scotch circulation in May, June, October, November, and De- cember for 1897-1900 . . 107-109 The most important causes of increased Scotch note issues in May and November . . . . log Reference to monthly fluctuations in the Rate at Banks of France, Germany, Holland, and Belgium . . .no Connection between demands made on account of Irish and Scotch Note Cir- culation and the Liabilities and Reserve of the Bank . . . . no Mr. Weguelin (1856) on the influence of the Scotch and Irish Circulation on the Bank of England Reserve . .110 A SPECIAL set of tables has been prepared to illustrate the relation between the reserve of the Bank of England and the current rate of interest. These tables, No. ii, pp. 82, 83, and No. 12, p. 97, give the average minimum rate of discount for each month in the years 1845- 1900, ^^'^ the corresponding averages of the liabilities and the reserve in groups generally of ten years each. The average yearly rate also requires attention. It is given in col. 4*6 of Table 3, p. 15. The average rate of interest charged by the Bank, after having increased from 1854 to 1866, has diminished, and, except in 1872, 1873, 1882, and 1890, the tendency has been towards lower rates for money almost uniformly for the last thirty-six years. If we divide the period under consideration into six groups, — five of ten years each, 1845-54, 1855-64, 1865-74, 1875-84, 106 CH. XI] SEASONS OF GREATEST BUSINESS ACTIVITY 107 1885-94, and one of six years, 1895-1900 — we shall find that the average rates in these groups were as follows : — t. s. d. 1845-54 . .385 1855-64 . 4 12 9 1865-74 . 3 16 I 1875-84 • 3 3 II 1885-94 • 3 3 2 I895-I900 • 3 4 The average for the whole period 1 845-1900 is £■>> ^^J. On referring to Table 12, p. 97, from which these figures are derived, it will be observed that there is a periodic fluctuation from one season of the year to another. In all the periods into which this statement is divided, the months of winter are generally the time of the highest charges. In the years 1855-64 the rate in the month of May, and in the years 1865-74 the rates in May and June, were very high. But these were exceptions. As a rule the autumn and early winter months are the times of greatest business activity, which sometimes affects the rate as late as the months of January and February. The demands which the home harvest brings are great ; the demands which foreign supplies of all kinds entail are more pressing still. The large amounts of produce then coming forward affect the money market ; and a deficient harvest (should there be a short supply) usually manifests itself about the third week in October. The ship- ments of corn also from America generally commence early in September, and intensify up to the middle of November. These causes, and others of a kindred nature which there is no need to specify, account for the autumnal demand.* They do not, however, exist in the spring. In the month of May, a corresponding, though slighter, increa^(|Df pressure may be to that taking place in October, No\^mlM|g||ttnd )er. The opening up of those sources of ^5J|^^B(?)n which have been locked up by the severity of th^^nnter probably accounts for a considerable part of the increased demand for money indicated by a rise in its value. Som^ effect also must be assigned to the periodic increase in the Scotch note circulation in the months of May and November. Any increase in that circulation beyond the limits fixed by the * See Chapter XIV., p. 138, "The Autumnal Drain." io8 CAUSES WHICH INFLUENCE RATE OF INTEREST [ch. xi legislation of 1844 and 1845 causes an immediate demand on the reserve of the Bank of England for gold. The increase in the Scotch circulation beyond the limit of 1845 did not become very distinctly marked till 1856. It has become much more considerable of late. It will be observed that the Bank rate in May was for the years 1845-54 below the average of the year. For the years 1865-74 the rate in May was higher than in any other month of the years included, except November. The particulars of the Scotch circulation in May, November, and December, for the years 1 897-1 900, are as follows : — -^^m^ 1900. May '•'^ June ^^-•■y, October '''' November December Authorised Limit of Scotch Bank Note Circulation (;^2,749,27i) and Gold and Silver Coin Held. '897. May June October November December 1898. May June October November December 1899. May June October November December Actual Circulation. Gold and Silver Coin Held. Average of 1897, Average of 1897, ;£7,33o,ooo. . 7,566,000 . ;£Si 85.0,000. . 5,892,000 . 7.875.000 ■ . 6,340,000 • 7.44S.OOO . . 5,973,000 . 8,026,000 6,436,000 . 7,674,000 . . 6,311,000 Average of 1896, Average of 1898, ;£7,502,000. ;£6,OI2,000. £ £ . 7,584,000 . . 6,041,000 . 7,943,000 . . 6,357,000 . 7,688,000 . . 6,S03,000 . 8,260,000 . 6,742,000 . 8,025,000 . 6,566,000 Average of 1899, Average of 1899, ;£7.8sg.ooo. ;£6,43J,ooo. £ £ . 8,027,000 . 6,360,000 . 8,377,000 . .. 6,873,000 • 7,972,000 . . 6,694,000 . 8,544,000 . . 7,162,000 . 8,268,000 . 6,858,000 Average of 1900, Average of 1900, ;£7>959.ooo. ;£6,46l,O0O. £ £ . 7,963,000 . . 6,396,000 . 8,463,000 . . 6,919,000 . 8,118,000 .. 6,666,000 . 8,715,000 . . 7,194,000 . 8,566,000 . 7,027,000 For the year 1900 the gold held against the extra note circulation in Scotland in the months mentioned above exceeded the average holding by ^700,000. The difference between the highest and lowest holdings of specie is far larger than this, and forms a perfectly needless demand on the central specie CH. xi] PERIODIC INCREASE, SCOTCH NOTE ISSUES 109 reserve of the country. This subject is examined into further in Chapter XII., p. 112, which deals with the Scotch and Irish note circulations. It may be desirable to mention here the causes which lead to these periodic, though temporary, requirements for notes in Scotland. " The main causes of the increased note issues in May and November are undoubtedly these : — " 1st. The payments of rents and interests on mortgages, which, in Scotland, are almost uniformly made at the half-yearly terms of Whitsuntide (15th May) and Martinmas (nth November). " 2nd. The settlement of all important transactions in herit- able property, which are also fixed for the same terms. " 3rd. The payment of household servants' wages, and in many cases salaries, at the same period. " These payments are to a large extent made through the medium of bank notes, and thus these notes get into hands where they remain for a time, many of the parties who receive the notes having no bank account. "It is further to be noted : — " 1st. That on the 4th of the month an unusually large amount of bills falls due, and if the 4th happens on a Saturday (the day when the returns are made up) we generally look for a heavier return on that account. " 2nd. The November returns are usually heavier than those in May, because of the requirements of the harvest, travellers, etc. " 3rd. In the country districts the term-day is in many places regulated by the old style, and thus the payment of farm rents runs on into June and December." This statement is taken from a description of the circum- stances written to me in 1872 by a well-known Scotch banker, the late Dr. Charles Gairdner, at that time General Manager 110 CAUSES WHICH INFLUENCE RATE OF INTEREST [ch. xi of the Union Bank of Scotland. Mr. George Anderson, the Treasurer of the Bank of Scotland, assures me that the circum- stances described by Dr. Gairdner are equally effective at the present day. It becomes desirable to refer at this point to the monthly fluctuations in the rate of discount charged by the Bank of England, and to compare them with the corresponding fluctua- tions in France, Germany, Holland and Belgium. The rates of the Banks of England, France, Germany, Holland and Belgium have therefore been tabulated on a similar basis for the years 1845 to 1900, and divided into periods generally speaking of ten years, the six years 1895- 1900 being formed into a separate table. While the tables show some pressure on the Bank of England in May, and in a much higher degree in November, the other banks do not appear to experience the same influence as distinctly. The inference is that the Scotch demand in May and November may be of sufficient importance to affect the rate of the Bank of England. If we refer to Table II, at pp. 82, 83, which contains a summary of the monthly averages of the liabilities and reserve of the Bank of England for the years 1845- 1900, we shall find that the liabilities of the Bank on average have been low in the months of May and November ; that the reserve is comparatively weak in the months of April, May, October and November, and the pro- portion of the reserve to the liabilities low likewise. Something may perhaps be due to payments of dividends in the months of April and October. It is probable that there is some connec- tion between the demands made on the reserve on account of the Irish and Scotch note circulation and these circumstances. The opinion that these demands on the reserve are not specially connected with the ordinary circumstances of the trade of the country is supported by a reference to the returns of the Clearing House when tabulated so as to show the amount of business passing in each month of the year. The particulars from 1868 to 1900 are given in Table 18, in Chapter XIII., at page 133. Those figures do not show any exceptional demand in the month of November and not a very severe demand in May, and as the effect of a severe demand in May is not trace- able in the ordinary course of business of this country, or in the CH. xi] SCOTCH CIRCULATION AFFECTS BANK RESERVE iii rate charged by the Banks of France, Germany, Holland and Belgium, and the severity of the demand in November in those countries is not so great as in England, the inference is that the fluctuations shown to exist at the Bank of England at those periods are influenced in some appreciable degree by the require- ments of the Acts of 1 844-5 in connection with the Scotch and Irish note circulation. This was noticed so far back as 1856 by Mr. T. M. Weguelin, who was at that time governor of the Bank. Mr. Weguelin observed in a letter to the Chancellor of the Exchequer (Sir G. C. Lewis) on the effect of this demand : — " Now with regard to the oscillation of the internal circulation of the country, I may notice that there is periodically a demand for currency from the Scotch and Irish banks, which, whilst it produces a most sensible effect upon the Bank of England reserve, is uncontrollable by any action of the Bank. At certain periods of the year, especially of the harvest, the demand for currency commonly greatly exceeds the authorised issue ; and as the excess must be issued on gold deposited in certain specified places, that gold is withdrawn from the Bank reserve, to be again restored to it when the reflux of the currency of the Scotch and Irish banks takes place, which is usually in the months of December to March. The Scotch banks very generally exceed their authorised aggregate issue ; but with the Irish banks, although the aggregate issue is not usually exceeded, yet it often happens that some are in excess, whilst others are under the authorised amount. But as each bank has to provide for its own excess, the demand on the London bullion reserve is as great as if the whole Irish circulation had gone beyond its limit." The fluctuations in the note circulation in Ireland have rarely been as large as those in the note circulation in Scotland, the periodical fluctuations in which have greatly increased of recent years, and continue to increase. The subject is an important one, and, as mentioned above, requires to be examined into further, owing to the manner in which specie is required to be held against the excess note circulations of Scotland and Ireland by the Bank Acts of 1844-5. This will, therefore, be considered in the next chapter. CHAPTER XII THE SCOTCH AND IRISH NOTE CIRCULATION Fluctuations in the Irish and Scotch Note Circulation, and connection between this and the Bank of England Reserve II2 Increase of Scotch and Irish Note Circu- lation since 1845 . . .112 Table 17 arranged to show the influence of the circulation on the Reserve of the Bank . . . 112-113 Dr. Charles Gairdner on the principle by which the holding of specie is regu- lated . . . 113-115 The Reserve of the Bank of England the only source from which to draw specie . . . . 115 The specie held not a special security, but an asset against general liabilities . 115 Fixed Issues of the Scotch Banks, 1845- igoo . . . . 115 Fixed Issues of the Irish Banks, 1845- 1 900 i 'S Summary Tables, Scotch and Irish Note Circulation and Specie held . .116 Clauses of the Bank Act of 1845 which regulate theholdingof specie against the excess issue in Ireland and Scotland 1 1 6-1 1 7 Table i $. Monthly Averages of Note Cir- culation and of Gold and Silver Coin held in Scotland from 1845-1900 Ii8-I20 Table i6. Monthly Averages of Note Circulation and of Gold and Silver Coin held in Ireland from 1845- 1900 . . . 121-123 Table 17. Monthly Averages of Rate of Discount at the Bank of England and of Note Circulation and Gold and Silver Coin held in Scotland and Ire- land, 1845-1900 . . 124-131 The course of the Irish and Scotch note circulations, and the connection between the fluctuations in them and the reserve of the Bank of England, now require to be considered. By the Bank Acts of 1845 which refer to the Scotch and Irish circulations, specie is compelled to be held against any excess of the issue over the limits authorised by those Acts. The note circulation in both countries, especially in Scotland, has greatly increased since 1845, ^."d I have tabulated the figures, both of the note circulation and of the specie held against it, in the same groups as for the other statements. These will be found in Tables 15 and 16, on pages 1 18-120 and 121-123. In these tables the statements follow the order of the months in each year as they stand in the calendar. As the matter, however, requires further consideration, owing to the influence which the requirements of the note circulations for specie have on the reserve 112 CH. xii] SCOTCH CIRCULATION AFFECTS BANK RESERVE 113 of the Bank, I have arranged the figures again in Table 17, pp. 1 24-1 3 1. In this Table the months are not placed in the order of the calendar, but in that of the month with the smallest circulation first, thus proceeding to the highest. The averages of the Bank of England rate of discount are added, arranged in the same manner. The columns of proportional figures will enable the reader to follow the course of events without difficulty. As a rule it will be observed that the specie held against the note circulation, both in Scotland and in Ireland, corresponds very closely in its movements with the note circulation, fluctuating as the note circulation fluctuates. This is what might be expected. The specie held by the Scotch and Irish banks has reference far more to the note circulation than to their customers' requirements for cash. If the reader will pass his eye along the table, keeping the columns of proportional figures in mind, he will find that as a rule the months in which the note circulation in Scotland and Ireland, the specie held, and the bank rate are highest, in the majority of instances correspond. This is not invariably the case, but the recurrence is sufficiently frequent to suggest a connection between them. The principle by which the holding of the specie is regulated is described in a paper by the late Dr. Charles Gairdner, whom I referred to in the last chapter with reference to the movements in the Scotch note circulation. I quote from him again here, as I know of no other statement which explains the point to which I desire to draw attention, in fewer and clearer words, and have only to express my regret that Dr. Gairdner has left behind him so little in writing on these subjects. Dr. Gairdner headed his remarks on the subject as The Influence Exercised by the Bank Acts of 1844 and 1845. " These Acts proceed on the preamble that ' it is expedient to regulate the issue of bills or notes payable on demand,' and the mode of regulation adopted is by prohibiting the institution of any new bank of issue, and imposing on those in existence certain stringent conditions. It is not my intention on this occasion to enter on the general question of bank notes, a question which would require at least one evening to itself; and I therefore only ask your attention to the manner in which I 114 SCOTCH AND IRISH NOTE CIRCULATION [ch. xii the regulations of the Bank Act exercise an influence on the reserves of coin. " The general principle of the Acts of both years is that gold must be held by the banks of issue, individually, for whatever sum their actual issues exceed their authorised issues. Under the English Act this general principle is qualified by the fact that the country banks of issue in England are prohibited from exceeding, under any circumstances, the amount of their authorised issues, a prohibition which has the effect of com- pelling them to use the notes of the Bank of England to the extent whereby the demand upon them for notes exceeds their authorised issues. Any expansion of notes in England, then, beyond the amount authorised in the Act, is necessarily an expansion of the note circulation of the Bank of England. In Scotland and in Ireland, on the other hand, the banks may increase their circulation to any extent in accordance with the public demand, provided that they have gold at their principal place of issue to an amount not less than the amount of such increase, ascertained as I shall presently explain. " This being the general principle of the Bank Acts, there has to be noted a very important difference in its application in England as compared with Scotland and Ireland. At the Bank of England, where alone in England any expansion of note issues can take place, the official arrangements of the bank are divided into two distinct departments — a note-issuing department and a banking department. From the note depart- ment no notes can legally be issued, even for an hour, in excess of the authorised amount, plus the coin in that department. It follows from this that a sudden demand for notes made on the banking department sufficient to exhaust their reserve will create a deadlock. "In Scotland and in Ireland, on the other hand, no such deadlock need take place, because any demand for notes, to whatever extent it may go, may be legally complied with, provided that on the average of four weeks, ascertained at the close of business on each succeeding Saturday, the issuing banks respectively hold, at their principal place of issue, an amount of gold corresponding with the excess of issue beyond the authorised amount. Contravention of this provision would CH. xii] SCOTCH AND IRISH ISSUES, DEMAND FOR SPECIE 115 involve a certain pecuniary penalty on the offending bank ; but contravention is improbable and unnecessary, because of the time allowed for strengthening the stock of gold through the principle of average over four successive weeks."* The only source, however, from which the gold required can be obtained is from the reserve of the Bank of England. This subject has been referred to in Chapter IX. p. 81. The specie held in Scotland and Ireland does not form a special security against the note circulation. It is an asset held against the general liabilities of the issuing bank. The fixed issue of the Scotch Banks was in 1845 . . . ;^3,o87,209 It was diminished by the failure of the Western Bank of Scotland, 28th August, 1858 ;^337,938 „ City of Glasgow Bank, 2nd October, 1878 72,921 410,859 The fixed issue from 1878 to 1900 was . ... ;£^2, 676,350 Hence as the notes which had been issued by the Western Bank of Scotland and the City of Glasgow Bank were taken up by the other banks, the amount of specie (over ;if 400,000), which represents the issue allowed by the Acts of 1844-5 to the Western Bank of Scotland and the City of Glasgow Bank, is now permanently lodged in Scotland, with some ;^3, 000,000 more held against the excess of the aggregate circulation over the limit allowed. The fixed issue of the banks in Ireland remains the same in 1900 as it was in 1845, ;^6, 3 54,494. Ireland is the only part of the United Kingdom in which the note issue has re- mained without alteration since the Acts of 1 844-5 were passed. The . following statement shows the difference between the highest and the lowest months from 1 845-1 900. It shows how much larger in consequence the demand for specie both in Scotland and Ireland is now than it was in 1845 : — * TAe Constitution and Course of the Money Market, by CHARLES Gairdner, General Manager of the Union Bank of Scotland, Limited. Read before the Economic Section of the Glasgow Philosophical Society, 20th February, 1888 (J. Maclehose and Sons, Glasgow, 1888), pp. 15-17- Ii6 SCOTCH AND IRISH NOTE CIRCULATION [ch. xii Scotch Note Circulation and Specie Held. 1845-1854 1855-1864 1865-1874 1875-1884 1885-1894 1895-1900 I 845-1900 Note Circulation. Difference between the highest month and the lowest month. i. 5S9.000 704,000 814,000 1,072,000 1,092,000 1,380,000 839,000 Mean of the extreme variations during each period. Per Cent. 8-5 8-S 8-5 9-5 9 9'5 Specie Hbld- Difference between the highest month and the lowest month. * 1 98, 000 295,000 511,000 819,000 945,000 1,304,000 568,000 Mean of the extreme variations during each period. Per Cent. 9 6-5 8 10 II 8-S Irish Note Circulation and Specie Held. Note Circulation. Specie Held. 1845-1854 1855-1864 1865-1874 1875-1884 1885-1894 1895-1900 1845-1900 Difference between the highest month and the lowest month. {. 999,000 1,005,000 1,294,000 1,340,000 974,000 1,057,000 Mean of the extreme variations during each period. Per Cent. 9 8 9-5 9-5 7-5 8 8-S Difference between the highest month and the lowest month. ■|-262,000 302,000 518,000 512,000 401,000 422,000 Mean of the extreme variations during each period. Per Cent. 8 7 10 8-5 6-5 7 1,103,000 8-5 35ZiOoo 7 ' 1846-54— Nine years in the case of specie held. + 1846-54 — Nine years in the case of specie held. See Tables 15, 16, 17, pp. 118-131. It will be convenient here to quote the clauses of the Bank Acts of 1845 which regulate the holding of specie against the excess issue in Ireland and Scotland. Anno Octavo et Nono Victories Regtna, Cap. xxxvii. An Act to regulate the Issue of Bank Notes in Ireland, and to regulate the Repayment of certain Sums advanced by the Governor and Company of the Bank of Ireland iox the Public Service. \21St July, 1845.] Clause XX. — And be it enacted. That in taking account of the Coin held by any Banker in Ireland with respect to which Bank Notes to a Account of further Extent than the Sum certified as aforesaid by the Commissioners by any °f Stamps and Taxes may, under the Provisions of this Act, be made and Banker. issued, there shall be included only the Gold and Silver Coin held by such Banker at the several head Offices or principal Places of Issue in Ireland of such Banker, such head Offices or principal Places of Issue not exceeding What shall be taken in the CH. xji] ACTS REGULATING SCOTCH AND IRISH ISSUES 117 Four in Number, of which not more than Two shall be situated in the same Province ; and every Banker shall give Notice in Writing to the said Commissioners, on or before the Sixth Day of December next, of such head Offices or Principal Places of Issue at which the Account of Gold and Silver Coin held by him is to be taken as aforesaid ; and no Amount Silver of Silver Coin exceeding One Fourth Part of the Gold Coin held by such to°exc°ed Banker as aforesaid shall be taken into account, nor shall any Banker be the Pro- authorised to make and issue Bank Notes in Ireland on any Amount of oi[e'°" ° Silver Coin held by such Banker exceeding the Proportion of One Fourth Quarter of Part of the Gold Coin held by such Banker as aforesaid.— 8° et 9" ^°''^" Victoriae, Cap. 37, § xx. Anno Octavo et Nona Victorim Regina, Cap. xxxviii. An Act to regulate the Issue of Bank Notes in Scotland. [21st y«^, 1845.] Clause X. — And be it enacted. That for the Purpose of ascertaining Mode of the monthly average Amount of Bank Notes of each Banker in Circula- fscertam- tion, the aggregate of the Amount of Bank Notes of each such Banker in average Circulation at the Close of the Business on Saturday of each Week during p™"^"' °^ the first complete Period of Four Weeks next after the Sixth Day of Notes of December One thousand eight hundred and forty-five shall be divided by 5?'^*i the Number of Weeks, and the Average so ascertained shall be deemed to circuia- be the Average of Bank Notes of each such Bank in Circulation during p°?^^°^ such Period of Four Weeks, and so in each successive Period of Four during the Weeks ; and the monthly average Amount of Gold and Silver Coin ^'^ ^°°' respectively held as aforesaid by such Banker shall be ascertained in like after 31st Manner from the Amount of Gold and Silver Coin held by such Banker December, at the head Office or principal Place of Issue in Scotland of such Banker at the Close of Business on Saturday in each Week during the same Period; and the monthly average Amount of Bank Notes of each such Banker in Circulation during any such Period of Four Weeks is not to exceed a Sum made up by adding the Amount certified by the Commis- sioners of Stamps and Taxes as aforesaid and the monthly average Amount of Gold and Silver Coin held by such Banker as aforesaid during the same Period. Clause XI. — And be it enacted. That in taking account of the Coin in taking held by any such Banker as aforesaid, with respect to which Bank Notes *^ ^'^\ count of to a further Extent than the Sum certified as aforesaid by the Commis- Coin sioners of Stamps and Taxes may, under the Provisions of this Act, be ^^''^J'y made and issued, no Amount of Silver Coin exceeding One Fourth Part SilverCoin of the Gold Coin held by such Banker as aforesaid shall be taken into not to ex- ceed the account, nor shall any Banker be authorised to make and issue Bank Proportion Notes in Scotland on any amount of Silver Coin held by such Banker 2f ^"^ , ' ' Fourth of exceeding the Proportion of One Fourth Part of the Gold Coin held Gold. by such Banker as aforesaid. — 8° et 9° Victoriae, Cap. 38, §§ x. xi. ii8 SCOTCH AND IRISH NOTE CIRCULATION [ch. xii TABLE IS. Monthly Averages of Note Circulation and of Gold and Silver Coin held in Scotland 1845-1900, in groups of Ten Years, 1845-54, 1855-64, 1865-74, 1875-84, 1885-94, and of Six Years, X895-1900, with Summary Table, 1845-1900. (The returns of the specie held commence in 1846.) Note Circulation. Specie Held. 1845-54. 1846-54. ] Proportion of Specie Circula- tion, 3a7, Average of Month. Average for the Ten Years, ;^3,426,ooo. Average of Ten Years = 100. Average for the Nine Years, ;£i,ogg,ooo. Average of t Nine Years — 100. Nine Years, 327o =iao. January £ 3,426,000 100 £ 1,121,000 102 33 103 February . 3,252,000 95 1,122,000 102 34 106 March 3,163,000 g2 1,113,000 lOJ 35 109 April 3,187,000 93 1,063,000 97 33 103 May 3,396,000 99 1,100,000 100 32 100 June 3,633,000 106 1,118,000 102 3' 97 July 3,401,000 99 1,070,000 97 31 97 August 3,359,000 98 1,031,000 94 31 97 September . 3,364,000 g8 1,014,000 g2 30 94 October 3,497,000 102 1,055,000 g6 30 94 November . 3,710,000 loS 1,174,000 107 3' 97 December . 3,722,000 log I,2I2,000 no 32 100 Diflference : Highest and Lowest Month, ;£ss9,ooo. Difference ; Highest and Lowest Month, ;£x98,coo. Mean of extreme Variations for 1845-54, 8"57o Mean of extreme Variations for 1846-54, 9% Note Circulation. Specie Held. 1855-64. 185M4. 'roportion of Specie Circula- tion, 547, Average of Month. Average for the Ten Years, ;£4,i37,ooo. Average of Ten Years = 100. Average for the Ten Years, ;£a,i33,ooo. Average of Ten Years = 100. Ten Years, 547.= 100. £ £ January . 4,191,000 lOI 2,282,000 102 54 100 February . 3,985,000 g6 2,236,000 100 56 104 March 3,851,000 93 2,180,000 gS 57 106 April 3,814,000 gz 2,197,000 99 5S 107 May 4,048,000 gS 2,242,000 100 55 102 Tune 4,393.000 106 2,299,000 103 53 96 July 4,084,000 99 2,195,000 gS 54 100 August 4,011,000 97 2,144,000 96 53 98 September. 4,042,000 gS 2,099,000 94 52 96 October . 4,242,000 102 2,l8l,00O gS 5' 94 November , 4,470,000 108 2,342,000 los 52 96 December . 4,518,000 log 2,394,000 107 53 98 Difference ; Highest and Lowest Month, ;£704,ooo. Difference : Highest and Lowest Month, ;f 395,000. Mean of extreme Variations for 1853-64, S'fU Mean of extreme Variations for 1855-64, 6's7o Note Circulation. Specie Held. 1865-74. 1865-74. Proportion of Specie to Circula tion, 62''/o Average of Month. Average for the Ten Years, £4,963,000. Average of Ten Years = 100 Average for the Ten Years, ;£3.o75,ooo. Average of Ten Years = 100 Ten Years, 627„= 100. £ £ January . 4,883,000 gS 3,044,000 99 62 100 February . 4,687,000 94- 2,992,000 97 64 103 March 4,593,000 gz 2,923,000 95 64 103 April May . 4,687,000 94 2,917,000 95 62 100 5,098,000 103 3,108,000 lOl 61 98 June . 5,243,000 106 3,210,000 104 61 98 July . . 4,940,000 99 3,044,000 99 62 100 August 4,845,000 gS 2,950,000 gb 61 98 September . 4,842,000 gS 2,940,000 96 61 98 October . 5,043,000 102 3,047,000 99 6t 98 November . 5,284,000 107 3,300,000 107 62 100 December - 5,407,000 log 3,428,000 III (>3 102 Difference : Highest and Lowest Month, ;£8i4,ooo . Difference : Highest and Lowest Month, ;£5xi,ooo. Mean of extreme Variations for 1865-74, 8*s7o Mean of extreme Variations for 1865-74, 87o CH, xii] MONTHLY AVERAGES, NOTES, SPECIE, SCOTLAND 119 TABLE IS (continued). Monthly Averages of Note Circulation and of Gold and Silver Coin held in Scotland 1845-1900, in groups of Ten Years, 1845-54, i855-<54, 1865-74, 1875-84, 1885-94, and of Six Years, 1895- 1900, "^^^ Summary Table, 1845-1900. Note Circulation. 1875-84. Specie Held. 1875-84. Proportion of Specie Circula- tion, 72% Average of Month. Average for the Ten Years, ;C5, 806,000. Average of Ten Years = 100. Average for the Ten Years, j£4,i5o,ooo. Average of Ten Years = 100. Ten Years, 737o=*oo. fanuary February . March April May . June . July . . August September . October . November . December . 5,769,000 5,456,000 5,342,000 5,371,000 5,746,000 6,414,000 5,766,000 5,622,000 5,671,000 5,860,000 6,411,000 6,253,000 99 94 92 g2 99 III 99 ^l 9S lOI no 108 £. 4,191,000 4,008,000 3,912,000 3,852,000 3,998,000 4,529,000 4,127,000 3,915.000 3,923,000 4,111,000 4,671,000 4,566,000 lOt 97 94 96 log 99 94 95 99 113 no 73 73 73 72 70 T 72 6g 70 73 73 101 101 101 100 97 99 100 97 96 97 101 101 Difference : Highest and Lowest Month, ;£i,o72,ooo. Mean of extreme Variations for 1875-84, 9*5% Difference : Highest and Lowest Month, ,£819,000. Mean of extreme Variations for 1875-84, 10% Note Circulation. 1886-94. Specie Held. 1886-94. Proportion of Specie to Circula- tion, 737o Average of Month. Average for the Ten Years, ;£6,xis,ooo. Average of Ten Years = 100. Average for the Ten Years, ;£4,4s6,ooo. Average of Ten Years = 100. Ten Years, 73°/.=ioo. January February . March April May June July August September . October . November . December . 6,044,000 5,706,000 5,576,000 5,734,000 6,431,000 6,433,000 6,168,000 6,003,000 6,031,000 6,074,000 6,515,000 6,668,000 99 93 9' 94 105 los lOI 98 99 99 107 109 £ 4,500,000 4,200,000 4,053,000 3,947,000 4,599,000 4,776,000 4,422,000 4,365,000 4,431,000 4,459,000 4,823,000 4,892,000 lOt 94 %' 8g 103 107 ^Z g8 100 100 108 no 74 74 73 69 72 74 72 73 73 73 74 73 101 101 100 95 99 101 99 100 100 100 101 100 Difference : Highest and Lowest Month, ;£i,o93,ooo. Mean of extreme Variations for 1885-94, 9% Difference : Highest and Lowest Month, ;C945,ooo. Mean of extreme Variations for 1885-94, lo'sVo Note Circolatioh. 1896-1900. Specie Held. 1895-1900. Proportion of Specie to Circula- tion, 8o7. Average of Month. Average for the Six Years, j£7,47J,ooo. Average of Six Years = 100. Average for the Six Years, ;£5,98i,ooo. Average of Six Years = 100. Six Yeats, 80%= 100. January February . March April May June July August September . October . November . December . £ 7,054,000 6,810,000 6,834,000 7,054,000 7,604,000 7,970,000 7,583.000 7,451,000 7,513,000 7,698,000 8,190,000 7,890,000 94 91 9' 94 102 107 lOI 100 lot 103 no 106 £ 5,755,000 5,533.000 5,419,000 5,403,000 5,981,000 6,378,000 6,069,000 5,901,000 6,033,000 6,156,000 6,707,000 6,438.000 gb 93 go 90 100 J07 lOI 99 lOI 103 112 108 77 81 79 77 79 80 80 80 80 80 82 82 96 101 99 96 99 100 100 100 100 100 103 103 Difference : Highest and Lowest Month, ;£i,38o,ooo Mean of extreme Variations for 1895-1900, g's'/o Difference : Highest and Lowest Month, ^1,304,000. Mean of extreme Variations for 1895-igoo, 11% 120 SCOTCH AND IRISH NOTE CIRCULATION [ch. xii TABLE IS (continued). Monthly Averages of Note Circulation and of Gold and Silver Coin held in Scotland 1845-1900, in groups of Ten Years, 1845-54, 1855-64, 1865-74, 1875-84, 1885-94, and of Six Years, 1895-1900, with Summary Table, 1845-1900. (The returns of the specie held commence in 1846.) Note Circulation. Specie Held. 1845-1900. 1846-1900. Proportion of Specie to Circula- tion, 65% Average of Fifty-five Years, 657o=loo. Month. Average for the Fifty- six Years, ;£5,i64,ooo. Average of Fifty-six Years =100. Average for the Fifty- five Years, ^^3,362,000. Average of Fifty-five Years =100. January 5,087,000 99 £ 3,360,000 100 6b 102 February . 4,852,000 94 3,230,000 g6 ii 103 March 4,754,000 gs 3,149,000 94 66 102 April 4,826,000 93 3,111,000 93 <>S 100 May 5,223,000 101 3,368,000 100 65- 100 June 5,520,000 107 3,572,000 J06 ^^ 100 July 5,173,000 100 3,344,000 99 (>S ' 100 August 5,059,000 9S 3,244,000 96 64 98 September . 5,072,000 98 3,259,000 97 64 98 October . 5,222,000 lOI 3.3S3.000 100 64 98 November . 5,593,000 log 3,676,000 jog 66 102 December . 5,590,000 log 3,679,000 no 66 102 Difference: Hig 'best and Lowest Monti , ;£839,QOO. Difference : Highest and Lowest Month, ;£568,ooo. Mean of extrem e Variations for 1845-15 oOi 8's% Mean of extreme Variations for r 845-1900, 8' .7. Fixed Issue, Banks in Scotland, 1845-54 Fixed Issue, Banks in Scotland, 1855 Deduct Western Bank of Scotland, 28th August, 1858 Fixed Issue, Banks in Scotland, 1858-78 Deduct City of Glasgow Bank, 2nd October, 1878 Fixed Issue, Banks in Scotland, 1878-1900 & 3,087,209 £ 3,087,209 337,938 2,749,271 £ 2,749,271 72,921 2,676,350 £ 2,676,350 CH, xji] MONTHLY AVERAGES, NOTES, SPECIE, IRELAND i2i TABLE i6. Monthly Averages of Note Circulation and of Gold and Silver Coin held in Ireland, 1845-1900, in Groups of Ten Years, 1845-54, 1855-64, 1856-74, 1875-84, 1885-94, and of Six Years, 1895-1900, with Summary Table, 1845-1900. (The returns of the specie held commence in 1846.) Note Circulation. 1845-84. Specie Held. 1846-54. Proportion of Specie to Circula- tion, 30% Average of Month. Average for the Ten Years, ;£5.483.ooo. Average of Ten Years —100. Average for the Nine Years, ;£i,6s9,ooo. Average of Nine Years = 100. Nine Years, 30 7. = 100. January February . March April May June July August September . October November . December . 5,803,000 5,789,000 5,665,000 5,630,000 5,520,000 5,235,000 5,041,000 4,931,000 4,946,000 5,423,000 5,930,000 5,885,000 lob X06 103 102 lOI 95 ga go go ^Z 108 107 4 1,756,000 1,773,000 1,766,000 1,703,000 1,648,000 1,704,000 1,591,000 1,563,000 1,511,000 1,561,000 1,649,000 1,692,000 lob 107 100 lOZ 99 102 g6 94 9' 94 99 102 33 30 3' 30 30 3^ 31 3' 3° 28 27 28 110 100 103 100 100 107 103 103 100 93 90 93 Difference : Highest and Lowest Month, ;£999,ooo. Mean of extreme Variations for 1845-54, 9 7. Difference : Highest and Lowest Month, ;f 363,000. Mean of extreme Variations for 1846-54, 8 % 1845, Fixed Issue Banks in Ireland, ;£6,354,494. Note Ciecdlation. 1855-64. Specie Held. 1855-64. Proportion of Specie to Circula- tion, 36 7. Average of Month. Average for the Ten Years, £6,287,000. Average of Ten Years = 100. Average for the Ten Years, ;£s,245,ooo. Average of Ten Years = 100. Ten Years, 36 7. =100. January February . March April May June July August September . October . November . December . 6,518,000 6,547,000 6,430,000 6,369,000 6,388,000 6,093,000 5,820,000 5,690,000 5,836,000 6,495.000 6,695,000 6,569,000 104. J04 102 lOl 102 97 g2 go 93 103 zoo 104 2,374,000 2,359,000 2,304,000 2,236,000 2,203,000 2,189,000 2,138,000 2,109,000 2,095,000 2,215,000 2,324,000 2,397,000 104 '05 103 9? 98 97 95 94 93 99 104 107 3(> 36 35 % 37 % 34 35 37 100 100 100 97 97 100 103 103 100 94 97 103 Difference : Highest and Lowest Month, ;£i,qos,ooo. Mean of extreme Variations from 1855-64, 8 7.. Difference : Highest and Lowest Month, ;£302,ooo. Mean of extreme Variations for 1855-64, 7 7. Note Circulation. 1865-74. Specie Held. 1866-74. Proportion of Specie to Circula- tion =39 Z Average of Month. Average for the Ten Years, ;£6,6i6,638. Average of Ten Years =100. Average for the Ten Years, ;£3,58»,aoo. Average of Ten Years =100. Ten Years, 397.=loo. . 'anuary ?'ebruary . March April . May . June . July . . August September . October . November . December . 6,756,000 6,699,000 6,598,000 6,685,000 6,683,000 6,356,000 6, 149,000 6,067,000 6,113,000 6,773,000 7,361,000 7,158,000 102 lOI 100 lOI tor 96 93 g2 gs 102 III 108 2,706,000 2,634,000 2,570,000 2,531,000 2,532,000 2,476,000 2,415,000 2,393,000 2,391,000 2,583,000 2,841,000 2,909,000 los 102 100 ^i gS 95 94 93 93 zoo no "3 40 39 38 39 39 39 ^Z 3S 39 40 103 100 100 97 97 100 100 100 100 97 100 103 Difference : Highest and Lowest Month, ;£i,294,ooo. Mean of extreme Variations for 1865-74, 9*5 % Difference : Highest and Lowest Month, ;£5i8,ooo. Mean of extreme Variations for 1865-74, *o7o 122 SCOTCH AND IRISH NOTE CIRCULATION [ch. xii TABLE 1 6 {continued). Monthly Averages of Note Circulation and of Gold and Silver Coin held in Ireland, 1845-igoo, in Groups of Ten Years, 1845-54, 1855-64, 1865-74, 1875-84, 1885-94, and of Six Years, 1895-1900, V7ith Summary Table, 1845-1900. Note Circulation. 187&-84. Specie Held. 1875-84. Proportion of Specie to Circula- ion=447. Average of Month. Average for the Ten Years, ;£6,864,ooo. Average of Ten Years = 100. Average for the Ten Years, ;£»,994,ooo. Average of Ten Years = 100. Ten Years, 44 7, =100. January February . March April . May . June . July . . August September . October . November . December . 7,053,000 6,914,000 6,758,000 6,847,000 6,948,000 6,725,000 6,363,000 6,252,000 6,552,000 7,305,000 7,592.000 7,349.000 103 lOI g8 100 lOI 98 93 91 ^i 100 no 107 £ 3,148,000 3,046,000 2,984,000 2,939,000 2,942,000 2,880,000 2,774,000 2,758,000 2,802,000 3,119,000 3,270,000 3,265,000 103 100 gb 93 gz 94 104. log jog 45 44 44 43 42 43 44 H 43 43 43 45 102 100 100 98 95 98 100 100 98 98 98 102 Difference : Highest and Lowest Month, ;fx. 340,000. Mean of extreme Variations for 1875-84, 9*5% Difference : Highest and Lowest Month, £ix2,. Mean of extreme Variations for 1875-84, 8*5 7o Note Circulation. 1885-94. Specie Held. 1885-94. Proportion of Specie to Circula- tion =49 7o Average of Month. Average for the Ten Years, ;£6, 258,000. Average of Ten Years = 100. Average for the Ten Years, ;£3,o89,coo. Average of Ten Years = 100. Ten Years, 497.=ioo. January February . March April . May . June . July . . August September . October November . December . £. 6,454,000 6,276,000 6,147,000 6,317,000 6,369,000 6,025,000 5,892,000 5,865,000 5,877,000 6,342,000 6,839,000 6,691,000 103 100 gS lOI 102 96 94 94 94 lOZ log 107 £. 3,156,000 3,059,000 3,043,000 3,031,000 3,041,000 2,974.000 2,927,000 2,965,000 3,041,000 3,186,000 3,328,000 3,320,000 J03 ^i ^i ^i ^i gb g8 103 108 108 49 49 48 4S 49 50 51 52 50 49 50 100 100 100 98 98 100 102 104 106 102 100 102 Difference : Highest and Lowest Month, ;£974,ooo. Mean of extreme Variations for 1885-94, 7*5 % Difference : Highest and Lowest Month, ;f4oi,ooo. Mean of extreme Variations for 1885-94, 6'5 % Note Circulation. 1895-1900. Specie Held. 1895-1900. Proportion of Specie to Circula- tion, 49 V. Average of Month. Average for the Six Years, ;£6,383,ooo. Average of Six Years = 100. Average for the Six Years, ^£3,147,000. Average of Six Years = 100. Six Years, 497.= 100. January February . March April . May . June . July . . August September . October November . December . £ 6,243,000 6,194,000 6, 190,000 6,442,000 6,576,000 6,208,000 5,984,000 5,995,000 6,181,000 6,907,000 7,041,000 6,640,000 g8 97 97 lot 103 97 94 94 97 108 no 104 £ 3,129,000 3,115,000 3,100,000 3,062,000 3.I3S.OOO 3,087,000 2,998,000 3,001,000 3,148,000 3,311,000 3,420,000 3,253,000 99 99 99 97 too g8 95 9S 100 los log Z04 50 50 50 48 48 50 50 50 51 48 49 49 102 102 102 98 98 102 102 102 104 98 100 100 Difference : Highest and Lowest Month, ;£x,o57,ooo Mean of extreme Variations for 1895-zgoo, 8 % Difference ; Highest and Lowest Month, ;£4a9,ooo. Mean of extreme Variations for 1895-igoo, 7 % CH. xii] MONTHLY AVERAGES, NOTES, SPECIE, IRELAND 123 TABLE 16 (continued). Monthly Averages of Note Circulation and of Gold and Silver Coin held in Ireland, 184S-1900, in Groups of Ten Years, 1845-54, 1855-64, 1865-74, 1875-84, 1885-94, and of Six Years, 1895-1900, with Summary Table, 1845-1900. (The returns of specie held commence in 1846.) Note Circulation. Specie Held. 1845-1900. 1846-1900. Proportion of Specie Average of Fifty-five Month. Average for the Fifty- six Years, ;£6,3i3,ooo. Average of Fifly-six Years =100. Average for the Fifty- five Years, ,£2,599,000. Average of Fifty-five Years =: 100. to Circula- tion, 41 7o Years, 41 7.= 100. January 6,468,000 I02 £ 2,699,000 104 42 102 February . 6,416,000 102 2,648,000 lOB 4' 100 March 6,306,000 100 2,609,000 100 4' 100 April . 6,377,000 lOI 2,565,000 99 40 98 May . 6,405,000 lOI 2,560,000 99 40 98 . une . 6,096,000 97 2,528,000 97 4' 100 July . . 5,876,000 93 2,452,000 94 42 102 August 5,798,000 92 2,442,000 94 42 102 September . 5,881,000 93 2,469,000 93 42 102 October 6,508,000 103 2,635,000 lOI 40 98 November . 6,901,000 log 2,782,000 107 40 98 December . 6,721,000 107 2,794,000 loS 42 102 Difference: Hi ghest and Lowest Month 1 j£i, 103,000. Difference : Highest and Lowest Month, £35 1,000. Mean of extrer (le Variations for 1845-19 00, 8-5 7. Mean of extreme Variations for 1846-1900, 7 ' /. Fixed Issue, Banks in Ireland, 1845-1900 ;f6.3S4.494 124 SCOTCH AND IRISH NOTE CIRCULATION [cH. xii TABLE 17. Monthly Averages of Rate of Discount at the Bank of England, and of Note Circula- gronps of Ten Years, 1845-54, 1855-64, 1865-74, 1875-84, 1885-94, and of Six Years, figures. (The returns of the specie held both in Scotland and Ireland commence 184s- BANK OF ENGLAND. SCOTLAND. Rate of Discount, 1845-54. Note Circolation, 184s- S4. Specie Held, 1846-54. Average Av.of Average Av.of Average Av.of Month. for the Ten Years, Ten Years Montb. for the Ten Years, Ten Years Month. for the Nine Years, Nine Years £3 is. sd- =100. ;£3.4"6,ooo. = 100. ;£i,09g,ooo. =100. £ s. d. £ £ January 3 5 8 p6 March 3, 163,000 gz September. 1,014,000 92 February . 360 96 April. 3,187,000 93 August 1,031,000 94 March 360 qb February . 3,252,000 9.'! October 1,055,000 gb April ■ 3 7 I gH August 3,359,000 <,8 April 1,063,000 97 May . 3 7 7 99 September. 3,364,000 gH uly . 1,070,000 97 September . 3 7 8 99 May. 3,396,000 99 May. 1,100,000 too August 3 7 10 99 :uly . . 3,401,000 99 March 1,113,000 lOZ July . . 380 99 January 3,426,000 100 June. 1,118,000 103 June . 3 8 4 100 October . 3,497.000 102 January 1,121,000 102 October 3 10 ID 104 une . 3,633,000 106 February 1,122,000 102 December . 3 10 10 104 November . 3,710,000 108 November 1,174,000 107 November . 3 15 I no December . 3,722,000 log December 1,212,000 ItO Difference : Highest and Lowest Difference : I iighest and I .owest Difference Highest and Lowest Month, 91. %d. Month, ;£5S9,ot )0. Month, ;^i98,ooo. Mean of extreme Variations for Mean of ext reme Variatio ns for Mean of extreme Variations for 1B45-54. 7°/. 1845-54, 8-s7. 1846-54, 9% I8SS- BANK OF ENGLAND. SCOTLAND. Rate of Discount, 1855-64. Note Circulation, 1855-64. Specie Held, 1855-64. Average Av.of Average Av.of Average Av.of Month. for the Ten Years, Ten Years Month. for the Ten Years, Ten Years Month. for the Ten Years, Ten Years £^ I2S. gd. = zoo. ,£4,137,000. = 100, ^2,233,000. = 100. £ s. d. £ £ August 432 go April 3,814,000 g2 September. 2,099,000 94 July . . 4 4 5 9' March 3,851,000 93 August 2,144,000 9b September . 446 9' February . 3,985,000 gb March 2,180,000 9S June . 496 97 August 4,011,000 97 October . 2,181,000 98 April . 4 II 2 gS September. 4,042,000 g8 July . . 2,195,000 98 October . 4 12 4 99 May . 4,048,000 g8 April.' 2,197,000 99 March 4 12 5 100 July . . 4,084,000 99 February . 2,236,000 JOO January 4 15 8 los January 4,191,000 lOI May. 2,242,000 100 May . 4 15 8 103 October . 4,242,000 102 January 2,282,000 102 February . 4 16 5 104 June . 4,393,000 J06 June . 2,299,000 103 December _, 5 3 3 III November. 4,470,000 108 November . 2,342,000 'OS November . 5 4 9 "3 December . 4,518,000 log December . 2,394,000 107 Difference : Highest and Lowest Difference : J highest and Lowest Difference : Highest and Lowest Month, £z IS. "jd. Month, ;£704.oc Xl. Month, ;£395,o 30. Mean of extreme Variations for Mean of ext reme Variations for Mean of ex treme Variations for 1855-64, "•j7. 1855-64, 8-57. 1855-64, 6-57. CH. xii] MONTHLY AVERAGES, BANK RATE, NOTES, SPECIE 125 TABLE 17 {continued). tion, and of Gold and Silver Coin held, in Scotland and in Ireland, from 1845-1900, in 1895-1900, with Summary Table, 1845-igoo, arranged from the smallest to the largest with the year 1846.) 1854. IRELAND. Note Circolation, i84S-'i4. Specie Held, 1846-54. Average for the Average of Average for the Average of Month. Ten Years, Ten Years Month. Nine Years, Nine Years ;£5,483,oao. = 100. ;£i ,659,000. — 100. August 4,931,000 90 September . 1,511,000 9' September 4,946,000 go October . 1,561,000 94 July . 5,041,000 <)2 August 1,563,000 94 June . 5,235,000 95 July . . 1,591,000 96 October 5,423,000 99 May . 1,648,000 99 May . 5,520,000 lOI November . 1,649,000 99 April . 5,630,000 lOS December . 1,692,000 102 March 5,665,000 103 April . 1,703,000 102 February 5,789,000 106 June . 1,704,000 102 . anuary 5,803,000 106 January 1,756,000 106 December 5,885,000 107 March 1,766,000 106 November . 5,930,000 108 February . 1,773.000 m Difference : Highest and Lowest Month, ;£g99,ooo. Difference : Highest and Lowest Month, ^26j,ooo. Mean of extreme Variations for 1845-54, gVa Mean of extreme Variations for 1846-54, 87o 1864. IRELAND. Note Circulation, 1855-64. Specie Held, 1855-64. Average for the Average of Average for the Average of Ten Years Month. Ten Years, Ten Years Month. Ten Years, ;£6, 387,000. = 100. j£2,245,ooo. =100. August 5,690,000 90 September . 2,095,000 93 July . 5,820,000 92 August 2,109,000 94 September 5,836,000 93 July . . 2,138,000 9S June . 6,093,000 97 June . 2,189,000 97 April . 6,369,000 lOI May . 2,203,000 gS May . 6,388,000 102 October . 2,215,000 99 March 6,430,000 t02 April . 2,236,000 99 October 6,495,000 103 March 2,304,000 J03 fanuary 6,518,000 104 November . 2,324,000 104 February 6,547,000 104 January 2,374,000 104 December 6,569,000 104 February . 2,359,000 105 November 6,695,000 106 December . 2,397,000 107 Difference ; Highest and Lowest Month, i£i,oo5,ooo. Difference : Highest and Lowest Month ;C]03,00a. Mean of extreme Variations for 1855-64, 87o Mean of extreme Variations for 1855-64, I'L 126 SCOTCH AND IRISH NOTE CIRCULATION [ch. xh TABLE 17 {continued). Monthly Averages of Rate of Discount at the Bank of England, and of Note Circula- groups of Ten Years, 1845-54, 1855-64, 1865-74, 1875-84, 1885-94, and of Six largest figures. 1865- BANK OF ENGLAND. SCOTLAND. Rate of Discount, i»65-74. Note Circulation, 1865-74. Specie Held, 1865-74. Average Av.of Average Av.of Average Av.of Month. for the Ten Years, Ten Years Month. for the Ten Years, Ten Years Month. for the Ten Years, Ten Years i,-i xts. \d. = 100. ^£4,963,000. = 100. ;£3,075,000. = 100. £ s. d. £ £ September . 322 82 March 4,593,000 92 April. 2,917,000 9.5 March 3 10 I 92 February . 4,687,000 94 March 2,923,000 9.S April . 3 II II 94 April 4,687,000 94 September. 2,940,000 qb February . 3 12 9 9t> September. 4,842,000 q8 August 2,950,000 qb July . . 3 13 10 97 August 4,845,000 qS February . 2,992,000 97 August 3 13 II 97 January 4,883,000 q8 January 3,044,000 99 January 3 17 8 lOI July . . 4,940,000 99 July . . 3,044,000 99 December . 3 19 I 104 October . 5,043,000 102 October . 3,047,000 99 June . 3 19 8 ''OS May . 5,098,000 '03 May . 3,108,000 lOI October 3 19 II •^05- June . 5,243,000 106 June . 3,210,000 104 May . 4 3 8 no November . 5,284,000 107 November . 3,300,000 107 November . 4 8 8 117 December . 5,407,000 tog December . 3,428,000 III Difference : Highest and Lowest Difference : I lighest and Lowest Difference: Highest and Lowest Month, £1 6s. 6d. Month, ;f 8r4,oc 0, Month, ;£5Xi,ooo, Mean of extreme Variations for Mean of ext reme Variations for Mean of extreme Variations for 1865-74, I7'57. 1865-74, 8-57. 1865-74, 87. 187s- BANK OF ENGLAND. SCOTLAND. Rate of Discount, 1875-84. Note Circulation, 1875-84. Specie Held, 1875-84. Average Av.of Average Av.of Average Av.of Month. for the Ten Years, Ten Years Month. for the Ten Years, Ten Years Month. for the Ten Years, Ten Years £-i 31. iirf. = 100. ;£s,8o6,ooo. = 100. ;£4,l5o,ooo. = 100. £ s. d £ £ :uiy . . 2 14 6 Us March 5,342,000 92 April 3,852,000 P7 une . 2 IS 2 8b April 5,371,000 q2 March 3,912,000 94 April . 2 IS 8 ii7 February . 5,456,000 94 August 3,915,000 94 August 2 IS 9 a? August 5,622,000 97 September. 3,923,000 Pi May . 2 16 3 88 September. 5,671,000 q8 May . 3,998,000 qb September . 3 I 3 qb May . 5,746,000 99 February . 4,008,000 97 March 3 I 7 qb July . . 5,766,000 99 October . 4,111,000 99 February . 3 S II 103 January 5,769,000 99 July . . 4,127,000 9Q October . 3 10 10 III October . 5,860,000 lOI January 4,191,000 lOI December . 3 15 10 iiq December . 6,253,000 108 June . 4,529,000 loq anuary 3 17 S 121 November . 6,411,000 no December . 4,566,000 no November . 3 18 2 122 June . 6,414,000 III November . 4,671,000 "3 Difference : Highest and ] ..owest Difference : ] highest and I owest Difference : I highest and Lowest Month, £1. 3^. id. Month, £1,073, cxx>. Month, ;£8i9,oc 0. Mean of extreme Variatic ns for Mean of ext reme Variatio ns for Mean of ext reme Variations for 1B75-84, 18-57. 1875-84, 9-s7. 1875-84, io7. CH. xii] MONTHLY AVERAGES, BANK RATE, NOTES, SPECIE 127 TABLE 17 {continued). tion, and of Gold and Silver Coin held, in Scotland and in Ireland, 1845-1900, in Years, 1895-1900, with Summary Table, 1845-1900, arranged from the smallest to the 1874. IRELAND. NoTS Circulation, 1865-74. Specie Held, 1865-74. Average for the Average of Average for the Average of Month. Ten Years, Ten Years Month. Ten Years, Ten Years ;£6,6i7,c»o. = 100. ;£2,582,0OO. = 100. August 6,067,000 92 September . 2,391,000 93 September . 6,113,000 <)2 August 2,393,000 93 July . . 6,149,000 93 :uly . 2,415,000 94 June . 6,356,000 g6 une . 2,476,000 9S March 6,598,000 100 April . 2,531,000 98 May . 6,683,000 lOI May . 2,532,000 g8 April . 6,685,000 lOI March 2,570,000 100 February . 6,699,000 101 October 2,583,000 100 January 6,756,000 102 February 2,634,000 102 October . 6,773,000 102 January 2, 706,000 zos December . 7,158,000 Z08 November 2,841,000 no November . 7,361,000 III December 2,909,000 "3 Difference; Highe 3t and Lowest Month, ;£l,294,00O. Difference : Highest and Lowest Month, ;^5i8,ooo. Mean of extreme ^ Variations for 1865-74, 9-S°/, Mean of extreme Variations for 1865-74, ro% 1884. IRELAND. Note Circolatiom, 1875-84. Specie Held, 1875-84. Average for the Average of Ten Years Average for the Average of Month. Ten Years, Month. Ten Years, Ten Years ;£6,864,ooo. = 100. ,£2,994,000. = 100. August 6,252,000 91 August 2,758,000 92 July . . 6,363,000 93 July . 2,774,000 93 September . 6,552,000 9S September 2,802,000 94 June . 6,725,000 98 June . 2,880,000 96 March 6,758,000 98 April. 2,939,000 9* April , 6,847,000 100 May . 2,942,000 98 February . 6,914,000 lOI March 2,984,000 100 May . 6,948,000 lOI February 3,046,000 102 January 7,053,000 103 October 3,119,000 104 October . 7,305,000 106 January 3,148,000 105 December . 7,349,000 107 December 3,265,000 log November . 7,592,000 no November 3,270,000 tog Difference : Highe St and Lowest Month, ;£r,34o,ooo. Difference : Highest and Lowest Month, ;£Sr2,QOO. Mean of extreme ^ ''ariations for 1875-84, 9-5% Mean of extreme Variations for r875-84. 8-5% 128 SCOTCH AND IRISH NOTE CIRCULATION [ch. xu TABLE 17 {continued). Monthly Averages of Rate of Discount at the Bank of England, and of Note Circula- groups of Ten Years, 1845-54, 1855-64, 1865-74, '875-84, 1885-94, and of Six Years, figures. 1885- BANK OF ENGLAND. SCOTLAND. Rate of Discount, 1885-94. Note Circulation, 1885-94. Specie Held, 1885-94. Average Av.of Average Av.of Average Av.of Month. for the Ten Years, Ten Years Month. for the Ten Years, Ten Years Month. for the Ten Years, Ten Years ii y- id. = 100. ;£6,II5,000. = 100. A,4S6,ooo. = 100. £ s. d. £ £ July . . 290 ^8 March 5,576,000 9' April . 3,947,000 89 June . 2 10 10 Hi February . 5,706,000 9H March 4,053,000 9-f April. 2 13 2 84 April . s> 734.000 94 February . 4,200,000 94 May . 2 14 2 8b August 6,003,000 9li August 4,365,000 98 August 2 16 6 8g September . 6,031,000 99 July . . 4,422,000 99 March 2 18 6 93 January 6,044,000 99 September . 4,431.000 100 September . 3 4 4 103 October . 6,074,000 99 October . 4,459,000 100 February . 3 6 « 'OS July . . 6,168,000 lOI January 4,500,000 lOI October . 3 10 1 III May - 6,431,000 lOi May . 4,599,000 los November . 3 16 9 132 June . 6,433,000 101 June . 4,776,000 107 December . 3 17 4 IZ2 November . 6,515,000 107 November . 4,823,000 108 January . 4 I 1 128 December . 6,668,000 log December . 4,892,000 no Difference: Highest and Lowest Difference : '. ■iighest and Lowest Difference: Highest and Lowest Month, ^i i2s. \d. Month, £x,oq2t 300. Month, ;£945,ooo. Mean of extreme Variations for Mean of ext reme Variations for Mean of extreme Variations for 1885-94, as7. 1885-94, 9% 1885-94, 10-5% 189s- BANK OF ENGLAND. SCOTLAND. Rate of Discount, 1895-1900. Note Circulation, 1895-1900. Specie Held, 1895-1900. Average Av.of Average Av.of Average Av.of Month. for the Six Years, Six Years Month. for the Six Years, Six Years Month. for the Six Years, Six Years £l oj. 4i. = 100. ;£7,47i,ooo. =100. ;£5,98i,ooo. = 100. £ s. d. £ £ June . 2 10 7 84 February . 6,810,000 91 April . 5,403,000 90 July . . 2 10 10 84 March 6,834,000 91 March 5,419.000 90 August 2 13 6 89 January 7,054,000 94 February . 5,533,000 «7 September . 2 15 5 92 April . 7,054,000 94 January 5,755,000 9b February . 2 16 5 94 August 7,451,000 100 August 5,901,000 99 March 2 16 8 94 September . 7,513,000 lOI May . 5,981,000 100 May . 2 17 4 9.'> July . . 7,583,000 lOI September . 6,033,000 lOI April . 2 17 8 9b May . 7,604,000 103 July . . 6,069,000 lOI January 3 6 S no October . 7,698,000 103 October . 6,156,000 103 October 392 ii.H December . 7,890,000 lob June . 6,378,000 107 November . 3 13 4 131 June . 7,970,000 107 December . 6,438,000 108 December . 3 16 8 I2-J November . 8,190,000 no November . 6,707,000 112 Difference : Highest and Lowest Difference: Highest and Lowest Difference: lighest and L owest Month, £t. 6s. id. Month, ;£i, 380,000. Month, ;£i,304, 000. Mean of extreme Variations for Mean of extreme Variations for Mean of ext reme Variatio IS for 1895-1900, 21-57. 1895-1900, 9'57. 1895-1900, ii7o CH. xii] MONTHLY AVERAGES, BANK RATE, NOTES, SPECIE 129 TABLE 17 (contiHHed). Uon, and of Gold and Silver Coin held, in Scotland and in Ireland, 1845-1900, in 1895-1900, with Summary Table, 1845-1900, arranged from the smallest to the largest 1894. IRELAND. Note Circulation, 1885-1894. Specie Held, 1885-1894. Average for the Average of Ten Years Average for the Average of Month. Ten Years, Month. Ten Years, Ten Years ;£6,3S8,000. = 100. ;£3,o89,ooo. ==100. August £. 5,865,000 94 July . . . 2,927,000 95 September 5,877,000 94 August 2,965,000 96 July . 5,892,000 94 June . 2,974,000 96 June . 6,025,000 96 April . 3,031,000 9S March 6,147,000 98 May . 3,041,000 98 February 6,276,000 too September . 3,041,000 98 April . 6,317,000 lOl March 3,043,000 98 October 6,342,000 lOt February . 3,059,000 99 May . 6,369,000 103 January 3,156,000 102 January 6,454,000 103 October 3,186,000 103 December 6,691,000 107 December . 3,320,000 108 November 6,839,000 109 November . 3,328,000 108 Difference ; Highest and Lowest Month, :£974,ooo. Difference ; Highest and Lowest Month, ;C40i,ooo. Mean of extreme Variations for 1885-94, Ti'U Mean of extreme Va iriations for 1885-94, 6-s7. 1900. IRELAND. Note Circulation, 1895-1900. Specie Held, 1895-1900. Average for the Average of Average for the Average of Month. Six Years, Six Years Month. Six Years, Six Years ,£6,383,000. = 100. ,£3,147,000. = 100. £ £, July . . . 5,984,000 94 July . . . 2,998,000 95 August 5,995,000 94 August 3,001,000 95 September 6,181,000 97 April . 3,062,000 97 March 6, 190,000 97 June . 3,087,000 98 February 6,194,000 97 March 3, 100,000 99 June . 6,208,000 97 February . 3,115,000 99 January 6,243,000 98 January . 3,129,000 99 April . 6,442,000 lOI May . 3,135.000 100 May . 6,576,000 Z03 September . 3,148,000 100 December 6,640,000 104 October 3,311,000 105 October 6,907,000 108 December . 3.253.000 104 November 7,041,000 no November . 3,420,000 log Difference : Highest and Lowest Month, ;£l,057,ooo. Difference : Highest and Lowest Month, t^n, Difference : Highest and Lowest Month, ^£352,000. Mean of extreme Variations for 1846-1900, 77. CHAPTER XIII RETURNS OF THE LONDON BANKERS' CLEARING HOUSE The returns of the London Bankers' Clear- ing House a source of information as to business activity in the country Table 1 8. Monthly Averages of London Bankers' Clearing House Returns, i868-igoo . ... Comparison of Monthly Averages and Annual Averages Variations of Turnover of Clearing House have diminished, virhile those of Rate of Discount have increased Totals for 1868-1900 Fluctuations in the Clearing House Re- turns show no correspondence with 132 133 134 134 134 those of the Rate at the Bank of Eng- land . . . . 13s Months of Highest Rates at the Banks of England, France, Germany, Holland and Belgium, compared with Clearing House returns . . . 13S-136 Months of Maximum Note Circulation in Scotland and Ireland . . . 1 36 Transactions of the Clearing House earlier than 1868 . . . . 136 Table 19. Exports and Imports, Clearing House Returns, and total Bank Note Circulation, years 1861, 1871, 1881, 1891, and 1900 . . . 137 The returns of the London Bankers' Clearing House provide one of the best sources of information we possess as to the activity of business in this country, and to those periods of the year when that activity is greatest. Much may be learned from the monthly returns of exports and imports published by the Board of Trade, but the Clearing House returns bring the main points as to activity of business together in the most distinct form available. In order to show these points clearly these returns have been tabulated, and as far as possible formed into groups of years corresponding to those into which the other tables in this volume are arranged (Table i8). In the case of the Clearing House returns, however, there was this difficulty : while the other tables are carried back to 1844 and 1845, the Clearing House returns have only been published continuously onwards from 1868. To make the figures correspond as far as possible, the first seven years, 1868-74, were brought into one group. This enabled the remaining years to be divided in the same manner as the corresponding periods have been in the other tables. The averages shown are the monthly averages of the turn- over at the Clearing House. Being thus taken out in months, they are in the aggregate the twelfth part of the actual turnover. 132 CH. xiii] MONTHLY AVERAGES, CLEARING HOUSE RETURNS 133 TABLE 18. Monthly Averages of London Bankers' Clearing House Returns 1868-1900, in groups of Seven Years, 1868-74 ; Ten Years, 1875-84 ; Ten Years, 1885-94 ; a°d Six Years, 1895-1900; with Summary Table, 1868-1900. 1868-74. 1875-84. 1885-94. 1895-1900. Month. Average for the Seven Years, ^£398,669,000. Av.of Seven Years = 100. Average for the Ten Years, ^£464,863,000. Av.of Ten Years = 100. Average for the Ten Years, ;£s49,Si4,ooo. Av.of Ten Years = 100. Average fOr the Six Years, ;£676,89o,ooo. Av.of Six Years = 100. January , February . March April May . 1 une . July . . August September. October November . December . 385,314,000 354,609,000 412,781,000 417,886,000 386,194,000 37S.S97,ooo 456,721,000 387,185,000 386,693,000 408,231,000 391,855,000 420,971,000 97 89 104 los 97 94 "5 97 97 102 106 £. 522,619,000 451,494,000 495,646,000 457,057,000 485,025,000 454,716,000 473,489,000 450,427,000 407,233,000 484,328,000 443,695,000 452,644,000 tI2 106 9S 104 9S 102 97 88 104 gb 97 £ 576,519,000 549,991,000 593,010,000 531,620,000 555, 367^000 524,401,000 581,656,000 534,846,000 497, S2 1.000 568,144,000 530,912,000 550,183,000 100 loS 97 lOI 106 97 9' 103 97 JOO 722,760,000 643,989,000 712,738,000 623,821,000 702,252,000 651,879,000 718,389,000 668,793,000 608,945,000 709,243,000 687,504,000 672,368,000 107 95 los 92 104 ^i 106 99 90 'OS 102 99 Difference : Highest and Lowest Month, ;£i03, 112,000. Mean of extreme Variations for 1868-74, 13°/. Difference : Highest and Lowest Month, ;£ii5,386,ooo. Mean of extreme Variations for 1875-84, Difference: Highest and Lowest Month, ;j95,489,ooo. Mean of extreme Variations for 1885-94, 8-57. Difference: Highest and Lowest Month, ;£lt3,8l5,00O. Mean of extreme Variations for 1895- jgoo, 8 -57. 1868-1900. Average of Month. Average for the Thirty-three Years Thirty-three Years, = 100. ;£si4,99i,ooo. £ January . 546,216,000 106 February 495,728,000 96 March . 547,044,000 106 April 501,657,000 97 May 524,872,000 102 June 494,897,000 96 July . 547,234,000 106 August . 502,296,000 97 September 466,837,000 9' October . 534,521,000 104 November 503,457,000 9S ^ecember 515,129,000 too Difference : Highest and Lowest Month, ;£8o,3g7,ooo. Mean of extreme Variations for i868-igoo, 7*5 % 134 RETURNS OF THE CLEARING HOUSE [ch. xiii But the proportions which they show of the fluctuations result- ing correspond. That the basis is accurate is shown by- comparing the averages in Table i8, p. 133, with the actual averages of the periods given. The figures are as follows : — LONDON CLEARING HOUSE. Monthly Averages. 1868-1874 . . £3gS,66g,ooo=ioo 1875-1884 . . 464,863,000=776 1885-1894 1895-1900 549, 5 14.000 =7j,S 676,890,000=770 Annual Averages. 1868-1874 . . ;^4,8is, 144,000=700 1875-1884 . . 5,567,045,000=776 1885-1894 . . 6,599,638,000=7^7 1895-1900 . . 8,144,458,000=769 It will be observed from Table 18 that the mean of the extreme variations of the turnover of the Clearing House has gradually diminished during the period tabulated. In this respect what has occurred differs from the results shown by the variations in the discount rate at the Bank of England, which, with the exception of the period 1895- 1900, have continually increased in intensity during the corresponding time, as shown in Table 12, p. 97, and Table 36, pp. 192, 193 — having been in- creasing from 1845 onwards. Periods. 1845-54 1855-64 1865-74 1875-84 1885-94 1895-1900 E OF Discount. London Bankers' Clearing House. Mean of the extreme Variations during each period. % Periods. Mean of the extreme Variations during each period. 7 775 i8-s 21.5 1868-74 1875-84 . 1885-94 189S-1900 . % '3 JZ s-s As it may be convenient to over of the London Clearing 1868 to 1900 are given. follow the progress of the turn- House, the total returns from LONDON BANKERS' CLEARING HOUSE 1868 1869 1870 1871 1872 1873 1874 187s 1876 1877 1878 1879 1880 1881 1882 1883 1884 Totals for the Year. £ 3,425,185,000 3,626,396,000 3,914,220,000 4,826,034,000 5,916,452,000 6,070,948,000 5.936,772,000 5.685,793,000 4,963,480,000 5,042,383,000 4.992,398,000 4.885,937,000 5.794.238,000 6,357,059.000 6,221,206,000 5,929,404,000 5,798,555,000 Proportion of amount in each year to x868. i8eS=ioo. 100 106 114 141 172 177 173 166 145 «47 146 143 169 i8s 181 173 169 Year. 1885 1886 1887 1888 1889 1890 1891 1892 1893 1894 1895 1896 1897 1898 1899 1900 RETURNS, 1868-1900. Proportion of Totals for the amount in each Year. year to 1868, £ 1868 = 100. 5,511,071,000 . 161 5,901,925,000 . 172 6,077,097,000 . 177 6,942,172,000 . 203 7,618,766,000 . 223 7,801,048,000 . 228 6,847,506,000 . 200 6,481,562,000 . 190 6,478,013,000 . 189 6,337,222,000 . 185 7,592,886,000 7,574,853.000 7,491,281,000 8,097,291,000 9,150,269,000 8,960,170,000 222 221 219 237 268 262 CH. xiii] PERIODS OF BUSINESS ACTIVITY 135 As a period of active business is generally reflected in the discount market by a high rate, it might have been expected that the months in which most activity was shown in the clearings would be the months which showed the highest rate of discount. But this is not the case. The months in which on average for the fifty-six years, 1845- 1900, the highest rates of discount have been charged are the months of October, November, December, and January — the three months at the close and the earliest month of the year. But the clearing returns show a generally different range of activity. According to them the months of greatest business activity are January. March, May, July, and October — the first and third months at the commencement of the year, the second month of the second quarter, the first month of the second half year, and the first month of the last quarter. January, July and March are all on a level, October comes next, and then May. It is easy to understand that these months may very well be periods of business activity, but it is not so easy to understand why this being the case the charges for discount at the Bank of England do not correspond. The activity of business is indicated by the amount of the cheques in circulation, and it might naturally have been expected that higher rates of discount would follow if these depended only on the demands of business. It may be remarked, in passing, that the highest months in the returns of the Banks of France, Germany, Holland and Belgium more or less correspond with each other, and that at none of these banks are the months of October and November marked by such exceptionally high rates as at the Bank of England. In all of them the winter months — and in the case of France and Holland the months of early spring also — are months of higher rates than the remainder of the year. These points are of importance so far as they appear to imply that the requirements of the Bank Acts of 1844-5 exercise an influence over the rate of discount charged in this country by causing the rate at some periods of the year to be higher than it naturally would have been owing to the demands made through the operation of the Act on the reserve of the Bank. This point is more fully discussed in Chapters IX. and XIX., p. 81 and p. 190. 136 RETURNS OF THE CLEARING HOUSE [cH. xm Table 15, with the monthly averages of the Scotch note circulation and of the specie held against it, shows (pp. 1 18-120) what the requirements for specie for Scotland were in May, June, November and December. Table 16, pp. 12 1-3, gives the corresponding information for Ireland. Table 17, pp. 1 24-1 31, compares these points with the Bank rate. The months of maximum circulation were not precisely the same in Scotland and Ireland, but for the autumn and winter they fairly correspond. To facilitate comparison the proportions of the average rate of discount of each month to the annual average discount rate at the Banks of England, France, Germany, Holland and Belgium are added, with the corresponding proportions of the turnover at the Clearing House in London. Proportion of Average M onthly Discount Rate to Average Annual Rate, fifty-six years at Banks of England, France, Germany, Holland, Belgium fifty years, and of Monthly Averageto Yearly Average at London Bankers' Clearing House thirty-three years. Bank of Bank of Bank of Bank of Bank of London Clearing House (SeeTablelS) Average of Thirty-three Years =100. England France Germany Holland Belgium Month. (SeeTablel2) (SeeTable21) (SeeTable2B) (SeeTableSO) (SeeTable33) Month. Average of Average of Average of Average of Average of Fifty-six Fifty-six Fifty-six Fifty-six Fifty Years =100. Years= loo. Years =100. Years= lOo, Years =100. January 1 10 io5 106 106 104 lo5 January '. February . 99 104 97 103 99 96 February March 96 lOI 94 99 95 106 March April . 93 98 94 96 95 97 April May . 99 98 96 97 98 102 May June . 92 9S 96 94 96 96 June July . . 89 95 97 95 96 106 July August 92 96 96 96 97 97 August September . 92 96 100 96 98 91 September October 108 103 107 lOI 104 104 October November . 116 106 109 107 no 98 November December . "3 loS no no 108 100 December There is but little to show what the transactions of the Clearing House were earlier than the year 1868. It is stated in the minutes of evidence taken before the Committee of the House of Commons on the Bank of England Charter, 1832 (No. 3,624, p. 258), that in 1810 "the daily amount of the transactions of the Clearing House varied from ;^5, 000,000 to ;if 15,000,000, and that the amount of bank notes paid were from ;^2 50,000 to ;if5oo,ooo." The amount passed by the principal banking houses in London at the Clearing House in 1839 is given as ;^94i,40i,6oo (^Principles of Money, by John Wade, 1842, p. 79). These indications are too slight to build any useful inferences on them as to the course of business in the CH. xiii] EXPORTS AND IMPORTS, CLEARINGS AND NOTES 137 first half of last century. The figures for 1 868, however, given on p. 134, allow us to form a rough estimate of the amount in 1861, and the following table (Table 19) enables us to compare the exports and imports, the amount of the clearing, and the total bank note circulation of the United Kingdom at every decade from 1 86 1 to 1900. It will be seen from this that during the forty years over which the table extends, while the exports and imports collectively increased in the proportion of from 100 to 244, the total amount of the clearings increased in the proportion of from 100 to 320 — a far larger proportion — while the note circulation had only extended from 100 to 124, an increase of only about half the growth of the exports and imports. It is in the clearings that the great extension has taken place, the paper circulation of the country being now for practical purposes mainly in cheques, against which, it may be remarked in passing, no adequate specie reserve has been provided. TABLE 19. Exports and Imports of United Kingdom, Amounts passed through the London Clearing House, and the Total Bank Note Circulation of all the Issuing Banks in the United Kingdom for the years 1861, 1871, 1881, 1891, and 1900. Year. Declared Value of Exports and Imports (See Note i). Increase of Exports and Imports, 1861 = 100. Amount of Clearing in the Year stated. Increase of Clearing since x86i, 1861 = 100. Decimal Proportion of Total Exports and Imports to Clearing. Total Bank Note Circula- tion in the United Kingdom. Increase in Bank Note Cir- culation since x86i, 1861 = 100. Year. l86l. Exports Imports £ 125,100,000 183,000,000 too 160 201 244 (say) 2,800,000,000+ 4,826,000,000 6,357.000,000 6,848,000,000 8,960,000,000 700 JJO 227 3Z0 •110 •103 •9/ •84 £ 36,585,000 42,060,000 41,791.000 40,296,000 45,460,000 100 114 no 124 Total 308,100,000 1861 1871. Exports Imports 223,100,000 270,500,000 Total . 493,600,000 1871 1881. Exports Imports Total . 234,000,000 333,900,000 567,900,000 1881 1891. Exports Imports 247,000,000 373.500.000 Total 620,500,000 189I 1900. Exports Imports 291,192,000 459,893.000 Total . 751,085,000 1900 Note i. — The re-exports of foreign and colonial produce is deducted from the imports in this statement, thus showing the net amount of imports retained in the country. + Estimated amount of the clearing. CHAPTER XIV THE AUTUMNAL DRAIN The Autumnal Drain takes its origin from the requirements of the season . 138 Table 20. Statement showing the Autum- nal Movements in Gold and Silver, Coin held by the Bank of England, 1881-1900 . . . . 138 Influence of the Bank Acts of 1844-5 °^ the Autumnal Drain . . .139 Gold taken from the Reserve of the Bank of England as basis of Note circulation in Scotland and Ireland . Examples of this and large proportion of amount drawn from Bank during the Autumnal Drain on account of require- ments of Acts of 1844-S 139 139 Effect of this movement on the Bank Rate 139 This name is given to a movement of coin throughout the country in the months of autumn, which sometimes reaches very considerable proportions. It takes its origin, no doubt, from the requirements of the season, which stimulate employment in agriculture, and set large masses of the population free for an autumnal holiday. The following statement shows the movement of specie from the Bank of England for the years from 1 88 1 to 1900: — TABLE 20. statement showing the Autumnal Movements in Gold and Silver Coin held by the Bank of England for the years 1881-1900— beginning of September to about the middle of November in each year. Gold Coin. Silver Coin. Received from Taken for Taken for Received from or taken Total Decrease. Increase Year. or taken for Scotland Ireland for Home Circulation or Abroad on Balance. on Balance. on Balance. on Balance. Decrease. Reed, from Taken for Reed, from Taken for £ i £ £ £ £ £ £ 1881 1,772,000 811,000 430,000 788,000 3,801,000 60,000 1882 ... 417,000 838,000 610,000 880,000 2,745,000 19,000 1883 413,000 795,000 180,000 873.000 2,261,000 92,000 1884 ... 1,460,000 765,000 270,000 ... 935,000 3,430,000 67,000 1885 ... 754,000 660,000 1,110,000 252,000 2,776,000 13,000 1886 259,000 717.000 330,000 391,000 1,179,000 88,000 1887 3S3.0OO 575,000 25,000 ... 383,000 630,000 57,000 1888 2,513,000 44S.O0O 420,000 689,000 4,067,000 141,000 1889 2,431,000 612,000 300,000 640,000 3,983,000 414,000 1890 2,009,000 616,000 480,000 1,215,000 4,320,000 174,000 1891 1,471,000 478,000 320,000 ... 288,000 2,559,000 77,000 1892 1,856,000 533.000 235,000 720,000 3,344,000 153,000 1893 65,000 800,000 440,000 724,000 451,000 146,000 1894 74,000 ... 584,000 300,000 730.000 1,540,000 40,000 1895 3.329.000 964,000 178,000 1,213,000 5,684,000 104,000 1896 1,453.000 539,000 108,000 348,000 2,448,000 27,000 1897 928,000 685,000 300,000 137.000 2,050,000 4,000 1898 773,000 829,000 34S.OOO 1,523,000 3,470,000 131,000 1899 4,905,000 515,000 357,000 ... 1,149,000 6,926,000 132,000 1900 1,052,000 926,000 330,000 163,000 2,145,000 49,000 Note. — The figures printed in thick type in the column "Silver Coin," represent an increase. 138 CH. xiv] EFFECTS OF AUTUMNAL DRAIN 139 There is thus an internal ebb of gold in autumn. A corresponding influx to the extent of from two to three millions takes place between the months of May and June. The effect of this autumnal pressure was described in 1857 by the late Mr. William Langton, to the Statistical Society of Manchester {Transactions, Session 1857-8), and the investi- gation was carried on, with his accustomed ingenuity and research, by Professor W. S. Jevons, 1866 (Statistical Society of London : Journal, vol. xxix.). The pressure is enhanced by the requirements of the Bank Acts of 1844-5, acting through the movements of the Scotch and Irish issues. See Tables 1 5, 16, 17, pp. 118-131. An amount of gold has to be brought from the Bank of England to Scotland and Ireland corresponding, on average, with the amount of notes in circulation. An examination of the figures contained in Table 20 will show how this works out. The amounts for 1881 and 1882 will serve as examples. 1 88 1. Gold taken for abroad Do. home circulation Do. Scotland Do. Ireland . 1882. Gold taken for abroad Do. home circulation Do. Scotland Do. Ireland . £\,^Tl,ooo 788,000 ;^2,s6o,ooo ;£8lI,O0O 430,000 ^1,241,000 ;f3,8oi,ooo .£417,000 880,000 ;£i,297,ooo ;£838,ooo 610,000 ;£i,448,ooo ;£2,745,ooo The amounts moved to Scotland and Ireland are taken out of the reserve of the Bank under the provisions of the Acts of 1844-5. In 1 88 1 more than a third of the total, in 1882 more than half the total of what was thus drawn was taken under this influence. On an average, for the years 1846- 1900, the rate of dis- count charged by the Bank of England was higher during the autumn months, and particularly in November, in connection with this movement. A somewhat similar movement is trace- able in the returns of the Banks of France, Germany, Holland and Belgium. (For further information see Palgrave, Dictionary of Political Economy, article on " Autumnal Drain " ; Jevons, Investigations in Currency and Finance, London, 1884; and R. H. Inglis Palgrave, Evidence before Select Committee of House of Commons, Banks of Issue, 1875.) CHAPTER XV VARIATIONS IN THE RATE CHARGED BY THE BANK OF FRANCE FROM 1844 TO 1900 Reasons for selecting 1844 as the starting- point of these investigations . . 140 Organisation of Bank of France . 141-143 Table 21. Monthly Averages of Mini- mum Rate of Discount of Bank of France from 1845-1900 . . . 142 Number of Branches . . . 143 Description of the Business of the Bank of France . . . 143-148 Table 22. Changes in the Rate of Dis- count charged by the Bank of France, and the number of days at each Rate in each year, 1844-1900. . 144-14S Table 23. Bank of France Rate of Dis- count, 1844-1900. The number of days at each Rate, arranged from the highest number to the smallest, and from the lowest rate to the highest . 146 [Amounts in Francs Management of the Business in times of difficulty . ... 148 Assistance given to England during the Baring Crisis . ... 148 Other Banks in France . . 148-149 Difference between Banking in England and in France. . . 148-149 Difference between number and extent of variations in the Rate in England and in France . . . 150-151 Comparisons from 1890-1900 . . 151 Comparison of Rates in years 1847, 1857, 1866, and 1890 . . . 152 Reserve in the Precious Metals at the Bank of France . . . 152 Table 24. Gold and Silver held by the Bank of France, 1877-1900 . . 153 converted as 25=;^i.] Chapter X. contained a statement, Table 13, pp. 98, 99, of the variations in the rate of discount charged by the Bank of England from 1844 to 1900, commencing with the date when the Act of 1844 came into force. That date was selected as the starting-point of this inquiry, because before that period it had scarcely been the custom of the Bank of England to make any variation at all in its rate. On some occasions, particularly in 1839, a higher rate was charged, but the regular Bank rate was 4 per cent. The market rate might be something very different, but the Bank did not concern itself with that. If the market rate was as high or higher than the Bank rate, the Bank was resorted to for discount purposes ; but if the market rate was lower, the Bank did not reduce its rate accordingly. Earlier than the date from which that table starts — September 5th, 1844 — the rate charged by the Bank of 140 CH. xv] ORGANISATION OF BANK OF FRANCE 141 England is no guide to the market rate, and hence it was of no service to pursue the investigation further back than that time. The same date was taken for the starting-point of the tables of the rate of the Bank of France, as has been done with the Banks of Germany and Holland, in order to facilitate comparison between the operations of the different banks. The Bank of Belgium did not commence operations till 1850. For a long time before 1844, in France as, generally speak- ing, in England, the rate of the bank had not varied from 4 per cent. It stood at that point at the Bank of France from 1820 to January, 1847. The tables of the rates charged by the Bank of France correspond in arrangement exactly with those relating to the Bank of England. The first table, No. 21, p. 142, gives the average rate of discount charged month by month by the Bank of France during the period from 1845 to 1900, in groups of ten years each from 1845-54 to 1885-94, and for the six years 1 895- 1 900. It also shows the proportion which the rate charged in each group of ten years bore to the average rate of the period. A summary table shows the average monthly rates for the whole period, 1845-1900. Table No. 22, pp. 144, 145, gives the number of changes of the rate in each year, and the total number of days at each rate in each year. A supple- mentary table, No. 23, p. 146, shows the number of days at each rate arranged from the greatest number of days which each rate lasted to the smallest, and the number of days at each rate arranged from the lowest rate to the highest. Before commencing this comparison, it will be desirable to give some description of the organisation of the Bank of France. The direction of the bank consists of the following persons : — First, there is a governor and two sub-governors ; all these three are nominated by the Government, and are understood to be removable at its pleasure, but this power, as a matter of fact, is not exercised. Then there are fifteen directors, who are elected by the proprietors. Three of these directors must be selected from the class of the receivers- general, who are connected with the Government, and the management of the taxes of the country. The receveurs- gdndravx, or trdsoriers payeurs-gdndraux, as they are more 142 VARIATIONS IN RATE, BANK OF FRANCE [ch. xv TABLE 21. Monthly Averages of Minimum Rate of Discount of Bank of France 1845-1900, in groups of Ten Years, 1845-54, 1855-64, 1865-74, 1875-84, 1885-94, and of Six Years, 1895-1900, with Summary Table, 1845-1900. 1845-54. 1866-64. 1865-74. 1875-84. Average for Av. of Ten Years =100. Average for Average of Ten Years= 100. Average for Average of Ten Years = 100. Average for Average of Ten Year5= 100. Month. the Ten Years, £3 igs. sd. the Ten Years, £^ i^s. lad. the Ten Years, £3 i8j. iirf. the Ten Years, £3 ai. irf. £ s. d. £ s. d. £ '. d. £ ^. d. fanuary 401 lOI S I 9 107 4 3 II 106 380 110 February . 420 103 4 18 8 104 406 102 3 7 7 log March 404 lOI 4 16 8 102 3 17 8 99 3 4 10 105 April 400 101 480 93 3 16 97 3 I 3 99 May 3 18 10 ,,8 4 II 7 gb 3 16 9 97 309 gH . une 3 18 972.ooo — Total incre tween Dec. 31, ? 1877, and Dec. ( ;^46,828,ooo ;^9,436,ooo 31, 190C ) 1877 . Amount in ;^46, 544,000 ;^34, 544.000 » » 1900 . 93.372,000 43,980,000 More in 1900 ;^ 46, 8 2 8, 000 ;^9,436,ooo During the years 1899-1900 the silver diminished more than ;£"4,ooo,ooo, while the gold increased more than ;^20,ooo,ooo during the same period. December 31, 1902, the gold held was ;^ioo,768,ooo, the silver ;^43.936,ooo, the total being ;^i44,704,ooo. CHAPTER XVI VARIATIONS IN THE RATE CHARGED BY THE IMPERIAL BANK OF GERMANY FROM 1844 TO 1900 Origin of the Bank of Germany . -155 Table 25. Monthly Averages of Minimum Rate of Discount of the Bank of Germany, 1845-1900 . . . 156 Table 26. Changes in the Rate of Dis- count charged by the Bank of Ger- many, and the number of days at each rate in each year, 1844-1900 . 157 The Bank of Germany, like the Bank of France, under the control of the State 158 Table 27. Bank of Germany, Rate of Discount, 1844-1900. The number of days at each rate arranged from the highest number to the smallest, and from the lowest rate to the highest 158 German Bank Acts of 1875 and 1899 158-159 Supervision and Direction of the Bank of Germany . ... 159 The supreme control over the Bank exercised by the Chancellor of the Empire . . . . 159 Number of Branches . . . 160 Number of alterations in the Rate of Discount compared with England and France . . . . 160 Disturbances caused by Gold Currency introduced into Germany in 1872 . 160 Banking more developed in Germany than in France . . .160 Other Banks in Germany . . . 160 Business carried on by the Bank of Ger- many compared with that carried on by the Bank of France and by the Bank of England . . .160 Comparison of Bills discounted in France and Germany . . . 160-161 Business of the Bank of Germany in Current Accounts (Giro Verkehr), and transmitting money from one part of the country to another . . . 161 Note Circulation . . . 162-166 Limit of the authorised Note Issue . 162-163 PAGB Tax on the Excess Issue Difference between this system and the system in England . . .163 Dangers of the English system observed by German Legislators . . . 163 Different place taken in business matters by the Note Circulation in Germany to that taken by the Note Circulation in England . . . 163-164 Development of the Note Circulation . 164 Further comparison of Note Issues in Germany and England . . . 166 Three Limitations on the Note Issue of the Bank of Germany, (l) the legal limit, (2) the tax of 5 per cent, on the excess issue, {3) the requirement that one- third of the issue should be held in cash 166 Discount of Bills by Bank of Germany . 166 Foreign Bills held . . . 167 Proportion of these on England . . 167 Inland and Foreign Bills held by Bank . 167 Fluidity of Securities held by Bank . 167 Specie held by the Bank . . . 168 Table 28. Coin and Bullion, 1876-1900 168 Table 29. Annual Averages of Note Circulation, 1876-1900 . . . 169 Occasions when the Note Issue exceeded the Legal Limit, the Dates of these, and the Duty on the Excess . 169-171 Rate at the Bank of Germany compared with the Banks of England, France, Holland, and Belgium . Taix on Excess Issues Proposal to adopt in England an arrange- ment similar to that in Germany as to exceeding authorised circulation . Bill brought forward by Lord Sherbrooke in 1873 . ... Injurious effect of High Rates of Interest on Trade . ... [The Reichsmark converted as 20=;f i.] 171 172 172 172 173 Chapters X. and XV., pp. 95, 140, contained an account of the variations in the rate of interest charged by the Bank of IS4 CH. xvi] HISTORY OF BANK OF GERMANY 155 England from 1844 to 1900, and by the Bank of France during the same period. It is desirable to continue this part of the investigation by a similar inquiry into the rates charged during the same time by the Bank of Germany. Strictly speaking, we ought to speak of the Bank of Prussia and the Bank of Germany. Originally founded by Frederick II., King of Prussia, in 1765, as a State institution, under the title of the Royal Bank, it continued till 31st December, 1846, when it was reconstituted with the admission of shareholders, and became a note-issuing bank. Organised in this manner, the Bank of Prussia continued its operations steadily till 31st December, 1875, when the German Bank Act of that year altered its constitution entirely, and greatly enlarged its sphere of work. From being the financial institution of a compara- tively restricted country, the Reichsbank became the centre of the monetary operations of a great empire at the time when the standard of value of that empire was changed from Silver to Gold. It is now one of the great banks of Europe, and therefore we have placed its present name, that of the Imperial Bank of Germany, at the head of this chapter. The same dates and the same method exactly have been followed in constructing the tables which accompany this chapter as with those which were drawn up in the description of the rates charged and the fluctuations in them in the case of the other banks whose operations are described, in order that the com- parison made may follow precisely the same plan in all cases, and enable the reader to see how far and to what extent the same causes have operated in all the countries referred to. The first table. No. 25, p. 156, gives the average rate of discount charged, month by month, by the Bank of Germany during the period from 1845 to 1900; it also shows the proportion which the rate charged in each month bore to the average rate of the year. A summary at the end of the table shows the average monthly rates for the whole period, 1845-1900. Table No. 26, p. 157, gives the number of changes of the rate in each year and the total number of days at each rate in each year. A supplementary table, No. 27, p. 158, shows the number of days at each rate, arranged from the lowest rate to the highest, and the number of days at each rate, 156 VARIATIONS IN RATE, BANK OF GERMANY [ch. xvi TABLE 25. Monthly Averages of Minimum Rate of Discount of Bank of Germany, 1845-1900, in groups of Ten Years, 1845-54, 1855-64, 1865-74, 1875-84, 1885-94, and of Six Years, 1895-igoo, with Summary Table, 1845-1900. 1846-64. 1856-64. 1865-74. 1876-84. Average for Av.of Ten Years =100. Average for Average of Ten Years = 100. Average for Average of Ten Years= 100. Average for Average of Ten Years = 100. Month. the Ten Years, ;£4 6s. 5rf. the Ten Years, £*V- the Ten Years, the Ten Years, £* SJ. id. £ s. d. I s. d. £ s. d. £ s. d January . 490 J-D? 4 10 4 lOI 4 IS 10 104 4 10 S 106 February . 480 102 466 97 4 7 9 9S 4 2 10 97 March 464 TOO 4 5 9 97 4 4 4 9' 3 19 4 94 April 460 100 4 5 96 460 93 3 18 g2 May 4 4 10 98 4 6 S 97 4 12 8 100 3 19 2 93 June 440 97 460 97 4 14 102 3 17 II 92 July 458 99 452 90 4 IS II 104 3 19 I 93 August 450 q8 4 4 7 95 4 10 8 98 426 97 September. 440 97 488 99 4 7 8 9S 4 II 9 108 October . 478 lOI 4 14 II 106 4 16 8 ros 4 16 7 114 November. 480 102 4 17 9 110 4 17 4 J06 4 13 6 no December . 480 102 4 17 5 log 4 18 7 J07 4 10 1 106 Difference : Highest and I owest Difference : H ghestand Difference : H ghestand Difference : Highest and Month, 5s. Lowest Month, I3J, 2c/. Lowest Month, i+t. id. Lowest Month, iBj. U. Mean of e> :treme Variatio ns for Mean of extr 5me Vari- Mean of extr 3me Vari- Mean of extreme Vari. 1845-54. 3% ations for 1855- 64, 7-5% ations for 1865- 74,8% ations for 1875-84, ti% 1886-94. 1895-1900. 1845-1900. Average for Average of Average for Average of Average for the Average of Month. the Ten Years, Ten Years the Six Years, Six Years Fifty-six Years, Fifty-six £i 13J. irf. =:iOO. £4 4^- »<^- = 100. £a, 5*- ^d. Years =100. £ s. d. £ s. d £ s. d. January . 4 I 2 77/ 4 IS I "3 4 10 706 February . 3 9 3 95 403 ^/ 427 97 March . 3 7 6 gs 3 15 8g 401 94 April 3 7 I g2 3 IS II go 3 19 11 94 May 3 I ^ 92 3 15 9 go 416 g6 June 380 93 3 IS S go 4 I 3 96 July . . 380 93 3 IS 8 go 420 97 August . 3 9 S 95 3 16 7 9' 4 I 10 96 September 3 13 2 100 416 97 448 100 October . 3 18 10 108 4 14 3 112 4 II 4 107 November 420 112 502 ijg 4 12 7 log December 4 4 9 116 S 5 I2S 4 13 2 no Difference: H ghest and Lowes t Month, Difference: H ighest and Difference : Highest and i7f. id. Lowest Month, £1 lor. Lowest Month, 131. yl. Mean of extre me Variations fo 1885-94, Mean of ext reme Vari- Mean of extreme Vari- "% ations for 1895-1 900, 18% ations for 1845-1900, 8% CH. xvi] DAYS AT EACH RATE, 1844-1900, GERMANY 157 IMPERIAL BANK OF GERMANY. RATE OF DISCOUNT. Table 26. Changes in the Rate of Discount Charged by the Bank of Germany, and the Number of Days at Each Rate in Each Year, from 5th September, 1844 (when the Bank Act came into Operation in England), to 31st December, 1900. No. of changes 3% 3i% 4% ii'l. 5 7. si 7. 6% 6i% 7% 7i% 8% 9% Total Years Years Rise Fall Total Days Days Days Days Days Days Days Days Days Days Days Days Days 1814 I — I 41 76 — — — — 117 1844 1845 I I 2 — — 204 78 83 — — — — — — — 365 1845 1846 I I 2 — — 121 — 244 — — — — — — — 36s 1846 1847 — I I — — — 122 243 — — — — — — — 36s 1847 1848 I I 2 — — — 256 no — — — — — — — 366 1848 1849 — I I — — 3'4 51 — — — — — — — — 365 1849 1850 No cha nge — — 36S — — — — — — — — 36s 1850 1851 No cha nge — — 36S — — — — — — — — — 365 1861 1852 No cha nge — — 366 — — — — — — — — — 366 1852 1853 I — I — — 273 — 92 — — — — — — — 365 1863 1854 — I I — — 234 — 131 — — — — — — — 36S 1854 1855 I I — 310 55 — — — — — — — 365 1855 1856 3 I 4 — — 121 7 138 — 100 — — — — — 366 1856 1857 4 2 6 — — — 162 32 82 45 — 44 — — 365 1857 1868 I 4 5 — — 330 — 19 II — 5 — — — — 365 1858 1859 I I 2 — — 293 — 72 — — — — — — 365 1859 1860 No cha nge — — 366 — — — — — — — — 366 1860 1861 No cha nge — — 36s — — — — — — — — — 365 1861 1862 No cha nge — — 365 — — — — — — — — — 365 1862 1863 I — I — — 307 58 — — — — — — — — 36s 1863 1864 3 I 4 — — 124 128 — 54 — 60 — — — 366 1864 1865 3 2 5 — — 198 — 64 — 21 — 82 — — — 36s 1865 1866 I 7 8 — — 18 45 87 — 79 — 68 — 5 63 365 1866 1867 No cha nge — — 36S — — — — 365 1867 1868 No cha nge — — 366 — — — — — — — — — 366 1868 1869 I — I — — 277 — 88 — — — — — — — 365 1869 1870 2 3 5 — — 150 — 163 — 20 — — — 32 — 365 1870 1871 — 2 2 — — 300 14 SI — — — — — — — 365 1871 1872 I I — 260 106 — — — — — — — 366 1872 1873 3 4 7 — 53 98 128 — 86 — — — — — 365 1873 1874 2 2 4 — — 257 14 56 — 38 — — — — — 365 1874 1875 2 3 J ^ 168 131 — 66 — — — — — 365 1875 1876 3 3 6 S4 210 67 19 — 16 — — — — — 366 1876 1877 3 4 7 — 214 33 78 40 — — — — — — 365 1877 1878 I 2 3 — — 220 41 104 — — — — — 365 1878 1879 2 3 S 145 — 149 71 — — — — — — — — 365 1879 1880 2 3 s — 283 22 29 32 — — — — — — 366 1880 1881 2 I 3 — — 233 — 80 52 — — — — — — 36s 1881 1882 2 2 4 — — 182 7 159 — 17 — — — — — 36s 1882 1883 I I — — 348 17 — — — — — — — 365 1883 1884 No cha nge — — 366 — — — — — — — — 366 1884 1885 I 2 3 303 37 25 — — — — — — — 365 1885 1886 3 2 5 240 71 41 13 — — — — — — — 365 1886 1887 2 2 234 113 — 18 — — — — — — — 365 1887 1888 2 2 261 — 80 25 — — — — — — — — 366 1888 1889 2 2 4 212 52 12 89 — — — — — — — 365 1889 1890 2 I 3 2I6 — 68 81 — — — — — — 36S 1890 1891 I 3 4 91 10 252 — — 12 — — — — — — 365 1891 1892 I I 2 291 75 — — — — — — — — 366 1892 1893 2 1 3 "S 108 — 142 — — — — — — 36s 1893 1894 — 2 2 329 — 27 — 9 — — — — — — 365 1894 1895 I I 31S 5° — — — — — — — — — 36s 1895 1P96 2 I 3 208 — 76 — 82 — — — — — — — 366 1896 1897 2 3 149 43 73 — 100 — — — — — — — ^P 1897 1898 4 2 6 s° 213 — 50 10 42 — — — — — ^P 1898 1899 4 3 7 — 41 126 92 — 94 — 12 — — — 36s 1899 1900 3 3 — — _ 178 160 430 15 730 50 12 234 — — — 36s 1900 76 8S 161 2,640 178 11,077 1,439 3.648 44 37 1 63 20,570 iS8 VARIATIONS IN RATE, BANK OF GERMANY [ch. xvi arranged from the greatest number of days which each rate lasted to the smallest. The Imperial Bank of Germany is, like the Bank of France, under the control of the State. The Bank Act of 1875 directs the manner in which this control is exercised (see pars. 25-31, pp. 158, 159). The business is also regulated in some points by the Bank Act of 1899. TABLE 27. Imperial Bank of Germany— Rate of Discount— 1844-1900. The Number of Days at each Rate, arranged from the highest number to the smallest. Number of Days (20 570). Rate Per Cent. Number of Days = 1,000. 11,077 . . . 4 . . . 540 3.648 . S 177 2,640 3 129 1.439 4i 70 730 6 35 430 5h 21 334 7 11 178 3h 9 63 9 3 5° 6| 2 44 7i 2 37 • 8 1 20,570 1,000 Imperial Bank of Germany— Rate of Discount— 1844-1900. The Number of Days at each Rate, arranged from the lowest rate to the highest. Rate Per Cent. Number of Days (20,570). Number of Days= 1,000. 3 . . . 2,640 ... 129 3* 178 9 4 11,077 540 4i 1.439 70 5 3.648 177 5h 430 21 6 730 35 6i SO 2 7 234 11 7i 44 2 8 37 1 9 63 3 20,570 1,000 Section 25. The Imperial supervision over the Reichsbank is exercised by a Bank-Curatorium,* comprising the Chancellor of the Empire, as President, and four other members. One of these four members is named by the Emperor, the other three by the Federal Council. This Curatorium meets * A Board of Inspectors. CH. xvi] GERMAN BANK ACT OF 1875 159 once a quarter. At these meetings a report is given of the condition of the bank and everything connected; it also receives a general account of all the operations and business arrangements of the bank. Section 26. The Imperial direction of the bank is exercised by the Chancellor of the Empire and, under him, by the Board of Directors of the Imperial Bank. Should the Chancellor be hindered from exercising his functions, the Emperor will name a substitute. The Chancellor directs the entire administration of the bank, subject to the provisions of this Act and the regulations which may be published in accord- ance with Section 40.* He issues the directions for the Imperial Board of Directors and for the branch institutions, as well as the rules and instructions for the officials of the bank, and directs the required alterations in the existing business arrangements and in the instructions to the officials. Section 27. The Imperial Board of Directors is the administrative and executive authority of the bank, and also represents it in public. It consists of a president and the required number of members, and passes its resolutions by a majority of votes ; but its proceedings are subject to the prescriptions and instructions of the Chancellor of the Empire. The President and members of the Board of Directors of the Imperial Bank are appointed for life by the Emperor on the recommendation of the Federal Council. Section 28. The officials of the Imperial Bank have the rights and duties of Imperial functionaries. The bank undertakes their salaries, pensions, and other payments for services, as well as the pensions and assistance given to their surviving relatives. The salaries and pensions of the Bank Directors are fixed yearly by the Imperial Budget ; those of the other officials by the Emperor, yearly, in agreement with the Federal Council on the motion of the Imperial Chancellor. No official of the bank may hold its shares. Section 29. The accounts of the Imperial Bank must be submitted to the Court of Accounts of the German Empire. The Chancellor will determine the form of the yearly accounts. The decisions on this point are to be communi- cated to the Court of Accounts. Section 30. The shareholders take part in the administration of the bank through the General Meetings, and a Central Committee elected from their numbers according to the following regulations : — Section 31. The Central Committee is the permanent representative of the shareholders in relation to the administration. It consists of fifteen members, besides whom fifteen substitutes are to be chosen. The members and the substitutes are chosen by the General Assembly out of the number of those among the shareholders who have at least three shares in their names. All the members and substitutes must reside within the Empire, and at least nine members and nine substitutes in Berlin. One-third of the members retires annually, but are eligible for re-election. The Central Committee meets at least once a month, presided over by the President of the Board of Directors of the Bank, who may also summon extraordinary meetings. The quorum at these meetings will be at least seven members. The arrangements of the business will determine when and in what turn the substitutes of members are called up. * This section directs the details of the bank management. i6o VARIATIONS IN RATE, BANK OF GERMANY [ch. xvi The Imperial Bank carries on a very considerable business in Berlin, and has also branches which form a network covering the whole of Germany. Including Berlin, there were in 1902 376 offices of the Reichsbank. In this latter respect the business which the Bank of Germany carries on corresponds more closely with that of the Bank of France than with that of the Bank of England. The number of variations in the rate of discount at the Bank of France and at the Bank of Germany also corresponds more closely in number than those at the Bank of England between 1844 and the close of the year 1900. There were 11 1 alterations in the rate recorded at the Bank of France and 161 at the Bank of Germany during those years ; while the Bank of England altered its rate 400 times during the same time. The year 1872 marks the date of the introduction of the gold standard into Germany. It could hardly have been expected that so colossal an operation, perhaps the largest of its kind which modern times have ever witnessed, could have been carried into effect without great disturbances of the money market in the countries employing a gold currency. This doubtless accounts for much of the unsteadiness of our money market during the years 1872-5, and for many of the alterations in the rate of discount charged at Berlin during the same period. The business of banking is, on the whole, more developed in Germany than in France. There are considerable banks in Hamburg, Frankfort, Bremen, and in other cities of North Germany, besides many carrying on business in Berlin. Hence the Bank of Germany has to meet more competition than the Bank of France. The business carried on by the Bank of Germany corres- ponds, as mentioned before, more closely with that carried on by the Bank of France than with that of the Bank of England. As in France, the charges for advances and discounts made at the head office correspond with those made at all the branches. Both the Banks of France and Germany have many branches, many more than the Bank of England ; both of them do a large business in remitting sums of money from one part of the country to another, and the bills which both of them deal CH. xvi] CURRENT ACCOUNTS AT BANK OF GERMANY i6i with in the way of their business are comparatively small in amount. The average amount of the inland bills dealt in by the Bank of Germany in 1900 was ;^85 4^. for each bill. The average amount of the trade bills discounted at Paris by the Bank of France in 1900 was jC^g ss. ^d. The average amount of the bills dealt in by the Bank of England is believed to be much larger than either of these sums. The business of the Imperial Bank of Germany on current accounts (Giro Verkehr) has considerably increased, during recent years. This is the branch of the business in wnich the greatest development has occurred, it having increased tenfold between 1876 and 1900. In its present form the system only dates from 1876 ; the enormous extension it has received shows how greatly such a method of making payments was required in a country with large business transactions, and in which cheques are but little used, notes and specie being generally employed. It was established as a means for facilitating pay- ments between persons in different parts of the empire, and for economising the use of specie in these transactions. In this it has been especially successful. The sums paid in specie have dropped from being 39*5 per cent, of the whole in 1876 to 1 6*8 per cent, in 1900. It is true that the actual amounts paid in specie have largely increased ; they were ;^3 30,000,000 in the course of 1876, and ;^ 1,3 7 2, 000,000 in 1900; but while there is a substantial increase in most years during the whole period, the payments in specie have not increased by any means so much as the total sums, which have increased from ;^836,ooo,ooo in 1876 to ;^8, 182,000,000 in 1900. Hence while the totals have increased nearly tenfold, the payments in specie have increased only fourfold. The current accounts connected with this branch of the business have likewise greatly increased in number; from being only 3,245 in 1876, they have increased to 15,847 in 1900. The average amount to the credit of these accounts has also largely developed ; from being ;^3,529,ooo in 1876, it had increased to ;^25,6io,ooo in 1900. It is impossible in this place to go more into detail on this point. The advantage resulting to business has been extra- ordinary from the convenience thus given in remitting money M i62 VARIATIONS IN RATE, BANK OF GERMANY [cH, xvi through book entry from one part of the empire to another. For example, if A B in Leipzic wishes to make a payment to C D in Berlin, he can pay the amount into the office of the Reichsbank at Leipzic, and on the following day the amount is credited to C D on his current account in Berlin. The person making the payment need not have an account at the bank. The transfers are made without charge. The next point to be considered is the note circulation. It is needful to premise before commenting on this that the note circulation is a far more important factor in business transactions in Germany than it is with us. Here cheques, not notes, are the recognised medium for business payments. If a sudden increase occurs in the amount of cheques paid away no one takes any notice of it, or is even conscious of the circumstance. All that happens is that the clearing-house returns are augmented, and that the banks on which the cheques are drawn make provision for meeting them. This is merely a private matter between the banks and their customers. No one else is concerned. It is quite a different thing when notes are in general use, especially when, as in Germany, the issuing bank is compelled, before placing its notes in circulation, to make provision according to the law as to the reserves held against them, and is compelled also to observe whether or not the amount issued exceeds the limit allowed by the law. This was originally fixed in Germany by the Bank Act of 1875. By that law also the issue of small notes was discontinued. From and after the year 1876 no notes were allowed to be issued below the value of 100 marks (;^5), and the bank was compelled to observe regulations as to the conduct of the business which were designed to cause it to keep its assets in as fluid a condition as possible, thus enabling it to be always ready to meet any demands which might be made on it, including those which might arise from the note circulation. The limit of uncovered issue — that is, of notes beyond the amount against which specie and legal tender money was re- quired to be held in certain proportions — was fixed by the Bank Law in 1875 ^^ ;^i 2, 500,000 for the Reichsbank, increased by the lapse of the issues of other banks to ;^i4,8i 1,450 in 1896, CH. xvi] AUTHORISED AND EXCESS NOTE ISSUE, GERMANY 163 and by the Act of 1899 to ;^2 2, 500,000, As the last-named extension of the limit, however, did not come into force till a later period than that we are now considering, no further reference need be made to it here. The principle is the same, whatever the actual amount may be. Beyond the fixed limit the bank was allowed to put notes into circulation on payment of a tax of 5 per cent, on the excess issue, with the proviso that specie to the extent of one-third of the total issue should always be kept in the vaults of the bank, and that against the remainder good bills should be held. Though a charge of 5 per cent, was not high, it was sufficient to keep the bank from desiring to exceed the authorised issue, and for this reason : if the charge for the advance on which the excess issue was based did not exceed 5 per cent., the bank made practically no profit from the transaction. If, however, a rate sufficiently high to enable the bank to make a profit was to be charged, it would be so high as to discourage the would-be borrower from seeking to obtain the accommodation. It has hence been only on public grounds, from a desire to facilitate business generally, that the Reichs- bank allowed the legal limit of its note circulation to be exceeded. This system of allowing an issue of notes beyond the limit fixed by the laws on payment of a moderate tax on the notes put into circulation, was established in contradistinction to the English system, which, through the arrangements of the Act of 1844, fixed an impassable boundary for the circulation of the Bank of England, and eventually annihilated the elasticity of the English note circulation. The German legislators observed that the absolute restriction of the amount of the uncovered note issue of the Bank of England on several occasions had the effect of intensifying crises. The fear that the Bank might reach the limit of its note circulation, and in consequence might be compelled to suspend the supply of its notes, which through their legal-tender character stand on the same level as the standard of value, had in critical times caused a panic-stricken multitude to throng to the counters of the Bank of England, seeking, while it was yet time, to provide themselves, through discounting bills, borrowing on stock and similar methods, with a sufficiency of the legal -tender circulating medium. In order i64 VARIATIONS IN RATE, BANK OF GERMANY [ch. xvi that the panic might be appeased it has been necessary in England, as we all know, to grant permission that the Act of 1844, which governs the limit of the uncovered note issue, should, if necessary, be suspended, although it was only on one occasion, in 1857,* that the law was actually infringed. Permission to do this was given in 1847, 1857, and i866.t These experiences, and the dread of the injury hence resulting to trade, caused the authors of the German Bank Law to seek out a different way by which they might meet the emergency whenever it arose in an automatic manner, without needing to have recourse to parliamentary authority. They did not make the permitted amount of note circulation a fixed and rigid thing, but they allowed the Reichsbank to exceed the fixed limit of its note circulation when the circumstances of trade required it. This power was, however, regulated by the imposition of the tax of 5 per cent., as mentioned above, on the excess of notes beyond the limit. The Reichsbank was thus compelled to connect the fact that it had overpassed the legal limit with raising the rate of discount at least to 5 per cent. In considering this arrangement it must again be remem- bered how absolutely different is the place which the note circulation takes in business matters in Germany from that which it holds in England, where in times of difficulty the position of the Bank of England note as a legal tender, and thus as representing gold, causes it to be sought for. In Germany notes are employed generally where cheques are used with us for ordinary business transactions — for the common require- ments of the day. If they cannot be supplied all business comes to a standstill, hence as business developes the note circulation increases, and tends to pass beyond limits which were adequate twenty-five years ago. The development of the note circulation is shown in Table 29, p. 169. The extent by which the legal limit was over- passed between 1881 — the first year in which an excess issue occurred — and 1900, is given in the statements on pp. 169-171. * See statement, note, p. 89. t This subject is also mentioned in Chapter IX., p. 88. The Act of Indemnity required in 1857 is printed at p. 91, and the bill proposed in 1873 by Lord Sher- brooke to meet similar difficulties is printed at p. 93. CH. xvi] EXCESS ISSUE FREQUENT OCCURRENCE, GERMANY 165 The German Bank Law requires, in any case, that cash should be held up to one-third of the note circulation. The average cover was in practice considerably more than this, having been in Per cent. 1876 . ... 74-55 1880 . ... 76'47 1885 . . . 80-57 1890 . ... 81-41 1895 . . . . 92-35 1900 ... 71-77 Thus the requirements of the Bank Law were in this respect amply fulfilled. The limit of the uncovered note circulation, owing to the vast development of the business of the empire, gradually became too narrow, as is shown by Table 29, p. 169, which gives the history of the growth of the note circulation. That this was not the cause of great disturbance to the busi- ness world arose from the fact that the Directory of the Reichsbank met the requirements of the time, which drove the circulation above the legal limit, by raising the rate of discount to 5 per cent, only, and further, out of consideration to the general interests of trade, paid the tax on the excess out of its own resources. Thus the Reichsbank, while undertaking the whole responsibility for the excess issue, and the risks of the extended business which compelled it to be made, received little or no profit from the transaction, while it had to bear all the expenses incurred, including the risk of bad debts. It was not, as will easily be understood, able indefinitely to continue this consideration for the common good. It has been stated recently that the customers of the Reichsbank have latterly had to pay the 5 per cent, duty on the over-issues, and the amount, duration, and extent of the excesses over the limit increased so greatly after the year 1895, that in the course of the year 1898 there were sixteen, and in the years 1899 and 1900 twenty occasions on which the note circulation exceeded the limit. Between 1896 and 1900 the Reichsbank had to pay the note- tax every quarter. In the year 1899 the excess continued during the whole of the fourth quarter of the year, and in 1900 during the same period, except for one return. In order to make the working of the note circulation of i66 VARIATIONS IN RATE, BANK OF GERMANY [ch. xvi the Reichsbank clear, it is advisable to point out the essential difference between the manner in which our own fiduciary Bank of England allowance, now ;i^ 18,17 5,000, and the German allowance, originally of ;^i 2,500,000 and now of ;^2 2, 500,000, are treated.* The Bank of England "issues" the ;^i8,i75,ooo permanently, whether the amount of bullion held is large or small, whether the public requires the notes or not. The Bank of Germany only issues the notes when they are wanted, and not permanently, exactly as it treats the excess issue. The Bank of England issues the notes which are not wanted by the public to itself — they form the "reserve" of the Bank. When the "reserve" is exhausted, no more notes can be obtained except by bringing in more bullion, which can be put behind a further issue of notes, — and for this there is not time during a crisis, — or by suspending the law which regulates the note circulation. Our system thus creates an amount of legal- tender money in reserve which is absolutely limited in amount. The German system has an equally available amount of issue in reserve, far less strictly limited, the amount of which is not shown in the published accounts. Beyond this there is the power of issue practically of any amount over the legal limit, provided that one-third of the amount of the notes in circulation is held by the bank in cash, and that the tax of 5 per cent, is paid on the excess issue. There are thus three limitations on the note issue of the Reichsbank. The first is the legal limit, now ;^2 2, 500,000, the second the tax of 5 per cent, on any excess over this limit, the third the necessity of holding one-third of the whole circulation in cash. The largest branches of the liabilities of the Imperial Bank have now been explained. The most important business on the credit side of the accounts of a note-issuing bank, and of the Imperial Bank in particular, is the discount of bills. Through its dealings with these securities, the bank not only finds the means for employment of the capital at its disposal, but also for meeting demands which may be made on it. On average nearly 80 per cent, of its profit is derived from this source, while, through the rapidity with which the bills held fall due, the bank can at any time supply itself with cash by * Die Reichsbank, Berlin, 1876-1900 (p. 8 ff.). CH. xvi] BILLS DISCOUNTED, LARGE AMOUNT, GERMANY 167 simply declining to discount and allowing the bills it holds to mature. The bills form the largest part of the provision made for meeting the demands which may be made on account of the notes. The bank is bound by law to hold in its coffers, in legal-tender notes of the empire, in gold bars or foreign coins valued at £(i(^ 1 2s. for a pound (German) of fine gold, at least one -third of the amount of the notes in circulation. The remainder of the amount of the notes must be represented by discounted bills. The bank deals both with inland and with foreign bills ; of these, on average, 99 per cent, are inland bills, only about I per cent, usually being foreign bills. For the year 1900, however, the proportion of the foreign bills dealt with was larger, being rather more than 3 per cent. The actual figures of the bills held December 31, 1900, were as follows : — From Balance Sheet, Bank of Germany, December 31, 1900. Bills due within fifteen days . ;^i 8,75 5,070 Bills due at later dates . . 3i)93i,i94 Bills on foreign places — England .... 3,734,120 Other foreign places . . 39jIS9 -;^So,686,264 3,773,279 Total . . ; £54,459,543 The great rapidity with which the securities held by the bank can be turned into cash is obvious from this statement. It will be seen that one-third of the whole amount of the bills held became due within fifteen days. A very large proportion of the bills fall due within even a shorter time than this, the proportion being — Within 7 days . . . 19-6 per cent. Over 7, but within 14 days . .11-2 „ Over 14 days, but within 4 weeks . 16-7 „ Over 2 months . . • S^'S » Average number of days the bills collectively have to run, 33. Thus it will be seen that one-fifth of the total amount of bills falls due within seven days, and about half, including these, within four weeks. It is difficult to imagine a bill -case of a bank i68 VARIATIONS IN RATE, BANK OF GERMANY [cH. xvi in better condition in this respect. The large amount of bills held on England shows the importance which the Reichsbank ascribes to possessing the means of checking any movement of the exchange in favour of England, and which may draw gold from Germany. As a rule, not less than 80 per cent, of the foreign bills held by the bank are bills drawn on England. Contemporaneously with the growth in Giro Verkehr busi- ness and in the note circulation, the amount of specie held has largely increased. The following table shows the yearly average of the coin and bullion, commencing with the establish- ment of the Reichsbank. From 1894 onwards the manner in which the accounts have been made up enables us to separate the holdings in gold from the remainder of the specie. TABLE 28. Coin and Bullion, 1876-1900. Gold held German Current Coin Yearly average % Proportion Date. 31st December of also held 31st December of published Weekly of average each Year. of each Year. Returns. each year to 1876. I £ £ 1876=100 1876 2,144,170 *22,885,8i6 25,529,644 100 1877 3,597,363 19,015,688 26,155,178 102 1878 2,004,126 21,601,193 24,703,583 97 1879 2,976,609 23,993,692 29,711,844 116 1880 3,386,225 22,736,639 28,104,538 110 1881 3,556,659 22,170,518 27,837,475 109 1883 7,393,024 20,548,404 27,449,237 107 1883 5,764,282 22,164,870 30,093,258 118 1884 3,590,75 s 22,300,570 29,586,246 116 1885 9,685,330 21,226,709 29,306,530 115 1886 14,377,533 19,097,954 34,655,264 135 1887 17,111,381 21,230,57s 38,618,130 151 1888 21,815,444 21,108,600 45,170,134 177 1889 12,233,435 24,496,533 43,579,583 171 1890 11,826,844 26,107,945 40,050,956 157 189I 17,691,253 27,403,189 44,689,455 175 1892 16,231,622 25,666,842 47,103,709 185 1893 16,911,652 *22,975,239 42,294,395 165 1894 35,721,800 +14,989,200 46,716,380 183 1895 28,547,150 14,106,700 50,588,150 198 1896 26,569,350 13,659,450 44,599,400 175 1897 28,403,700 12,924,100 43,572,500 171 1898 25,233,650 12,387,300 42,546,900 167 1899 23,451,350 11,593,950 41,274,000 161 1900 25,031,300 11,460,650 40,856,850 160 A further description of the details of the operations of the Bank of Germany is not required in this place. A sufficient * From 1876 to 1893 inclusive the gold coin held among "German Current Coin" is not stated separately. t From 1894 to 1900 the amounts are separated. CH, xvi] NOTE CIRCULATION, ANNUAL AVERAGES, GERMANY 169 outline has been given for the purpose proposed — the compari- son of the rate of discount ruling in Germany with that in the other countries referred to. The following table shows what the development of the note circulation has been : — TABLE 29. Imperial Bank of Germany. Annual Averages of Note Circulation, 1876-1900. Proportion of each Year Da.te. Note Circulation to 1876. Yearly Average. 1876 = 100. £ 1876 34.243.314 100 1877 34.746,450 101 1878 31,132,084 91 1879 33.383.746 97 1880 36.750.642 107 1881 36,986,370 108 1882 37.348,901 109 1883 36,862,286 108 1884 36,645,303 107 188s 36.372.132 106 1886 40,108,900 117 1887 43,030,813 126 1888 46,652,116 136 1889 49.365.708 144 1890 49,194,085 144 1891 48,583,303 142 1892 49,236,812 144 1893 49,241,462 144 1894 50,019,195 146 189s 54.779.650 160 1896 54,174.850 158 1897 54,285,200 158 1898 56,229,700 164 1899 57,087,600 167 1900 56,928,050 166 There have been from the year 1881 onwards many occa- sions on which the note issue has exceeded the legal limit. The particulars are as follows : — 1881. The Duty on the Excess was ;£i,359, the Amount: — Dec. 31 . ... ;^i, 304,608 1882. The Duty on the Excess was ;^i,637, the Average ^^785,234, THE Amounts: — Sept. 30 . . . ;:^96i.2o5 I Oct. 7 . . . ;^6o9,262 170 VARIATIONS IN RATE, BANK OF GERMANY [ch. xvi 1884. The Duty on the Excess was jQi,']02, the Amount: — Dec, 31 • ... ;£i,633,935 1885. The Duty on the Excess was jQizit the Amount: — Jan. 7 . ... ;£i30,766 1886. The Duty on the Excess was ;^i,779, the Amount: — Dec. 31 . ... ;^i, 708,067 1889. The Duty on the Excess was ;£i 1,799, the Average, ;^3,775,462, the Amounts: — Sept. 30 Oct. 7 ;^3,59i,2io 2,261,297 Dec. 31 ;^5,473,88o 1890. The Duty on the Excess was ;^i6,392, the Average ;£2, 709,022, THE Amounts : — Jan. 7 . £2,Si%9^S I Oct. 7 . ;^s,2 10,240 Sept. 30 . 4,572,542 I Oct. IS . 1,692,468 Oct. 31. Dec. 31 ;^946,S46 1,312,369 1893. The Duty on the Excess was ;^2,ooo, the Amount: — Sept. 30 . ... ;^i,925,885 1895. The Duty on the Excess was ;^i 1,203, the Average, ;£3,S83,667, the Amounts : — Sept. 30 . ^^2,304,315 I Oct. 7 . ;^i,035,495 | Dec. 31 . ;^7,4i4,i90 1896. The Duty on the Excess was _;^23,24o, the Average, ;^3,7i8,4io, the Amounts : — Jan. 7 . jg'1,790,576 March 31 . 2,200,411 June 30 . ;^i, 716,434 Sept. 30 . 5.977>928 Oct. 7 . Dec. 31 ^^3.917.639 6,707.431 1897. The Duty on the Excess was ^^38,396, the Average ;^4,o95,ssi, the Amounts : — Jan. 7 . ;^i,564>SS6 March 31 . 609,477 June 30 . 1,409,857 i8g8. The Duty on the Excess was ;£96,37o, the Average, ;£s,782,203, THE Amounts: — ^ Sept. 30 . ;^IO,29I,477 Oct. 31 ;fi,95i.20i Oct. 7 8,551.83s Nov. 7 . 354,184 Oct. 15 3.513,282 Dec. 31 8,614,091 Jan. 7 ;^3,028,242 Oct. 7 ;^I2,092,073 Nov. 15 ;£3,722,99S March 31 3,523.912 Oct. 15 8,351.869 Nov. 23 3°3.i38 April 7 . 1,044.953 Oct. 23 5,068,560 Nov. 30 1,832,743 June 30 6,476,171 Oct. 31 7,764,228 Dec. 23 1,529,121 July 7 . 3,286,168 Nov. 7 6,518,472 Dec. 31 14,147,764 Sept. 30 13,824,846 CH. xvi] DUTY ON EXCESS ISSUE, GERMANY 171 1899. The Duty on the Excess was £142,^6$, the Average, ;£6,833,soo, THE Amounts : Jan. 7 Jan. IS March 31 April 7 . June 30 July 7 . Sept. 23 ;^7,354,8i2 i,7°4,iS7 5,495,286 2,631,028 6,935.228 4,762,663 26,489 Sept. 30 Oct. 7 Oct. 15 Oct. 23 Oct. 31 Nov. 7 Nov. 15 ;^i8,56i,653 14,180,528 10,212,781 6,255.572 9,384.173 7,313.353 5,059,260 Nov. 23 Nov. 30 Dec. 7 , Dec. 15 Dec. 23 Dec. 30 ;^2,6i9,674 4,460,641 3.509.598 2,518,603 6,803,817 16,880,799 The Duty on the Excess was ;£i25,893, the Average ;^6,o42,847, THE Amounts: — ;^io,45i,8o8 July 7 . ;^2,o52,405 Nov. 15 . ;^2,746,i2S 2,385,019 Sept. 30 . 14,626,562 Nov. 30 . 1,153,649 11,912,966 Oct. 7 . 12,439,982 Dec. 7 . . 110,585 6,720,991 Oct. 15 . 6,586,951 Dec. 15 . 476,682 2,110,761 Oct. 23 . 3.348,976 Dec. 23 . 3,605,412 1,659,229 Oct. 31 . 6,933,702 Dec. 31 . 17,795,871 7,932,165 Nov. 7 . 5,807,101 1900. Jan. 7 Jan. 15 March 31 April 7 April 15 April 30 June 30 The total amount of duty paid to the Government during the twenty-five years (1876-1900) has been ^£'474,272. The tables marked 25 and 26, pp. 156 and 157, describe the variations in the rate of discount charged by the Bank of Germany, and the number of days at each rate. In one respect the figures contained in Table 26 differ from those of any of the other banks in the fact that at no time has a lower rate than 3 per cent, been charged. With the Banks of England, France, and Holland, rates from 2 to 2^ per cent, have occurred, and with the Bank of Belgium 2^ has not been infrequent. So low a rate as 3 per cent, was not charged by the Bank of Germany before 1879, and it did not become frequent till 1886, and the years between that date and 1898. The 2,640 days during which collectively it was charged by the Bank of Germany compare with — 11,341 at 3 per cent, and under by the Bank of England. 10,163 „ „ France. 12,508 „ „ Holland. 10,623 .. .. Belgium. 4 per cent, has been the most usual rate charged by the Bank of Germany, that rate having been fixed for 1 1,077 days by it. The more extreme rates have been charged for comparatively short periods. Those above 5 per cent, lasted at the Bank of Germany for 1,588 days, as compared with 2,299 at the Bank 172 VARIATIONS IN RATE, BANK OF GERMANY [ch. xvi of England. And at the Bank of England 141 of these days were at 10 per cent., a rate charged by no other bank during the period with which we are concerned. The study of Table 27, p. 158, which gives the number of days at each rate, shows very clearly the measures which the Bank of Germany had to take in order to retain and augment the gold in its possession.* Tax on Excess Issues. One of the propositions which has been made with the view of mitigating the fluctuations in the rate of interest charged by the Bank of England has been the adoption of an arrange- ment similar to that at present in use in Germany, through which the Reichsbank is allowed to exceed the authorised limit of its circulation, provided a definite proportion of specie to the actual issue is maintained, on payment of a tax of 5 per cent, (see p. 163). But it must be remembered that this expedient, although it allows a greater measure of freedom to the Reichsbank, does not add a single 20-mark piece to its store of specie. Hence this measure, although well adapted to the business requirements of Germany, does not appear equally suited to our own case. A somewhat similar plan for the modifi- cation of the Act of 1844 was brought forward by Lord Sher- brooke (Mr. Robert Lowe) in 1873, but the bill he introduced did not obtain sufficient support to secure acceptance from the House of Commons. t It was indeed hardly likely to do so, as it required the minimum rates for discounts and temporary advances to be not less than 12 per cent., and the foreign exchanges to be favourable to this country before "a special and temporary issue of Bank of England notes " on Government securities could be permitted. It may be mentioned in this place that the Bank of England paid to the Treasury out of the profits of the note issue for the year ended 31st March, 1902 — the latest statement to hand — ;i<^i94,88o 35. The Treasury thus shares in the profits of the issue. It is more likely to reap an advantage from this source when the rate charged for the privilege of " a special and temporary issue " is low, than when, as in the proposal made by Lord Sherbrooke, the rate is * For further information respecting the Bank of Germany see Bankers' Magazines (August, 1902, and before). + This bill is printed on pp. 93, 94. CH. xvi] HIGH RATES INJURIOUS TO TRADE 173 exaggeratedly high — so high, indeed, as to produce of itself a serious panic. Those who are not conversant with the ways of many forms of business in this country, not large indi- vidually, but of great importance collectively, have no idea of the injurious effect which high rates of interest produce on the prosperity of these industries, and how rapidly heavy charges exhaust all possible profits. This is especially the case when those engaged in them are people with capitals comparatively small in proportion to the industries which they carry on. CHAPTER XVII VARIATIONS IN THE RATE CHARGED BY THE BANK OF HOLLAND FROM 1844 TO 1900 PAGE History of Bank of Holland . 174-175 President and Secretary appointed by the Crown . ... 174 System of Management . . .175 Branch (Rotterdam), Agencies, and Cor- respondents . . . . 175 Business of the Bank of Holland . 175-176 Law of 7th August, 1888, allows the Bank to buy Bills payable abroad Capital and Reserve Bill passed (1884) to Protect Stock of Gold . ... Holland regards it a duty of the Govern- ment to endeavour to prevent the Standard of Value which it imposes on its subjects from fluctuating . The Bank of Holland principally a Bank of Discount . 175 176 176 177 177 Rate of Discount at Bank of Holland lower than at any other of the great banks of Europe Variations in the Rate of Discount com- pared with those at other European Banks . ... Table 30. Monthly Averages of Mini- mum Rate of Discount of Bank of Holland from 1845-1900 Table 31. Changes in the Rate of Dis- count charged by the Bank of Holland and the number of days at each Rate in each year, 1844-1900. Table 32. Bank of Holland, Rate of Discount, 1844-1900. The number of days at each Rate, arranged from the highest number to the smallest, and arranged from the lowest rate to the highest . ... 177 177 178 179 180 [The Florin converted as I2=;if i.] The remarks on the variations of the rate of discount charged by the Bank of Holland will be best understood when preceded by a few remarks on its history, which will assist us to under- stand its position and the class of business it transacts. During the second half of the last century many changes were made in the management of the Bank of Holland, the financial institution which has long exercised the leading influence over the monetary matters of that country. The existing bank was founded in 18 14. Various plans, including the establishment of a Banking Office for the introduction of an issue of bank bills, date as far back as 1795, but twenty years elapsed before satisfactory arrangements could be made. At the present time the President and the Secretary are both appointed by the Crown. These officers are paid by the bank, 174 CH. xvii] SYSTEM OF MANAGEMENT, BANK OF HOLLAND 175 which owes much of its prosperity to the skill and ability exer- cised by Mr. C. W. Mees, President from about 1850 onwards, by his successor, Dr. N. G. Pierson, afterwards Finance Minister of Holland, and by Mr. N. P. Van Den Berg, formerly President of the Bank of Java, who took up and now carries on the work of Dr. Pierson. Besides the President and the Secretary there are four Directors, who are appointed by the general meeting of the shareholders with the agreement of the Commissioners. The Commissioners, who also share in the management, are appointed by a committee of fifty of the largest of the shareholders. It is their duty to examine the annual balance sheet, which they also sign, and their sanction is necessary for the amount of the dividends. They occupy in many respects much the same position as the "Censors" of the Banks of France and of Belgium. The president and directors are obliged to have their domicile in Amsterdam. Only Dutch citizens in the possession of full civic rights and holding not less than fifteen shares can be directors. The head office is in Amsterdam ; the branch at Rotterdam corresponds closely to the branch of the Bank of Belgium at Antwerp in its relative importance to the bank. Nearly 10 per cent, of the total operations of the bank were transacted in Rotterdam in 1 900- 1, about 55 per cent, was done in the other agencies, and 35 per cent, in the head office. There are seventeen agencies at towns varying in importance from the Hague and Arnheim to much smaller places like Deventer and Meppel, one sub-agency, and seventy-two correspondents. The corres- pondents are divided into three classes. Discounts and loans on advances on security can be obtained at the branch bank, the agencies, and the sub-agency, and the correspondents of the first and second class, of which there are sixty-two. Remit- tances and the power of receiving short drafts by means of "assignations," that is, of drafts issued by the bank, are allowed between all the offices except those of the third class. A charge of 30 cents (say, sixpence), including the stamp duty payable to the Government of 21 cents (say, fourpence) on each transaction, irrespective of amount, has kept these trans- actions from being very numerous. The turnover in them was about ;^26,ooo,ooo for the year 1900-1. Cheques are not 176 VARIATIONS IN RATE, BANK OF HOLLAND [cH. xvii much used in Holland. The notes in circulation, short drafts and balances on deposit account at the bank, must be covered by coin and bullion to the extent of 40 per cent. Loans to a considerable extent are made by the bank on merchandise. The discount business, though much smaller than that in Belgium, is considerable. The law of August 7th, 1888, allowed the bank to buy bills payable abroad. This power has been used, though not to a very large extent. These bills are sold when the Foreign Exchanges become unfavourable to Holland, and when this occurs are as useful to the bank as the possession of gold. The loans, advances, and discounts on March 31st, 1902, were about ;^8,8cx),ooo, divided thus : — Inland Bills . . . ;^3, 500,000 Foreign Bills . . . 940,000 Loans and Advances . . 4,400,000 The total discounts for the year 1 900-1 were about ;^2 7,000,000. The capital and reserve fund of the bank may be reckoned as ^2,000,000. Like the Bank of Belgium, it keeps in touch with the business of the country through the operations at its numerous agencies and correspondents, and it watches the foreign exchanges in the interest of the country, which is sometimes exposed to considerable demands for specie. As a rule, the balance of trade is in favour of Holland, and bullion accordingly flows in freely. But occasion- ally the tide turns, as was the case in 1882, when a strong demand for export set in, and the bank's stock of gold, which about the middle of 1880 had amounted to 80,000,000 of guilders (;^6,666,6oo, at 12 guilders = ;^ i ), decreased to below 5,000,000 guilders (;i^4 16,600). To protect the general interests of the country against the serious dangers thus threatened, a bill was passed (Act of 27th April, 1884) empowering the Government, as soon as the state of the currency should render it necessary, to withdraw from circulation and to sell in the open market silver coin to the amount of 25,000,000 of guilders (;^2,o83,300, at 12 gs. = ;^i), and to buy gold with the proceeds. Up to the present time, however, " there has never been any need to put this measure CH. xvii] FLUCTUATIONS IN RATE, MODERATE, HOLLAND 177 — which in the full sense of the term may be considered as the safety-valve of the present currency system of Holland — into force.'' The existence of this power, which may be regarded as the equivalent of a "Treasury Letter" to the Bank of England in a crisis, has doubtless been of service to the Bank of Holland in difficult times, though the price of silver, and consequently the amount of gold bullion which could be purchased with 25,000,000 of guilders, is now (1902) less than half of what it was in 1884, the price of silver having been 4s. 2d. per oz. at the earlier, but only about i j. loal. at the later date. "The law of 1884 is the unequivocal acknowledgment of the principle that the State is responsible for the maintenance of the gold value of the silver currency, and that it is one of the first duties of every Government that has imposed a standard of value upon its subjects to take every reasonable precaution in its power to prevent that standard from fluctuating."* Holland is the only country in Europe which has recognised this duty. The Bank of Holland has, as distinctly as the Bank of France, endeavoured to keep an equable position both in ordinary times and in times of pressure. It is princi- pally a bank of discount, and declines anything that is not exactly trade paper — even of the most respectable houses. It has been able to maintain on average since 1845 the lowest rate of discount of any of the five banks whose operations we are now describing. The variations in its rate do not much exceed in number those of the Bank of Germany, and the extent of those fluctuations has on the whole been moderate. The number of changes in the rate of discount at the Bank of Holland has been 173, as against 161 at the Bank of Germany, iii at the Bank of France, and 400 at the Bank of England, between 1844 and 1900. Days. X The number of days at the rate of 3 per cent, and below was . 12,508 . 61 3J to 5 per cent, inclusive the number was . . . 7>i84 . 35 si per cent, up to 7 per cent., the highest charged . . . 878 . 4 In all . . . 20,570 . 100 The merchant who required discounts would have obtained this accommodation on the whole at more reasonable terms * See article by Dr. N. P. Van den Berg, "Exchange between Holland and Dutch India," Palgrave's Dictionary of Political Economy, vol. i. p. 773. N 178 VARIATIONS IN RATE, BANK OF HOLLAND [cH. xvii from the Bank of Holland than at any other of the great banks of Europe. Similar tables to those prepared for the explanation of the transactions of the other banks are given for those of the Bank of Holland, Table 30 gives the monthly averages of the minimum rate, Table 31 gives the number of days at each rate, and of changes in each year, from 1844 to 1900. TABLE 30. Monthly Averages of Minimum Rate of Discount of Bank of Holland 1845-1900, in groups of Ten Years, 1845-54, 1855-64, 1865-74, 1875-84, 1885-94, and of Six Years, 1895-1900, with Summary Table, 1845-1900. 1846-54. 1855-64. 1865-74. 1875-84. Average for Av.of Ten Years = 100. Average for Average of Ten Years = 100. Average for Average of Ten Years = 100. Average for Average of Ten Years = 100. Month. the Ten Years, £2 i8j. id. the Ten Years, ;£3 i6f . ad. the Ten Years, ;£3 17*. ad. the Ten Years, £% is. id. £ i. d. £ s. d. £ s. d. £ s. d. January . 3 1 4 los 404 rob 476 114 3 12 2 106 February . 300 Z03 3 14 11 g8 3 18 8 102 3 12 2 lob March 30s 104 3 13 gb 3 13 3 95 3 11 8 105 April 2 18 3 100 3 10 " 93 3 9 7 9{ 3 9 II 102 May 2 17 7 99 3 12 I 95 3 13 10 gt 3 9 10 102 June 2 16 96 3 11 7 94 3 II 7 93 3 4 8 95 July 2 14 4 93 3 II 93 3 13 94 340 94 August 2 14 3 93 3 10 6 93 3 16 2 99 3 3 II 93 September. 2 15 94 3 II II 95 3 13 5 95 340 94 October . 2 16 10 q8 3 19 8 to5 3 17 I 100 3 7 6 99 November. 3 2 I 106 464 114 446 no 390 lOI December . 340 ZIO 4 10 I 118 4 S 6 III 3 10 9 104 Difference Highest and 1 lOwest Difference : H ighest and Difference : H 'ghestand Difference: Highest and Month, gs. ga Lowest Month, 191. ^d. Lowest Month. 17^. x\d. Lowest Month, is. 3d. Mean of e ttreme Variatio ns for Mean of extr erne Vari- Mean of extr erne Vari- Mean of extr ame Vari- 1845-54, 8-5% ations for 1B55- 64, i=i-5% ations for 1865- 74, 1 1 '5% ations for 1875-84, 6*5% 1885-94. 1895-1900. 1845-1900. Average for Average of Average for Average of Average for the Average of Month. the Ten Years, Ten Years the Six Years, Six Years Fifty-six Years, Fifty-six £1 141. id. = lao. £2 2J. id. = 100. £%6s.id. Years =100. £ s. d. £ s. d. £ s. d. anuary . 2 17 2 los 329 lOI 3 10 9 to6 February 2 14 I 99 2 18 10 94 3 7 103 March 2 13 97 300 g6 3 5 7 99 April 2 13 97 2 IS 8 94 3 3 9 gb May 2 13 6 98 2 18 4 93 3 4 7 97 June 2 12 95 2 18 8 94 328 94 July 2 12 95 3 3 I JOI 3 2 II «f August 2 14 2 99 3 S 2 los 3 3 II gb September 2 16 102 3 3 4 102 340 gb October . 2 16 6 103 362 106 3 7 4 101 November 2 17 105 368 loy 3 II 3 107 December 2 17 5 106 368 107 3 12 9 no Difference: Highest and Lowe St Month, Difference : E [ighest and Difference: K [ighest and 5J. sd. Lowest Month, 8 s\d. Lowest Month, 10s. id. Mean of extreme Variations fo r 1885-94, Mean of ext reme Vari- Mean of ext reme Vari- 5-5% ations for 1895-j 900, 7% ations for 1845-1 900, 8% CH. xvii] DAYS AT EACH RATE, 1844-1900, HOLLAND 179 BANK OF HOLLAND. RATE OF DISCOUNT. Table 31, Changes in the Rate of Discount charged by the Bank of Holland, and the Number of Days at each Rate in each Year, from September 5th, 1844, to December 31st, 1900. No. I 6 Ill 16S 14 20 8 48 — — — 366 1872 1873 4 S 9 — — 83 29 217 7 16 13 — 36s 1873 1874 3 3 — — — 317 14 17 17 — — 36S 1874 1875 — I I — 128 237 — — — — — 36S 1875 1876 No cha nge — — 366 — — — — — — 366 1876 1877 No cha nge — — 36s — — — — — — — — 36s 1877 1878 2 — 2 — 122 160 83 — — — — — 36S 1878 1879 — 2 2 — 217 112 36 — — — — — — 36s 1879 1880 No cha nge — 366 — — — — — — — 366 1880 1881 ^ 3 — — 280 6 48 31 — — — — — 36S 1881 1882 4 4 8 — — 81 30 83 IS3 18 — — — 36s 1882 1883 I 4 S — — 206 32 34 20 73 — — — 36s 1883 1884 — I I — — 231 13s — — — — 366 1884 1885 I I 216 149 — — 36S 1885 1886 Nc cha nge ^6S — — — — — — 36S 1886 1887 Nc cha nge — S6S — — — — — — — — — ,36s 1887 1888 Nc cha nge — 366 — — — — — — — — — 366 1888 1889 Nc cha nge 36, — — — — — — — — 36S 1889 1890 4 — 4 — 291 24 7 2 41 — — — — — .365 1890 1891 ^ 3 324 13 7 21 — — — — — 36S 1891 1892 — I I 221 14s — — — — — 366 1892 1893 4 2 6 l^6 83 30 32 — 84 — — — 365 1893 1894 2 2 — 312 44 9 — — — — — — 30s 1894 1895 Nc cha nge — S6S — — — — — — — .36S 1895 1896 2 — 2 — 57 232 77 — — — — — — — 366 1896 1897 — I I — 266 99 — — — — — — 365 1897 1898 — I I — 123 242 — — — — — — — .365 1898 1899 4 — 4 — 172 13 IS — 77 88 — — — — 36S 1899 1900 3 3 — 328 8 13 16 — — — — 36s 1900 86 87 173 1,328 4,737 6,443 3.030 2,104 651 1,399 367 226 ISO 135 20,570 i8o VARIATIONS IN RATE, BANK OF HOLLAND [ch. xvii Table 32 gives the number of days at each Rate arranged from the highest number to the smallest, and also arranged from the lowest rate to the highest. For further remarks see Chapter XIX., p. 190, and Chapter XX., p. 203, which contain a general statement of the more important business fluctuations here considered. TABLE 32. Bank of Holland— Rate of Discount— 1844-1900. The Number of Days at each Rate, arranged from the highest number to the smallest. of Days (20,570). Rate Per Cent. Number of Days = 1,000 6,443 . . . 3 . . 313 4.737 2i 230 3.030 3h 147 2,104 4 102 1.399 5 68 1,328 2 65 651 4i 32 367 5h 18 226 6 11 ISO 6h 7 13s 7 7 20,570 1,000 Bank of Holland— Rate of Discount— 1844-1900. The Number of Days at each Rate, arranged from the lowest rate to the highest. Rate Per Cent. Number of Days (20,570). Number of Days = 1,000 2 . . . 1,328 ... 65 2* 4,737 230 3 6,443 313 3i 3.030 147 4 2,104 102 4i 651 32 5 1,399 68 Si 367 18 6 226 11 6i 150 7 7 135 7 20,570 1,000 CHAPTER XVIII VARIATIONS IN THE RATE CHARGED BY THE BANK OF BELGIUM FROM 1851 TO 1900 PAGE Direction of Bank of Belgium . 181-182 Governor and Deputy - Governor ap- pointed by the King . . 181-182 Branch (Antwerp) and Discount Offices 1 82- 1 83 Business of Bank in Commercial Paper and Bills . . . 182-183 The Country Discount Offices Private Partnerships, responsible for the busi- ness they carry on . . . 183 Fluctuations in the Rate of Discount compared with those at the Banks of Holland and France . . .184 Specie Reserve of Bank of Belgium comparatively small . . . 184 Bills Discounted . . . . 185 Large Proportion of Bills on other Countries held . . .185 Average Note Circulation . . .185 [Amounts in Francs Rate of Discount compared with that at Banks of England, France, Germany, and Holland . . . 185-186 Large Proportion of Days atLowRates 185-1 86 Comparatively small number of Fluctua- tions in Rate . . . , 186 Table 33. Monthly Averages of Mini- mum Rate of Discount of Bank of Belgium from 1851-1900 . . 187 Table 34. Changes in the Rate of Dis- count charged by Bank of Belgium and the number of days at each Rate in each year, 1851-1900 . . 188 Table 35. Bank of Belgium Rate of Discount, 1851-1900. The number of days at each Rate arranged from the highest number to the smallest, and arranged from the lowest rate to the highest . , . . 189 converted as 25=;^!.] The rate of discount charged by the Bank of Belgium has now to be examined. The government of this bank, which was founded by the Act of May 5, 1850,* is practically in the hands of the State, in a manner closely corres- ponding to that of the Banks of France, of Germany, and of Holland. The Governor is appointed by the King, who may also suspend or discharge him. His salary, which is fixed by the King, is paid by the bank, and the bank also provides him with a residence, and furnishes it. The Governor presides at all councils and meetings, and sees to the enforcement of all * Hence the year 185 1 is the first complete year of its operations. 181 i82 VARIATIONS IN RATE, BANK OF BELGIUM [ch. xviii laws and regulations. It would be his duty to inform the Government of any act of the council which might be contrary to the statutes, or adverse to the State, should any such occur. He has general authority over all the agents of the bank, and must own fifty shares of i,ooo francs each (say ^40) of the bank stock. The King also selects a deputy- governor from among the directors of the bank, who acts instead of the Governor when he is absent. The Directors, six in number, are chosen by the general assembly. They must be Belgian citizens, and reside in Brussels. Each director must own at least twenty-five shares, and cannot be on the administrative council of any other bank. Each director has the control of one department or more of the business of the bank, and has authority over the officers employed there. The Administrative Council meets three times a week. It also advises with the Censors, who, seven in number, are appointed by the general meeting of the shareholders. The Council of the Censors has control over all the transactions, audits the books, and votes the budget of expenses prepared by the Ad- ministrative Council. The Governor, Directors, and Censors constitute the General Council, which meets once a month, and keeps the position of the bank generally under consideration. It also selects a Discount Council, which examines the paper presented for discount, and determines what to accept or reject. The business is thus carefully safeguarded. The Bank of Belgium differs from the Banks of England, France, and Germany, in the fact that it has, like the Bank of Holland, one preponderating branch — in the case of the Bank of Belgium, that at Antwerp — at which a very large proportion of the business of the bank is done. The bank has branches and discount offices in the principal cities of the provinces, and in those other places where the Government considers it advisable. The bank confines its operations to commercial paper, and does not discount bills drawn on a bank. It buys bills on foreign centres — as London, Paris, and Amsterdam. Including Brussels and Antwerp, there are forty-one offices in all ; these include places which are important business centres, like Charleroi, Ghent, Liege, and Verviers, and very small towns like P^ruwelz and Wavre. CH. xviii] COUNTRY DISCOUNT OFFICES, BELGIUM 183 Discount ofifices, Comptoirs d'Escompte, are established wherever the interests of trade render this necessary. At these offices bills which conform to the requirements of the statutes of the bank are discounted. Each office is responsible for the paper in which it deals. Facilities for discount are given at niost of the agencies of the bank. Discount offices are in some instances maintained in places which carry on their business through the medium of the post, corresponding in this with the Villes rattachies in connection with the Bank of France. Under these circumstances it may well be understood that the operations of the discount offices which are responsible for the paper they admit to discount are carefully conducted and watched. The country discount offices of the Bank of Belgium are institutions so peculiar in character that a few words of ex- planation are advisable. They are private partnerships, SocUtds en nom collectif, " the title of the firms comprising the name of one or more of the partners, and the liability of each being unlimited." (See article on SocUtis Commerciales in Palgrave's Dictionary of Political Economy^ The members, or adminis- trators, of these firms are approved by the bank. They are responsible for the due payment of the bills discounted by them. They do a large business. During the year 1901 they discounted collectively 1,968,897 bills for an amount of ;^44,205,96o. The share of the discount, Del Credere, which the bank received for these was ^173,235; the share which the offices received was ;!^43,388. Del Credere means in this reference an extra commission received by a broker who undertakes to become surety for the solvency of the customer for whom he transacts business.* During the year 1901 more business, as is not unusual, was done at the country discount offices than at the head office. This is shown by the details of the business in 1901 : — (^Amounts in francs converted as 25 =;£i throughout this statement) The branches discounted . . 1,968,897 bills for ;^44i2os,9s6 Antwerp discounted . . . 243,118 „ 15,976,649 Brussels discounted . . . 1,657,972 „ 41,874,454 * See translation of the Report of the Bank of Belgium in the Banker^ Magazine for November, 1902. i84 VARIATIONS IN RATE, BANK OF BELGIUM [ch. xviii In the total amount of discounts the operations At the country offices represented . 43 per cent. Those at Antwerp . . . 16 „ Those at Brussels . . . . 41 ,, As the same rate of discount obtains at all the offices, the National Bank of Belgium is closely in touch with the business of the country. The regulations as to the note circulation direct that the bank shall maintain a stock of specie in hand equal to one-third of the combined amount of its bank note circulation and other obligations at sight ; but the Minister of Finance may at his discretion set aside this obligation, and authorise the bank to work below the one-third limit. Thus the bank is practically free in respect of its issues, and in 1 90 1 the specie and bullion held averaged ^4,500,000, and the fiduciary note circulation ;^23, 500,000. With reference to the date to which this statement is carried in the case of the Bank of Belgium, as the bank was not estab- lished till the year 185 1, while the operations of the other banks referred to in these pages go back to earlier dates, an exact comparison of the number of the changes in its rate with those of the other banks is not possible. For the period during which it has been at work, its fluctuations have corresponded very closely in number with those of the Bank of Holland ; it has not been quite as free from changes as the Bank of France, but it compares well with the other banks in this respect, as well as in the moderation of the rates of discount charged. While these moderate charges have been maintained, the reserve in specie of the Bank of Belgium has never been large in proportion to its operations. The current accounts were ;^3, 600,000 to the credit December 31st, 1901, and the bills discounted were ;^ 19, 100,000. With notes in circula- tion at the same date ;^26,ooo,ooo, the coin and bullion held stood at ;^4,6oo,ooo, less than one-fifth of the notes in the hands of the public. The bank has been enabled to carry on its operations with this comparatively small bullion reserve through its skill in discounting, and through the power of regulating the foreign exchanges which it possesses by means of the quantity of foreign paper which it holds. In the CH. xviii] DISCOUNTS AND NOTE CIRCULATION i8s balance-sheet of December 31st, 1901 (p. 207), the bills dis- counted stood at ;^ 1 9, 100,000; of this sum the foreign bills held amounted to ;^6, 500,000. Through holding these drafts on other countries the council of the bank has the means of operating in any direction when the exchanges are un- favourable to Belgium. The moderate rates of discount charged and the comparatively small range of fluctuation show how carefully, especially of late years, the Bank of Belgium has maintained this power. Roughly speaking, one-fifth part of the bills it has dealt with during the last twenty years have been on foreign countries. A statement is likewise given of the average fiduciary note circulation — the amount of which has greatly increased, particularly during the last twenty years. The considering the manner in which these points have been managed and the low rate of discount which has been charged will enable us to appreciate the caution with which the Bank of Belgium has conducted its operations : — Total Operations in Discounts. Year. On Belgium. On Foreign Countries Total. 1851 . 3,248,000 ... 4,192,000 7,440,000 i860 . 29,176,000 ... 1,120,000 30,296,000 1870 . 48,200,000 ... 5,272,000 ... 53,472,000 1880 65,880,000 ... 13,904,000 79,784,000 1890 . 78,344,000 ... 15,876,000 94,220,000 1900 . 109,988,000 ... 27,728,000 ... 137,716,000 1901 102,057,000 ... 32,776,000 ••• 134,833.000 Average Fiduciary Note Circulatj ON. Year. £ 1851 1,268,000 i860 4,472,000 1870 7,488,000 1880 12,544,000 1890 15,292,000 1900 23,060,000 1901 23,970,000 The rate of discount charged by the Bank of Belgium has generally been moderate, more than half — 10,623 days out of the 18,262 days which have elapsed between 1851, the first complete year of the bank's operations, and 1900 — having been at 2^ and 3 per cent. i86 VARIATIONS IN RATE, BANK OF BELGIUM [ch. xviii The number of days at these rates, compared with the other banks under notice, is as follows : — Belgium England France Germany Holland No of Days. 10,623 out of 18 ,262 II.34I „ 20 S70 10,163 » » 2,640 y> ) 12,508 » J jS per cent, of total. SS li » 49 I. I. 6^ „ ,: Days. % The number of days at the rate of 3 per cent, and below was 10,623 ■ J3 33 7 8 SCOTCH NOTE CIRCULATION AND SPECIE HELD AGAINST IT (j-« Table 15, pp. 118-120 and Table 17, pp. 134-131). Note Circulation. Specie Held against it. Years. Difference between the Highest Month and the Lowest Month. Mean of the extreme Variations during each Period. Difference between the Highest Month and the Lowest Month. Mean of the extreme Variations during each Period. £ 7,, £ 7. 1845-1854 . 559,000 83 198,000* 9 1866-1864 . 704,000 83 295,000 63 1865-1874 . 814,000 83 511,000 8 1875-1884 . 1,072,000 93 819,000 10 1885-1894 . 1,092,000 9 945,000 ^03 1896-1900 . 1,380,000 93 1,304,000 II Total Period, 1845-1900. 839,000 83 568,000* 83 From 1846 in the case of the Specie held. CH. xix] TABLES OF FLUCTUATIONS, SUMMARY 193 TABLE 36 {continued). Holland and Belgium, Note Circulation Bank of England, Bullion in Issue Bankers' Clearing House Returns, Scotch and Irish Note Circulation, and Specie held. Bullion in the Issue Depart- Liabilities of the Bank of Reserve of the Bank of England ment OF THE Bank op bNGLANE (j« Table 7, p. 71). (j« Table 11, pp. 82, 83). (see Table 11, pp. 83, 83). Proportion of Reserve Difference between Mean of the Difference between Mean of the Difference between Mean of the the Highest Month and the Lowest extreme Vari- the Highest Month extreme Vari- the Highest Month extremeVari- to Liabili- ations during and the Lowest ations during and the Lowest ations during ties (see Month. each Period. Month. each Period, Month. each Period. Table i», p. 82). .J °l. £ V. £. 7. 7. 885,000 S'S 3,109,000 9 2,004,000 II 62 1,485,000 S'J 1,862,000 S 2,038,000 12 42 1,867,000 rs 3,712,000 7 2,449,000 10-5 43 2,940,000 -S'-^ 5,053,000 8 2,837,000 9' 5 44 3,909,000 s-s 5,201,000 T5 3,432,000 II 45 3,982,000 6 7,505,000 7 5,372,000 lo-S 51 2,005,000 S 3,914,000 7 2,460,000 9 46 Bank of Belgium Rate of Discount (see Table 33, p. 187). Country Note Circula- tion OF England (see Table 8, p. 75). Clearing House Returns (see Table 18, p. 133). Difference between the Highest Month and the Lowest Month. Mean of the extreme Variations during each Period. Difference between the Highest Month and the Lowest Month. Mean of the extreme Variations during each Period. Years. Difference between the Highest Month and the Lowest Month. Mean of the extreme Variations during each Period. J. d. 5 o« 13 S IS 6 17 S 9 10 8 10 0* 7. rs 9-s lo-s 13 8 6 7S 636,000 583.000 549,000 443,000 262,000 240,000 465,000 7c 4-S 5 SS ss SS s-s s 1868-1874 1875-1884 1885-1894 1895-1900 1868-1900 £ 102,112,000 115,386,000 95,489,000 113,815,000 80,397,000 7. 12 S-S s-s 7S • From 1 851. IRISH NOTE CIRCULATION AND SPECIE HELD AGAINST IT (see Table 16, pp. 121-3, and Table 17, pp. 124-131), Note Circulation. Specie Hele against IT. Difference between the Mean of the extreme Difference between the Mean of the extreme Highest Month and the Variations during each Highest Month and the Variations during each Lowest Month. Period. Lowest Month. Period. £ 7= £ % 999,000 9 262,000* 8 1,005,000 8 302,000 7 1,294,000 9S 518,000 10 1,340,000 9S 512,000 ss 974,000 7-S 401,000 6-S 1,057,000 8 422,000 7 1,103,000 SS 352,ooo» 7 * From 1846 in the case of the Specie held. o 194 FLUCTUATIONS IN THE RATE [cH. xix and Belgium have not been so uniform as in France, none of these banks show anything like the same extremes of variation as are found in England. Nor are such fluctuations found in any other business movements in England of which we possess any indications as, for instance, in the proportions between the reserve and liabilities of the Bank or of the specie in the Issue Department. The fluctuations in the London Bankers' Clearing- House returns, which represent the amount of business passing from month to month, do not show any variations so extreme as those of the discount rate of the Bank of England, nor do the figures of the note circulation of the Bank of England, nor those of the English country note circulation, exhibit any similar movement. This last, though now greatly shrunken from the position it once held, yet reflected closely while it was more general than it became of recent years the requirements of English provincial business, and did this very distinctly when the note circulation extended more widely over the country. The returns of the Scotch and of the Irish note circulations show considerable fluctuations, but these also are not so extreme as the fluctuations in the rate charged by the Bank of England. It should be added that these summary tables were brought together thus with the view of examining whether any corres- pondence of fluctuation might be found. The only place in which such a correspondence exists is in the fluctuations of the Scotch and Irish note circulations, which, through the operation of the Bank Acts of 1844-5, ^'^^ brought to bear directly on the reserve of the Bank of England. The autumnal drain also must be remembered (see Chapter XIV., p. 138). It is well to mention here that these tables were originally drawn up in much greater detail, principally in annual, some in monthly averages. In this shape, while the information con- tained in them was very instructive, they were so cumbrous that publication was not advisable. The comparison has there- fore been shown between the fluctuations in the decades into which the various tables are divided because this was the most convenient method of placing the information before the reader in a succinct form. These tables show that the fluctuations in the rate charged by the Bank of England have been far CH. xix] FLUCTUATIONS IN RATE, HIGHEST IN ENGLAND 195 greater, more rapid, and more extreme than at any other bank in Europe. To make this point perfectly clear Tables 37, p. 196, 38, p. 197, and 39, p. 198, have been prepared. Table 37 shows the number of variations in the rate of discount charged by all the five banks in each year from 1844 to 1900; Table 38 the lowest and highest rates and the extent of fluctuation ; and Table 39 the number and extent of annual fluctua- tions in the rate — grouped together so as to show the extent of the fluctuations — and the number of years in which these fluctuations occurred. This last-mentioned table provides an interesting compendium of the number and extent of the fluctuations. These are arranged in order from the lowest rate of fluctuation to the highest. From it we learn that at no bank but the Bank of England were there during three separate years fluctuations so large as of 5^, 6, and 6^ per cent. With the exception of the Bank of Germany, and this only during one twelvemonth, no bank, except the Bank of England, has shown fluctuations of more than 4 per cent, and 5 per cent, in one year. In the majority of years the fluctuations at the other banks did not exceed i or 2 per cent. Hence, while the range of fluctuation at the other banks has been low, it has been high at the Bank of England. There can be no doubt that to the borrower, and every man in business practically must at times be a borrower, this high range of fluctuation has been a very serious disadvantage. In a statement like the present it is impossible to put before the reader more than the merest outline of the subject. No doubt the commercial position of England — the vast foreign trade of the country as shown by the enormous amounts of the exports and imports (see Table 44, p. 213) — the manner in which London is the clearing house of the world — all expose the London money market to sharper and more sudden demands for specie than any other business centre. The demands for specie are most closely connected with the rate of discount. The point for us to consider should be : Is our system arranged on the best plan to meet these demands ? Our method of keeping all the banking reserves of the country with one bank enables a great economy to be practised in our specie reserve ; ig6 FLUCTUATIONS IN THE RATE [CH. XIX TABLE 37. Number of Variations in Rates of Discount, Banks of England, France, Germany, Holland (1844-1900), and Belgium (1851-1900). BankofEn^land. Bank of Francej No. of Variatiotc in Rate. ' Bank of Germany. Bank of Holland. Bank of Belgium. Years. No. of Vanations No. of Variations No. of Variations No. of Variations Years. in Rate. in Rate. in Rate. in Rate.* 1844 I No change I No change — 1844 1845 2 No change 2 s 1845 1846 I No change 2 2 — 1846 1847 9 2 I I — 1847 1848 3 No change 2 4 — 1848 1849 I No change I I — 1849 1860 I No change No change I — 1850 1851 No change No change No change No change No change 1851 1852 2 I No change No change I 1852 1853 6 I I 2 No change 1853 1854 2 2 I No change No change 1854 1855 8 2 I 2 No change 1855 1856 7 2 4 3 I 1856 1857 9 8 6 g 4 1857 1858 6 4 5 6 4 1858 1859 5 2 2 No change 2 1859 1860 II I No change No change 2 1860 1861 II 7 No change 2 s 1861 1862 5 4 No change 4 3 1862 1863 12 8 I 6 3 1863 1864 IS II 4 9 6 1864 1865 16 6 c II 6 1865 1866 14 7 g II 6 1866 1867 3 2 No change 6 I 1867 1868 2 No change No change 2 No change 1868 1869 7 No change t 5 No change 1869 1870 10 4 s 12 5 1870 1871 10 2 2 2 11 1871 1872 14 I I 6 9 1872 187S 24 4 7 9 16 1873 1874 13 2 4 3 9 1874 1875 12 No change S I 9 1875 1876 5 I 6 No change 2 1876 1877 7 I 7 No change 2 1877 1878 10 I 3 2 3 1878 1879 s 2 5 2 4 1879 1880 2 2 s No change 2 1880 1881 6 2 3 3 7 1881 1882 6 3 4 8 10 1882 1883 6 I I 5 I 1883 1884 7 No change No change I 2 1884 1885 7 No change 3 I 4 1886 1886 7 No change 5 No change 6 1886 1887 7 No change 2 No change 2 1887 1888 9 4 2 No change 6 1888 1889 8 2 4 No change 4 1889 1890 II No change 3 4 2 1890 1891 10 No change 4 3 No change 1891 1892 4 I 2 I I 1892 1893 12 No change 3 6 I 1893 1894 2 No change 2 2 No change 1894 1895 No change I I No change I 1895 1896 3 No change 3 2 I 1896 1897 6 No change S I No change 1897 1898 6 I 6 I I 1898 1899 ' 6 2 7 4 6 1899 1900 6 4 3 3 2 1900 Total Variations 400 III 161 "73 173 * Commenced operations in 1851. CH. xix] FLUCTUATIONS IN RATE AT THE FIVE BANKS 197 TABLE 38. Lowest and Highest Rates charged and Extent of Fluctuation during each year, Banks of England, France, Germany, Holland (1844-1900), and Belgium (1851-1900). Bank II Bank Bank Bank Bank 11 OF England. 11 OF France. OF Germany. OF Holland. OF Belgium. 11 Year. u ig Si u u o ^ (11 lii MO 3d U O >, i^ L o o H la M" y Year. ^« 3'^ e'" ^'^ i!« ^■= ^« w« 5-3 2^ 5^ ^^ !5« .3 -a 1844 No chan ?e No chan ?e 4% 44% 4% No chan ge — — — 1844 1845 2i% 34% 1% No chan ?e 4 5 1 24% 54% 3% — — — 1845 1846 3 34 4 No chan ?e 4 5 1 4 54 14 1846 1847 3 3 8 s 5 2 4% No S% chan 1% 44 44 5 5 4 4 4 3 5 5 1 2 Operauons commenced 1851. 1847 1848 1849 2i 3 4 No chan ge 4 44 4 24 3 4 — — — 1849 1850 2i 3 4 No chan ge No chan ge 2 24 4 — — — 1850 1861 No chan ge No chan ge No chan ge No chan ge No chan ge 1851 1852 2 24 4 3 4 No chan ge No chan ge 3% 4% 1% 1862 1853 2 5 3 3 4 4 5 1 2 3 1 No chan ge 1863 1854 S 54 4 4 S 4 S 1 No chan ge No chan ge 1854 1855 3i 7 34 4 6 4 44 4 3 4 1 No chan ge 1855 1856 4i 7 24 5 6 4 6 2 4 54 14 3 4 1 1866 1857 Si lO 44 s 9 5 74 24 4 7 3 34 54 2 1867 1868 2i 8 B4 3 5 4 64 24 3 7 41 3 5 2 1868 1869 2i 44 2 3 4 4 S 1 No chan ge 3 4 1 1859 1860 2i 6 34 34 44 No chan ge No chan ge 3 4 1 1860 1861 3 8 6 44 7 24 No chan ge 3 4 1 3 5 2 1861 1862 2 3 1 34 s 14 No chan ge 34 4 4 3 4 1 1862 1863 3 8 6 34 7 34 4 44 4 3 s 2 3 54 24 1863 1864 6 9 3 44 8 34 44 7 24 44 7 24 4 6 2 1864 1866 3 7 4 3 s 2 4 7 3 3 6 3 3 6 3 1866 1866 3i lO 64 3 5 2 4 9 5 44 7 24 3 6 3 1866 1867 2 34 14 24 3 4 No chan ge 24 44 2 24 3 4 1867 1868 2 3 1 No chan ge No chan ge 24 34 1 No chan ge 1868 1869 2i 44 2 No chan g« 4 5 1 24 24 No chan ge 1869 1870 2i 6 34 24 6 34 4 8 4 3 6 3 24 6 34 1870 1871 2 s 3 s 6 1 4 S 1 3 4 1 24 54 3 1871 1872 3 7 4 s 6 1 4 S 1 24 5 24 24 54 3 1872 1873 3 9 6 s 7 2 4 6 2 4 64 24 34 7 34 1873 1874 2i 6 34 4 S 1 4 6 2 34 5 14 34 6 24 1874 1875 2 6 4 No chan gs 4 6 2 3 34 4 3 44 14 1875 1876 2 s 3 3 4 1 34 6 24 No chan ge 24 34 1 1876 1877 2 3 2 3 1 4 S4 14 No chan ge 24 34 1 1877 1878 2 6 4 2 3 1 4 5 1 3 4 1 24 44 2 1878 1879 2 s 3 2 3 1 3 44 14 3 4 1 24 4 14 1879 1880 2i 3 4 24 34 1 4 54 14 No chan ge 3 34 4 1880 1881 2i 5 24 34 S 14 4 54 14 34 44 1 34 2 1881 1882 3 6 3 34 s 14 4 6 2 34 54 2 3: 6 24 1882 1883 3 5 2 3 34 4 4 5 1 34 54 2 34 4 4 1883 1884 2 S 3 No chan ge No chan ge 3 34 4 3 4 1 1884 1885 2 s 3 No chan ge 4 5 1 24 3 4 3 4 1 1886 1886 2 5 3 No chan ge 3 5 2 No chan ge 24 4 14 1886 1887 2 s 3 No chan gs 3 5 2 No chan ge 24 34 1 1887 1888 2 5 3 24 44 2 3 44 IJ No chan ge 24 5 24 1888 1889 2i 6 34 3 4 1 3 5 2 No chan ge 3 5 2 1889 1890 3 6 3 No chan ge 4 54 14 24 44 .2 3 4 1 1890 1891 2i 5 24 No chan ge 3 54 24 3 44 14 No chan ge 1891 1892 2 34 14 24 3 4 3 4 1 24 3 4 24 3 4 1892 1893 2i s 24 No chan gs 3 5 2 24 5 24 24 3 4 1893 1894 2 3 1 No chan ge 3 5 2 24 34 1 No chan ge 1894 1895 No char ge 2 24 4 3 4 1 No chan ge 2i 3 4 1895 1896 2 4 2 No chan ge 3 5 2 24 34 1 24 3 4 1896 1897 2 4 2 No chan ge 3 5 2 3, 34 4 No chan ge 1897 1898 2i 4 14 2 3 1 3 6 3 24 3 t 3, 4 1 1898 1899 3 6 3 3 44 14 4 7 3 24 5 24 34 5 14 1899 1900 3 6 3 3 44 14 S 7 2 34 5 14 4 5 1 1900 198 FLUCTUATIONS IN THE RATE [CH. XIX TABLE 39. Number and extent of Annual Fluctuations in Rate at the Banks of England, France, Germany, Holland (1844-1900), and Belgium (1851-1900) during each year, grouped together so as to show the extent of the fluctuations and the number of years in which these fluctuations occurred. Bank of Bank of Bank of Bank of Bank of Extent of Annual Fluctuations % England. France. Germany. Holland. Belgium. Number of Number of Number of Number of Number of Yeats. Years. Years. Years. Years.* 4 6 4 6 9 7 1 4 17 13 II 13 14 3 S 6 S 4 2 6 6 13 6 7 24 4 I 5 7 4 3 15 — 3 4 4 34 S 3 — 2 4 44 5 54 4 I 3 I I 1 I — — I — — 6 64 I I — — — — Total . S4 37 48 43 41 Years in which no change occurred . 3 20 9 14 9 Years . S7 57 57 57 50 * Bank of Belgium commenced 1851. but on this one bank also all the demands connected with the note circulation of the country concentrate — both in England, Ireland, and Scotland — besides all the demands for the internal circulation of specie, of which an example is shown in the statement of the autumnal drain on the Bank of England for the twenty years 1881-1900 (Chapter XIV., p. 138), and all the demands for specie for export. These demands all fall on a reserve arranged as directed by the Act of 1844, which divides the resources of the Bank artificially into two parts, and causes the demand to fall on the smaller of them. The Act also has altered the composition of the reserve through increasing since 1844 the amount of the note circulation allowed to be issued against securities. See Chapter XXL, pp. 221-224. The division of the Issue Department and the Banking Department, although, no doubt, it has advantages, by directing immediate attention to the amount of free resources which the Bank has at its disposal, nevertheless tends to render the CH. xix] FIXITY OF ASSETS, BANK OF ENGLAND 199 amount actually available to meet any sudden demand smaller than it would be if this artificial arrangement were not followed. Then while at times the regulations of the Act of 1844 — which direct the Bank to buy standard gold up to any amount at a fixed price, whether needed for banking requirements or not — compel it to allow its reserve to be replenished at the will of the casual importer of gold — not of the responsible authorities of the Bank — thereby causing at times an unneeded accumulation, from which a low bank rate ensues, while at other times such an accumulation is followed by an opposite movement, and a tightness in the money market, both these movements being unconnected with the natural requirements of trade. All these matters are not without influence on the constant fluctuations in the rate. Table 7, p. 71, which contains a statement of the movements of the gold bullion in the Issue Department of the Bank, gives an outline of these transactions. An examination of this table, together with Table 11, pp. 82, 83, which compares the fluctuations in the liabilities and in the reserve, will be instructive, as will also be the comparison of the fluctuations in the rate of discount, the note circulation, the bullion, the liabilities, and the reserve shown in Table 36, pp. 192, 193. But search where we may in the accounts of the Bank, the fluctuations in the rate of discount exceed in severity all the other fluctuations which are recorded there. In considering the extent of these fluctuations something must be ascribed to the deficiency of fluidity in the assets of the Bank. That the securities held are all of the most dependable description there can be no doubt, but it is believed that the greater part by far are fixed securities. Little is now known as to the amount of bills discounted and of short loans, from which sources immediate supplies of ready cash can be obtained, hence this part of the subject can only be spoken of in very general terms. The general opinion is that the short loans are only occasionally of any important amount — that the amount of bills discounted now is but small. The traditions handed down from the patriarchs of the discount market respecting the amount of bills held by the Bank thirty or forty years ago, and their vivid description of the very considerable 200 FLUCTUATIONS IN THE RATE [cH. xix influence which the Bank of England once exercised over that market, to which there is nothing corresponding now, joined to the statement published by the Bank down to the year 1875 (see Table 3, cols. 30, 31, and 32, p. 14), lead to the impression that the Bank can now hold only a very small part of its assets in securities of this description. As is well known, if the Bank of England desires to " take money off the market " quickly it can only do this by working on its Consols. It does not hold any large amount of bills, which maturing rapidly would place it in possession of resources in cash without disturbing the outside market, nor has it any very large amount of short loans which it can draw in. Hence the action of the Bank must always be severe, though its action in protecting the reserve is most necessary. If the balance-sheet of the Bank of England is compared with the balance-sheets of the other banks cited, the difference of their position will be seen, both in regard to the fluidity of their resources and also to the amount of bills they hold in foreign centres. In order to enable the reader to make this comparison, the balance-sheet of the Bank of England for February 6th, 1902, has been given, both as it stands in the weekly returns and as it would appear if arranged as the balance-sheets of the other great issuing banks are. This will be found in Table 40, pp. 206, 207, with the balance-sheets of the Banks of France, Germany, Holland and Belgium for facility of comparison. The first point that strikes the reader is the enormous capital of the Bank of England — more than ;^ 18,000,000, including the rest or undivided profits. This amount com- pares with a capital of ;^9,ooo,ooo, including profits in addition, at the Bank of France, and of ;^9,7oo,ooo, including reserve, at the Bank of Germany. This amount is to be raised to ;^ 1 2,000,000 by the law of 1899. The capital and reserve of the Bank of Holland are about ;^2,ooo,ooo, and of the Bank of Belgium about ;^3,ooo,ooo. In respect of the amount of capital which it possesses the Bank of England has a great advantage over the other banks. When we proceed to the specie and bullion held the results are different. At the nearest convenient dates to that mentioned CH. xix] CAPITAL, DEPOSITS, BILLS AT THE FIVE BANKS 201 above — the dates will be found given in Table 40, pp. 206, 207 — the holding in specie of the Bank of England was ;^36,ooo,ooo, including perhaps ;^ 1,000,000 in silver; of the Bank of France, ;^ 143,000,000, including ;^44,ooo,ooo in silver ; at the Bank of Germany, ;^43, 000,000, including ;^i 2,000,000 in silver and divisional money; at the Bank of Holland, ^11,450,000; and at the Bank of Belgium, ;^4,6oo,ooo. The amounts are given in round figures in all cases. In the deposits there are great differences. Including public deposits, there were at the Bank of England ^^5 1,000,000 ; at the Bank of France, ;^39,ooo,ooo ; at the Bank of Germany, ^28,500,000; at the Bank of Holland, ^^400,000 ; and at the Bank of Belgium, ;^3,6oo,ooo. The differences between the amounts of notes in circulation issued by the banks are as considerable as those in the deposits. The notes in the hands of the public were : At the Bank of England, ^29,000,000 ; at the Bank of France, ;^ 1 63,000,000 ; at the Bank of Germany, ;^74,ooo,ooo ; at the Bank of Holland, ;^i8, 500,000; at the Bank of Belgium, ;^26,000,000. The great difference, however, between the banks is in the composition of the securities held. The amount, shown in Table 40, pp. 206, 207, was ;^62, 000,000 at the Bank of England. Few particulars are known, except that a large amount is held in fixed securities, and it is best not to attempt conjecture. The Bank of France held ^55,000,000. Of this over ;^3i,ooo,ooo was in bills, all at short dates, and about ;^24,ooo,ooo in advances on securities, all equally for short periods. At the Bank of Germany, out of ;^64,ooo,ooo, about ;^50,ooo,ooo was in bills, none at long dates, including ;^2, 100,000 on England and ;^8,ooo,ooo in advances on securities, all also for short periods. About ;if^6, 200,000 was invested in securities. At the Bank of Holland, out of ;^io,ooo,ooo, about ;^4,400,ooo was in bills, more than ;^900,ooo of these being on foreign countries. ;^4,ooo,ooo was in loans, also at short dates. At the Bank of Belgium, out of about ;^28,ooo,ooo, more than ;^i 9,000,000 was in bills, ;^6, 500,000 of these on foreign countries. ;if 5,000, 000 was in advances on government securities and other advances at short dates, and about ;^3,ooo,ooo in investments of a fixed 202 FLUCTUATIONS IN THE RATE [cH, xix character, including those held for the reserve fund. This rough analysis shows in what different forms of securities the amounts held by the different banks are invested. The largest holder of fixed securities is the Bank of England ; all the other banks hold their funds in a more readily available form. The large amount of specie held, the ready preparation made to meet any emergency, are among the causes which enable the great banks of the Continent to avoid the constant changes and the violent fluctuations in the rate which occur in England. The placing the balance-sheets together thus enables the reader to examine the facts for himself, in the same way as the statements in Table 36, pp. 192, 193, enable him to com- pare the fluctuations in the rate of discount charged by these banks during the period over which this investigation extends. CHAPTER XX SOME REMARKS ON THE RATE OF DISCOUNT OF THE BANKS OF ENGLAND, FRANCE, GERMANY, HOLLAND, AND BELGIUM Some remarks on Rate of Discount of the Banks of England, France, Ger- many, Holland and Belgium. Num- ber of days at each rate compared 203-210 Table 40. Balance-sheets of Banks oi England, France, Germany, Holland and Belgium compared . . 206-207 For the last twenty-five years the Rate lower in Paris than in London . . 209 Table 41. Rate of Discount of Banks of England, France, Germany, and Hol- land, 1844-1900, and Belgium, 1851- igoo. Number of days at each rate arranged from lowest rate to highest, and proportion per mille at each rate . 209 Tendency to greater Variations and number of Fluctuations to be expected 210 Foreign money in England and English capital abroad . . . 210-212 Table 42. Average Minimum Rate of Discount charged by Banks of England, France, Germany, and Holland for years 1845-1900, and Belgium for years 1851-1900, showing average for the groups of years and for the whole period . . . . 210 Table 43. Years in which no change took place in the Rate of Discount of Banks of England, France, Germany, Holland, and Belgium, 1844-1900 . 211 Bonds of Foreign Governments frequently held in England , . .212 Foreign Bills scarcely held . . . 212 Arrangements by which Foreign Banks meet demands arising from adverse exchanges . . . .212 Demand for Gold for Export . 212-213 Our Exports and Imports compared 213-214 Table 44. Foreign trade of United Kingdom (1861-1900), Imports and Exports, and London Clearing House Returns (totals at intervals of ten years) . ... 213 Need of a strong Bullion Reserve . .215 Advantages of London Money Market being the point where many monetary transactions are carried on, and that this country is so largely the Clearing House of the World . . .215 Disadvantages to business in this country of sudden and great Fluctuations in Rate of Discount . . . 2l6 Supply of Loanable Capital at moderate rates important to Trade . , 216 Table 45. Average Monthly Discount Rate, with proportion of each month to annual Average Rate, 1845-1900, at Banks of England, France, Germany, and Holland, Belgium 1851-1900, and at London Bankers' Clearing House 1868-1900 . . . . 216 A REVIEW of some of the more important points of similarity and contrast in the operations and the rate of discount of the Banks of England, France, Germany, Holland, and Belgium will not be out of place here. In one respect there is a difference between the rate charged at the Bank of Germany and those charged at the other banks between the years 1844 and 1900, and that is in the minimum rate of discount charged. The Bank of England, the Bank of France, and the Bank of Holland lowered their 203 204 REMARKS ON THE RATE OF DISCOUNT [ch. xx rates not infrequently to 2 per cent, in the course of those years. The rate of the Bank of Belgium dropped for a considerable time to 2^ per cent, but the Bank of Germany has never charged less than 3 per cent. During the period under review the rates from 2 to 2^ per cent, at the Bank of England were as below : — Bank of England, 1844 to 1900, Days. 2 per cent, for . . . . ■ 3.409 2i „ . . . . 28 2^ „ . . . . • 2,997 6,434 That is to say, for nearly one-third of the whole time the charges were at these low rates. The average rate charged by the Bank of France has been fractionally lower than that charged by the Bank of England, and it has charged less than 3 per cent, for a considerable period. The rates below 3 per cent, in the time under our notice were as follows : — Bank of France, 1844 to 1900. Days. 2 per cent, for . . . .1 . 2,027 2j „ . . . . • 2,579 4,606 Thus, in France extremely low rates only prevailed for about two-thirds of the time that they did in England. Still in France the time during which rates of 2 and 2^ per cent, lasted was more than one-fifth of the whole, a far from unimportant fraction. The corresponding figures in Holland are as follows : — Bank of Holland, 1844 to 1900. Days. 2 per cent, for . . ... 1,328 2i ., • • ... 4,737 6,065 This approaches very nearly to the number of days at similar rates in England. In Belgium 2 per cent, has never been charged ; 2^ is the lowest rate quoted by that Bank. Bank of Belgium, 1851 to 1900. Days. 2 1^ per cent, for . . . .. 3,169 About half the length of time of low rates in England or in Holland. CH. XX] RATES AT THE FIVE BANKS COMPARED 205 While, however, extremely low rates have thus prevailed for a considerable time in England, and for a long period, though not equally long, in France, Holland, and Belgium, the rate at Berlin never dropped to 3 per cent, till 21st March, 1879, and was at 3^ per cent, for 178 days only during the years under our notice. The number of days at the rates of 3 and 3^ per cent., which we may call intermediate rates, was as follows for all the five banks : — Bank of England, 1844 to 1900. Days. 3 per cent, for . . ... 4>9°7 3j .. • • ... 1,739 6,646 Bank of France, 1844 TO 1900. Days. 3 per cent. for . . • 5.557 3i ■ . 1,815 7.372 Bank of Germany, 1844 TO 1900. Days. 3 per cent. for . . 2,640 3^ • ■ . 178 2,818 Bank of Holland, 1844 TO 1900. Days. 3 per cent. for . . • 6,443 3J • • 3.030 9.473 Bank of Belgium, 1851 TO 1900. Days. 3 per cent for . . • 7.454 3h . 2,426 9,880 Taking the length of time that rates up to 3^ prevailed, the figures are as follows : — Days. Per cent, of whole Period Bank of England . 13,080 . . 64 Bank of France . 11,978 . • 58 Bank of Germany . 2,818 . • 14 Bank of Holland • 15.538 . • 75 Bank of Belgium . 13,049 . • 72 The greatest number of days recorded at one rate is that when the rate stood at 4 per cent, at Berlin. * The whole period is 20,570 days for the Banks of England, France, Germany, and Holland; 18,262 days for the Bank of Belgium. 206 REMARKS ON THE RATE OF DISCOUNT [ch. xx TABLE 40. Balance Sheets of the Banks of England, France, Germany, Holland, and Belgium, BANK OF ENGLAND.— Issue Department. Liabilities. Notes Issued £ 51,899,605 Assets. Government Debt . Other Securities . Gold Coin and Bullion EPARTMENT. £ . 11,015,100 • 6,759,900 . 34,124,605 ;^5i,899,6o5 Banking D ;f 5 1, 899,605 Proprietors' Capital Rest Public Deposits* . Other Deposits Seven-days and other Bills £ 14,553,000 3,561,102 12,338,295 39,051,746 250,019 Government Securities Other Securities . Notes . Gold and Silver Coin £ . 17,274,486 ■ 27,295,812 • 22,939,995 . 2,243,869 ;f 69,754, 162 ;^69,7S4,i62 * Including Exchequer, Savings Eanks, Commissioners of National Debt, and Dividend Accounts. Dateti February 6th, 1902. John G. Nairne, Chief Cashier. BANK OF FRANCE— jffa/a«« Sheet, December ^ist, 1901. Francs converted as 25=;^'!. Liabilities. £ Assets. £ Capital of the Bank 7,300,000 Coin and BuUion at Paris and at Reserve and Profits in addition the Branches 142,621,904 to Capital 1,700,622 Amount of Bills — Notes payable to bearer in circu Paris . ;^I2, 101,855 lation (head office and branches) 162,888,252 Branches . 19,620,233 Drafts . 1,039,749 31,722,088 Current Account with Treasury 8,098,797 Advances on Bullion, Money, and Current Accounts and Deposit Securities — Accounts — Paris .^11,861,298 Paris . ;^28,894,3i 5 Branches . 11,891,898 23,753,196 - 31,475,468 Advances to Government (laws Dividends unpaid, etc., etc. 2,626,634 of June 9, 1857, . une 13, 1878, November 17, 1897) 7,200,000 Government Stock(Reserve Fund 519.230 Disposable Funds, Government Stock . ... 3,985,092 Immovable Funds, Government Stock (law of June 9, 1857) . 4,000,000 Amount appropriated to Special Reserve 336,297 Office and furniture of the Bank and buildings at the Branches,et artce Sheet, March 31st, 1902. c. 991,715 ;^215, 129,522 )LhAND—Bai '215,129,522 BANK OF HC Guilders conver ted as I2=;^l, Liabilities. £ Assets. £ Capital . 1,666,667 Coin, Bullion, etc. . 11,457,222 Reserve . 444,3" Inland Bills 3,521,660 Notes in circulation 18,502,638 Foreign Bills 940,114 Transfers 126,766 Loan Accounts 3.846,76s Current Accounts . 380,068 Advances on Current Accounts 544.288 Discount on Inland Bills 12,318 Investments — Capital 775,379 ,, „ Foreign Bills 1,542 , , Reserve 62,666 Sundry liabilities . 85,205 Sundry Assets, Buildings, etc. 145.61S Net Profit for distribution 74,194 ;£'2i,293,709 ;^2i,293,709 Note. — All/w contra entries, as those of the notes of the Banks held by themselves, etc., are omitted so as to show the real position of the accounts. CH. xx] BALANCE SHEETS OF THE FIVE BANKS COMPARED 207 TABLE 40 (continued). BANK OF ENGLAND— j5a/a«f 9.776.698 21,832,532 6,911,620 4.905.790 31,609,230 11,817,410 43,426,640 Notes of Imperial Treasury(Reichs- kassenscheinen) . . . 900,281 Notes of other Banks . . 540,130 Bills held, due within fifteen days 16,637,085 Bills held, due at later dates . 31,128,690 Bills drawn on Eng- land Bills drawn on other foreign places 47.765,775 ;f 2, 171,987 26,088 2,198.075 49.963,850 Loans . ... 8,071,878 Securities. . . . 6,181,266 Value of Real Property belonging to the Bank . . . 1,863,360 Sundry Assets . . . 2,816,693 ;£■! 13,764,098 NATIONAL BANK OF BELGIUM— ^fl/a«« Sheet, December ^ist, 1901. Francs converted as 25=;^!. Liabilities. Capital paid-up Reserve Fund Notes in circulation Current Accounts . Stamp Duty, Share of Profits due to the Government, Employes' Superannuation, Provident Funds, Dividend due, etc. £ 2,000,000 1,144,698 25.973.213 3,580,553 607.354 ;f33.305.8i8 Assets. Specie and Bullion Bills discounted Securities due for Collection Advances on Government Secur- ities . ... Government and Reserve Fund Securities Securities for Current Accounts,etc. £ 4,646,127 19. 131.747 2,840,784 2,210,826 3,121,480 1.354,854 ;^33,305.8i8 Note. hWper contra entries, as those of the notes of the Banks held by themselves, etc., are omitted so as to show the real position of the accounts. 2o8 REMARKS ON THE RATE OF DISCOUNT [ch. xx The particulars are as follows : — Bank of England, 1844 TO 1900. Days. 4 per cent. for . . . 2,698 4i • • 481 5 . 2,012 5>i9i Bank of France, 1844 TO 1900. Days. 4 per cent. for . • 4.516 4i . . 353 5 ' • * . 2,061 6,930 Bank of Germany, 1844 TO 1900. Days. 4 per cent. for . ■ 11,077 4j . • 1,439 5 ' ■ 3,648 16,164 Bank of Holland, 1844 TO 1900. Days. 4 per cent. for . . 2,104 4i • . 651 S ' • 1,399 4,154 Bank of Belgium, 1851 TO 1900. Days. 4 per cent. for . . • 3,017 4i . . 643 5 • • 681 4,341 To make this point thoroughly clear, a summary statement, marked Table 41, p. 209, is added, showing the number of days at each rate, arranged from the lowest rate charged to the highest, for each of the five banks. It appears from this table that comparatively high rates were charged for the longest time in Germany; the next longest in France ; the next longest in England ; the next longest in Belgium ; and for the shortest time in Holland. But if the rate never fell below 3^ per cent, in Berlin between 1844 and 1875, it never rose above 9 per cent., and, indeed, stood at that high point for sixty-three days only during the period under consideration, that is for a very inconsiderable fraction of the whole time. The average of the rate, however, charged CH. xx] DAYS AT EACH RATE, THE FIVE BANKS COMPARED 209 in Berlin has been higher than at London or Paris, in Holland or in Belgium. The figures are — England (1845-1900) France ( „ ) Germany ( „ ) Holland ( „ ) Belgium (1851-1900) £ s. 3 12 3 II 4 5 3 6 3 8 Shown in averages of ten years the statement Table 42, p. 210, points out that on average, from 1875 onwards, the rate of discount has been lower for the last five-and-twenty years in Paris than in London. For the remaining variations in the rate readers should look to Table 36, pp. 192, 193, in which all the variations of the rate at each of the five banks are summarised, to all the other tables there referred to, and to Table 45, p. 216. There have been at Berlin as well as at Paris, in Holland, and in Belgium some years in which the rate of discount never varied at all, and there have been two years, though only two, at the Bank of England in which a similar occurrence took place, see Table 43, p. 211. TABLE 41. Rate of Discount, Banks of England, France, Germany, and Holland, 1844-1900, and Belgium, 1851-1900. The Number of Days at each Rate, arranged from the Lowest Rate to the Highest, and the Proportion per milh at each Rate Bank of England. Bank of France. Bank of Germany. Bank of Holland. Bank of Belgium.* Rate Number Number Number Number Number Number Number Number Number Number J"" of Days, of Days of Days, of Days of Days, of Days of Days, of Days of Days, of Days Cent. 20,570. = 1,000. 20,570. = IOOO. 20,570 = 1,000. 20,570. = 1,000. 18,262. = 1,000. 2 2J 2i 3,409 28 166 2,027 gS 1,328 63 2,997 146 2,579 "126 ... ... 4,737 230 3,169 '74 3 4,907 ^39 5,557 270 2,640 I2g 6,443 3'3 7,454 408 3i 1,739 84. 1.81S 88 178 9 3,030 147 2,426 '3' 4 2,698 13' 4,516 221 11,077 S40 2,104 102 3,017 '(>3 44 481 2? 353 n 1,439 70 651 32 643 35 5 2,012 98 2,061 100 3,648 177 1,399 68 681 37 6i 2S9 13 120 6 430 21 367 18 372 21 6 868 43 1,170 57 730 33 226 II 473 26 6i 91 4 8 50 2 150 7 ... 7 577 28 286 14 234 II 13s 7 27 a 7i 21 I 44 2 8 268 '3 41 2 37 I ... 9 9S 3 16 63 3 10 141 7 ... 20,570 1,000 20,570 1,000 20,570 1,000 20,570 1,000 18,262 1,000 * From 1851 to 1900. 210 REMARKS ON THE RATE OF DISCOUNT [ch. xx It will be observed from Table 43, p. 211, that there was one year alone in which all the five banks coincided in making no alteration in the rate charged, and that was in 185 1. It is an entirely fortuitous coincidence that in the period under consider- ation — Bank of Belgium, 1851-1900 (see p. 188) ; Bank of Holland, 1845- 1900 (see p. 179) — the number of changes has been the same — 173 at both banks. It will assist us in under- standing the variations in the rate to compare the number of fluctuations at the different banks during the last ten years under notice. Number of Variations in the Rates of Discount, 1891 to 1900. 1891 to 1900 Total amount of varia- tions from 1844 to 1900 Bank of England. 55 •• Bank of Bank of France. Germany. 9 ... 36 .. Ill 400 * 1851 to 1900. 116 Bank of Holland. 23 ... 173 ••• Bank of Belgium.^ 173 The rate charged by the Bank of France has remained almost uniformly low during the last ten years. This tendency to greater variations in intensity, and to a greater number of fluctuations, must be expected to increase as commerce extends, and as business transactions in different countries not only become more numerous, but more closely connected. As is well known, the amount of foreign money employed in the London money market has increased greatly TABLE 42. Average Minimum Rate of Discount charged by the Banks of England, France, Germany, and Holland for the years 1845-1900, and Belgium for the years 1851-1900, showing Average for the groups of ten years 1845-54 (Belgium, 1851-54), 1855-64, 1865-74, 1875-64, 1885-94, and for six years 1895-1900, and for the vtrhole period, 1845-1900 (Belgium, 1851-1900). lis m lid V 4J ^Ir llg Years. Bank of England. Bank of France. 0^ lis Bank of Germany. III Bank of Holland. Bank of Bblgium. ill i^& p< a o, „ „ 1902— Aug. nth A7S.0OO 175,000 350,000 750,000 450,000 250,000 350,000 975,000 400,000 ;f 14,000,000 4,175,000 ;f 18,175,000 Hence the amount of bank notes issued may be larger now than formerly, and yet the amount of gold required to be held against the notes issued may relatively be less. This has occurred on several occasions. For convenience of reference I will use the example employed earlier in this volume — the comparison between the position of the Issue Department on 2nd July, 1879, and 12th November, 1902, adding the figures of the Banking Department at both these dates, as this com- pletes the statement. The figures are : — Issue Department, znd July, 1879. Notes Issued . ;^49,022,675 Government Debt . Other Securities Gold Coin and Bullion . epartment. Government Securities . Other Securities Notes .... Gold and Silver Coin . .^11,015,100 3,984.900 34,022 67s ;^49,022,675 .^49,022,675 Proprietors' Capital Rest .... Public Deposits * . Other Deposits Seven-day and other Bills Banking D ;^i4,S53,ooo 3,171,027 7,279,300 29.957.815 293.099 ;^55,254,24i . ;^i4,48o,i46 20,024,691 19,485,810 1,263,594 ;^55,254,24I F. May, Chief Cashier. Dated July yd, 1879. * Including Exchequer, Savings Banks, Commissioners of National Debt, and Dividend Accounts. 2 24 CONCLUSION [CH. XXI Issue Department, I2tk November, 1902. Notes Issued ;f 49.339.090 ;^49. 339.090 Government Debt . Other Securities Gold Coin and Bullion Banking Department. Proprietors' Capital Rest .... Public Deposits * . Other Deposits Seven-day and other Bills ;^l4,S53,ooo 3.177.89s 8.637,637 39,264,304 136.134 ;rf 65,768,970 Government Securities Other Securities Notes Gold and Silver Coin ;f 11,015, 100 7,159.900 31,164,090 ;^49. 339.090 ;^i6,4i6,i32 26,890,956 20,278,055 2,183,827 ^^65,768,970 Dated Novemberl'ith, igQ2. J. G. Nairnb, Chief Cashier. * Including Exchequer, Savings Banks, Commissioners of National Debt, and Dividend Accounts. The notes issued July 2nd, 1879, were ;^49,022,675. They were balanced by : — Gold .... ;^34,022,675 Securities . . . 15,000,000 ;^49.o22,67S They were divided thus: — ;f29,S36,865 in the hands of the public. 19,485,810 held by the Bank. ;^49,022,67S The notes issued November 12th, 1902, were ;^49,339,090. They were balanced by : — Gold . Securities They were divided thus : — ;^3i, 164,090 18,175,000 ;^49.339.090 ;£^29,o6i,o35 in the hands of the public. 20,278,055 held by the Bank. A9.339.090 To recapitulate : — Notes issued July 2nd, 1879 ,, Nov. 1 2th, 1902 Notes issued in 1902 more Gold less ;f49,022,675 49.339.090 316,415 2,858,585 ;^3, 175,000 Gold July 2nd, 1879 ,, Nov. I2th, 1902 Gold /ess in 1902 . Securities more in 1902 as com pared with 1879 . ;^34,022,67S 31,164,090 2,858,585 ;f 3, 175,000 This statement shows what the effect of the working of Clause V. of the Act of 1844 was on the Issue Department at the two dates referred to. The notes issued were in November, 1902, ;^3i6,4i5 more than in July, 1879, but the gold held against the notes was ;^2, 858,585 less. To consider these matters fully would lead me beyond the limits of the subject to which these pages are devoted. It is sufficient here to call CH. xxi] ADEQUATE RESERVE A SOURCE OF STRENGTH 225 attention to the amount of the specie held on the two occasions mentioned above. It cannot be expected that the duty of maintaining an adequate reserve to meet the requirements of all the banks of the country could be accepted by the Bank of England alone, yet the tendency of business is to leave no unemployed money outside the Bank of England. To meet ordinary risks a larger supply of unused money is much wanted. It would also undoubtedly tend to more equable rates, and this would be of great advantage to the commerce of the country. Competition in business between this country and the leading countries of Europe is now exceedingly severe, and the advan- tage in the way of discounts which a trader may often obtain abroad might be quite sufficient of itself to turn the scale against his English competitor. What is stated in Chapter XX. p. 203 shows this clearly. Yet we do not seem nearer to the attainment of a really sufficient reserve now than we were when the Bank Act of 1844 was passed. To provide a compulsory amount of reserve by legal enactment would be unadvisable, but the object desired might be secured if an agreement on the subject could be attained by the principal banks of the country. It is not, in any time of pressure, the amount of capital in the country which is taken into account, or which governs the immediate price of money. It is not the amount of coin or of notes in circulation. It is the actual amount of specie reserve in hand, and the power of meeting and neutralising the effect of the foreign exchanges, when unfavourable, which decide the stability of the money market. Many exceptional causes, it will be said, have led to the recent fluctuations in the money market — to the vast number of changes in the rate of interest in recent years. But with the immensely extended commerce now carried on by this country, such causes, or similar causes, will be certain continually to manifest them- selves, and the only safe course is to be prepared to meet them. To do this we must be prepared to increase the amount of " unused " capital in the country, now so exceedingly and unduly small. To arrange this will require time, and an agreement between Q 226 CONCLUSION [ch. xxi the principal banks. I trust that the analysis of the trans- actions of the Bank of England and of the principal Banks of Europe which this work contains will be of service by showing clearly what is needed. In banking, the only secure position is that of strength, and that strength is connected most closely with the maintenance of an adequate reserve. It is to the development of such a reserve that the energy of the Bankers of the United Kingdom should now be directed. INDEX Headings in small capitals, as The Autumnal Dkain, im/,ly that the iiihole, or considerable part of a chapter, is devoted to the subject so indicated Accounts of the Bank of England— jm Eng- land^ Bank of. Acts, Bank— j«e England, Bank of; Ger- many, Bank of; Holland, Bank of. Aldenham, Lord, on Bankers' Balances — see Bankers' Balances, England, Bank of. Autumn, season of great business activity, 107 ; Rate of Discount high during, 139. Autumnal Drain of Specie and the Reserve, 41-42 ; influence on Bank of England Note Circulation, 72; causes of, 107-108; The Autumnal Drain, 138-139; 1881-1900, Table 20, 138 ; influence of Bank Acts, 1844-S, o", through Scotch and Irish issues, 139 ; connection with Bank of England Rate of Discount, 139, 198, 219. Bagehot, Mr., his remarks on constitution of Governing Body of Bank of England, 58. Bank of Belgium— J^e Belgium, Bank of. Bank of England— j«« England, Bank of. Bank of France — see France, Bank of. Bank of Germany, The Imperial — see Germany, The Imperial Bank of. Bank of Holland— j-eu Holland, Bank of. Bankers, London, Joint Committee of, and of Bank of England could fix rate of dis- count, 61-62. Banking, recent development in Europe and America, 9 ; in France and in England, difference between, 148-149 ; compared with banking in Germany, 160-161, 162, 164 ; business of the country, great increase in, 218. Banks, Foreign, practice of re-discounting by, 52; returns of, do not show exceptional demand in May and November, 1 10 ; seasons of greatest business activity shown by returns of Rate of Discount at, 135 ; fluidity of resources of, 200 ; see also France, Germany, Holland, and Belgium, Banks of. Ireland, capital, proportion to deposits, 19. Joint Stock (Metropolitan), effect of ad- mission to London Bankers' Clearing House on Bank of England Note Cir- culation and on Bankers' Balances, 22 ; development of Bill-broking, effect of action of, 53 ; undertook, 1877, inde- pendent course of action with regard to Bank of England Rate of Discount, 55 ; see also Banks, Private and Joint Stock, and Banks, United Kingdom. Banks, New York Associated, publish average weekly amount of reserves, 63. Private and Joint Stock, Accounts of, pub- lication generally recent, 7 ; Capitals and Resources, estimates of, 1872-1901, and Reserve of Bank of England, 104 ; ditto, made by Mr. Newmarch, 1851, and other estimates, 1902, 220; see also Joint Stock Banks and Banks of United Kingdom ; Note Circulation of, see Note Circulation, English Country. Scotland, capital, proportion to deposits, 19. United Kingdom, capital, proportion to deposits, 19; Bankers' Balances at the Bank of England, the ultimate reserve of all, 39 ; practice of loaning out re- serves of banks peculiar to this country, 39 ; capital and deposits of other banks, and reserve of Bank of England, 1872- 1901, 104; increase of deposits at, and also throughout the world, 220 ; influence on reserve, 220 ; see also Joint Stock Banks. Baring Crisis, the, 1890, effect of, doubt- less, on Bankers' Balances, 26 ; assistance given by Bank of France, 148, 152 ; see also Panic, 1890. Belgium, Bank of: established 1850, 181 ; management, system of, 181-182 ; trade of the country and, 184. Balance Sheet, compared with those of other Banks, Table 40, 207. Bills and Commercial Paper, Business in, 182 ; amounts of, discounted, 183-184 ; foreign, 185 ; total operations in discounts, 185, 201. Branch (Antwerp) and Discount Offices, 182, 183 ; Country Discount Offices, separate partnerships, 183. Capital, compared with Bank of England and other European Banks, 200. Deposits, Public, compared with Bank of England and other European Banks, 201. Liabilities, Proportion of Specie to, 84. Note Circulation, Specie held against, and against other obligations, 184 ; average fiduciary, 185 ; compared with Bank of England and other European Banks, 201. Rate of Discount, Monthly Averages of, compared with Banks of England, France, Germany, and Holland, and with London Bankers' Clearing House Returns, 136; influence of autumnal movement in gold shown in returns, 139 ; compared with Bank of Germany, 171 ; Variations in. 227 228 INDEX 1851-1900, 181-189; compared with other European Banks, 184, 186; low rates prevalent, 185 ; small number of rates charged, 186 ; Monthly Averages of Minimum, 1851-1900, Table 33, 187 ; number of days at each rate, and of changes in each year, 1851-1900, Table 34, 188 ; Number of days at each rate, arranged from highest number to smallest and from lowest to highest rate, 1851-1900, Table 35, 189; Summary of fluctuations, together with those of other returns, 1851-1900, Table 36, 193 ; Number of variations in, compared with Bank of England and other European Banks, 1851-1900, Table 37, 196; Lowest and highest charged and extent of fluctuation compared with Bank of England and other European Banks, 1851-1900, Table 38, 197 ; Number and extent of Annual Fluctuations in, compared with Bank of England and other European Banks, 1851-1900, Table 39, igS ; Low rates, compared with Bank of England and other European Banks, 1851-1900, 204; Intermediate rates, compared with Bank of England and other European Banks, 1851-1900, 205 ; High rates, compared with Bank of England and other Banks, 1851-1900, 208; Number of days at each rate, compared with Bank of England and other Banks, Table 41, 1851-1900, 209; Number of variations, 1891-1900 and 1851-1900, compared with Bank of England and other Banks, 210 ; Average minimum rate charged by, com- pared with Bank of England and with other Banks, in groups of years, 1851-1900, Table 42, 210; Years in which no change took place, compared with Bank of Eng- land and with other Banks, 1851-1900, Table 43, 21 1 ; Monthly averages, com- pared with Bank of England and other Banks, and with the returns of London Bankers' Clearing House, Table 45, 216. Belgium, Bank of : Securities, Composition of, compared with Bank of England and other Banks, 201. Specie, Proportion of, to Liabilities, 84 ; reserve of, comparatively small, 184 ; and Bullion, compared with Bank of England and other European Banks, 201. Bill brokers. Bank decided to make advances to, 1878, 51 ; arrangements made by the Bank with, 1890 and subsequently, 51 ! methods followed in England, unfavourable to quiet working of money market, ^2 ; development of, effect of action of bankers, S3 ; work without a Reserve, effect of, on Bank of England, 54. Bill discounters turn to Bank in time of pressure, 67. Bills, difference between bills and mortgages, 29 ; fewer, great competition for, 54 ; not increased in proportion to business generally, 66 ; in circulation, estimates of, by Mr. Newmarch, and other estimates, 66 ; see also England, Bank of. Bills discounted. Bills, English, held abroad, advantages and dangers of, 212-213. Bills, Foreign, few or none held in England, 212 ; see France, Germany, Holland, and Belgium, Banks of. Bullion held by Bank of England — see Eng- land, Bank of, Bullion. Business, extension in, generally, during the last fifty-six years, 7 ; autumn, season of greatest activity in, 107 ; influence of periodic increase of Scotch circulation on, 107-109 ; activity in the country. Clearing House returns a guide to, 132 ; seasons of greatest activity in, shown by fluctuations in Bank of England rate of discount, in Clearing House returns, and in those of rate of discount at Foreign Banks, 135 : bank- ing, of the country, great increase in, 218. Capital, loanable, greater growth of, in pro- portion to reserve, one cause of liability to fluctuation in value of money, 103 ; loanable, growth of, outside the Bank greater than that held by the Bank, 104 ; loan- able, large supply of, essential to trade, 2x6. Capital, Banks of United Kingdom — see Banks, United Kingdom. Capital, English, abroad, 212, 214-215. Capital and Deposits of other English Banks and Reserve — see Banks, United Kingdom. Capital of Bank of England — see England, Bank of, Capital. Cheques, recognised medium for business payments in England, 162. Chinese Loan, 1895-6, 18. Clearing House, London Bankers', effect of admission of Joint Stock Banks to, on Bank of England Note Circulation and on Bankers' Balances, 22 ; returns show no exceptional demand in May and November, 110; Returns of, 132-137; returns of, guide to business activity in the country, 1 32, 135 ; Returns, Monthly Averages, 1868-1900, Table 18, 133; variations in, compared with those of Rate of Discount, 134; Total Annual Returns, 1868-1900, 134; Monthly Rate of Discount at Banks of England, France, Germany, Holland, and Belgium, compared with Returns of, 1 36 ; Returns of, compared with Exports and Imports, and with Bank Note Circulation, 1861-1900, Table ig, 137 ; Summary of fluctuations in returns of, together with those in other returns, 1868-1900, Table 36, 193 ; fluctua- tions in returns of, represent business move- ments, 194 ; returns of, compared with Monthly Averages of Rate of Discount charged at Bank of England and at other European Banks, 1845-1900, Table 45, 216. Crises, Fixed Note Issue intensifies, 163 ; see also Baring Crisis, 1890 ; Panics, 1847, 1857, 1866, 1890. Demands for Specie — see Autumnal Drain ; Scotch and Irish Note Circulation. Deposits, Bank of England — see England, Bank of. Deposits. Deposits of other English Banks — see Banks, United Kingdom. INDEX 229 Discount, Rate ot—see England, Bank of, Rate of Discount ; also under France, Germany, Holland, and Belgium, Banks of. European Baxiks—see Banks, Foreign ; and France, Germany, Holland, and Belgium, Banks of. England, Bank of : Accounts, Principal Divisions OF, 16-32; example of Weekly Return, Bankers' Balances deducted from both sides, 38 ; division, effect of, 81 ; division of, 84, 198, 200; Table 40, 206- 207. Analysis of transactions, an index to finan- cial events, 8. Annual Averages of Transactions, Table 3, 1844-1900, 11-15. Balance Sheet, example of Weekly Return, Bankers' Balances deducted from both sides, 38 ; compared with other European Banks, 200-202 ; Table 40, 206-207 5 compared, 1879 and 1902 (issue against securities), 223, 224 ; see also Accounts of the Bank of England and Weekly Returns. Bank Acts of 1844-45, influence, working, 8 ; regulation of, as to Bullion at the Bank, 30 ; influence of Scotch and Irish Note Circulation on Reserve through power of issuing notes against gold, 41 ; designed to suppress English Country Note Circulation, 74 ; Effect of, as to Division of Accounts, 81 ; Act (12th December, 1857) to Indemnify Bank of England for excess issue over limit allowed in 1844, 91-93 ; Scotch and Irish Note Circulation and Acts of 1845, 112 ; Dr. Charles Gairdner on influence exercised by, on Scotch and Irish Note Circulation, 113-115; clauses in, regulating specie held against excess issue, Scotland and Ireland, 116-117; in- fluence of, on Rate of Discount through Reserve, 135; Autumnal Drain enhanced through demand caused by Scotch and Irish Issues, 139 ; limit of Note Circula- tion fixed by, 163 ; Act suspended, 1857, 164 ; permission to suspend granted, 1847, 1857, 1866, 164; plan for modification proposed by Lord Sherbrooke (Mr. Lowe), 1873, 172 ; division of resources of Bank into two parts by, causing demand to fall on smaller, 198 ; composition of reserve altered by, 198, 223 ; regulations as to purchase of gold, 199 ; increase of securities in Issue Department caused by, 220 ; clauses of, sanctioning this, 221-223. Bank Post Bills, decrease in these, 19 ; Total Deposits and, 17-19; deposits, and pro- portion of Coin and Bullion to, 31, 76 ; see also Liabilities. Bankers' Balances, increase in, larger than any other branch of business of the Bank, 1844-1877, 18 ; liable to be drawn on in times of pressure, 20; proportion to Reserve, 1844-1877, 20; Averages of, 20-22 ; increased more rapidly than Reserve, 21 ; amount of Reserve largely maintained by, 21 ; effect of admission of Joint Stock Banks to London Bankers' Clearing House on, 22 ; and the Reserve, 23-27; represent "Till money" rather than Reserve, 23 ; included in Total Deposits, 24 ; during panics of 1857, 1866, 24 ; of 1875, 25 ; influence of panics on amount of, 25 ; effect of stop- page of Bank of Glasgow, 1878, doubt- less on, 25-26 ; similar effect of Baring Crisis, i8go, 26; London Bankers' Balances with the Bank of Eng- land, 34-43 ; Annual Averages, Table 5, 1844-1877, 35; in times of Pressure, 1857, 1866, 1877, 36; sometimes larger than Reserve, 36, 37 ; increase of, a natural growth of business, 37 ; example of pro- portion of Reserve to liabilities, after deducting Bankers' Balances from both sides, 38 ; cannot be Reserve both of Bank of England and of other Banks, 39 ; ultimate Reserve of all the Banks in the Kingdom, 39 ; practice of loaning out Reserves of Banks peculiar to this country, 39 ; included among Bank of England Liabilities, 39; How far they form an efficient Reserve, 44-47 ; Mr. H. H. Gibbs (Lord Aldenham) on, 44 - 45 ; normal and abnormal, 45 ; portions really and nominally "Reserve," 45; portion nominally Reserve, only "Till money," 45-46; portion of, at Bank of England, only for " Safe Custody," 45, 46 ; propor- tion to Reserve in times of panic, 1847, 1857, 1866,89; proportion of, to Reserve, and Rate of interest, 1847-1878, 90; periodic fluctuations, 217. England, Bank of: Bills discounted, amount of, in times of pressure, 1844-75, 28 ; influence of Rate of Interest on amount of, 28 ; proportion of, to total securities, 28 ; AND Temporary Advances, 64- 68; amount of, 1844-1875, 65-66; pro- portion to ' ' other " securities, 66-67 j amount in circulation, 1873-1902, 66. Bullion, position of Bank of England with regard to gold bullion imported into the country, 30 ; what takes place when brought into the country, 30 ; see also Gold. Bullion, Coin and, held by the Bank, Average of, 30-31 ; proportion of, to Liabilities, 31, 76; proportion of, to Notes held by the Public, 31 ; consider- able increase in, 76 ; connection with Bank Rate not easy to trace, 76 ; pro- portion to Liabilities and Note Cir- culation, 78 ; proportion of, to Total Liabilities, strength of Bank depends on this, 78 ; compared with that held by other European Banks, 200-201 ; demands on, through movements in Scotch and Irish Note Circulation, influence on Rate of Discount, 219. Bullion, Coin and, held in Issue Depart- ment — see Issue Department. Bullion, silver — see Issue Department. Business, Private, conducted like any other bank, 68. Capital, paid-up, largest of any known bank, 17 ; amount of, including rest, 64 ; proportion to deposits, 19 ; large amount of, compared with other European banks, 200, 230 INDEX England, Bank of: Deposits, Chancery Balances included with Government, since 1873, lo note ; Total, and Bank Post Bills, 17-19; Private, largest increase in these, 18 ; Public, 18 ; pro- portion to capital, 19 ; Total, Bankers' Balances included in, 24; "other" De- posits, increase in 1875, 1878, 25-26; Uniformity of rate for, and for discounts, advisable, 61-62 ; of Bank, Mr. Thomson Hankey on investment of, 65 ; Public, held, compared with those held by other European Banks, 201 ; see also Liabilities. Directors, opinion of, as to fixing rate valuable, 57. Governing Body of the Bank, Constitution of, 58 - 60 ; Mr. Bagehot's remarks thereon, 58 ; Parliamentary Reports, 1848, remarks therein, 58-60. Governor, permanent, desirable, 57 ! r^" commended in Parliamentary Report, 1848, 60. Government Securities— J«« Securities. Issue Department, Notes Issued, Specie AND Securities in the, 17 ; Increase in gold and notes issued, 31 ; proportion of notes issued against bullion and securities, 32 ; Note Circulation Bank of England, Country Note Circula- tion, AND Coin and Bullion in the, 69-80 ; Monthly Averages of, bullion in the, 1845-1900, Table 7, 71 ; Silver bullion held in, 78 ; Silver bullion held, discussed in connection with Indian ex- changes, 79; Silver bullion held, 1844-53, and gold coin and bullion and silver bullion held, 1860-61, Table 10, 80; Gold bullion held in the, during panics, 1847, 1857, 1866, and 1890, 89-90; Summary of fluctuations in bullion in the, together with those of other returns, 1845-1900, Table 36, 193 ; division of, from Banking Department in accounts, 198 ; Gold bullion in, 199 ; Securities in, increase caused by Bank Act, 1844, 220 ; clauses sanctioning this, 22 1-223 > gold held sometimes less, while amount of notes issued greater, returns showing this, 1879, 1902, 223-224. Liabilities, Total, 19 ; increase in, 19 ; proportion of Reserve to, smaller in recent years, 20 ; proportion of Reserve to, 1846-1877, 24 ; proportion of buUion held by Bank to, 31, 76 ; example of proportion to Reserve after deducting Bankers' Balances, 38 : Bankers' Balances included among, 39-41 ; proportion of bullion held by Bank to Total, strength of Bank depends on this, 78 ; The Reserve AND, 81-94 ; Reserve and, main point to consider, 81-84 ; Monthly averages of Reserve and, 1845-1900, Table II, 82-83 > proportion of Reserve to, 84, 86 ; proportion of Reserve to, connected with fluctuations in Rate of Discount, 86-87 ; proportion of Reserve to, in crises, 1847, 1857, 1866, 89 ; proportion of Reserve to, and Rate of Interest, 1844-1878, 90; Summary of fluctuations in, together with those of other Banks, etc., 1845-1900, Table 36, 193 ; proportion of Reserve to, influence on Rate of Discount, 219. England, Bank of: Management, continuity in, needed, 58. Note Circulation, connected with Reserve, 8 ; " Notes issued," how entered in. Table 3, 10 note; "Notes Issued," Specie and Securities in Issue De- partment, 17 ; Annual Averages of, 22-23 > effect of admission of Joint Stock Banks to London Bankers' Clear- ing House on, 22 ; increase of, in the provinces, 1844-1875, 22 ; proportion of notes to bullion in Issue Department, 31-32; Bullion held IN the Issue De- PARTMEtjT; English Country Note Circulation, 69-80; Monthly Averages of, 1 845-1 900, Table 6, 70 ; influence of Autumnal Drain, 72 ; increase, 72 ; in London and in the provinces, 72 ; may take place of lapsed country note issues, 72, 74 ; and metallic circulation, 72-73 ; diminution, 1879-1885, increase, 1894-1900, 73 ; analysis of notes com- posing, 74, 76 ; Composition of, 1856- 1876, Table 9, 77 ; proportion of buUion held by Bank to, 78 ; text of Bill pro- posed by Lord Sherbrooke (Mr. Lowe) to allow excess issue, 1873, 93-94; com- pared with Clearing House Returns and with exports and imports, 1861-1900, Table 19, 137 ; compared with Note Circulation in Germany, 162-164, 166 ; fixed by Bank Act, 1844, 163 ; fixed issue intensifies crises, 163 ; Bank Act, 1844, fixing limit of issue, suspended, 1857, 164; permission to suspend granted, 1847, 1857, 1866, 164 ; fixed amount, 166 ; notes "issued" form part of Reserve, 166; proposal to adopt tax on excess issue, as in Germany, 172 ; requirements in Eng- land different to those in Germany, 172 ; Lord Sherbrooke's plan for modification of Bank Act of 1844, 1873, 172; Treasury shares profits of issue, 172; Summary of fluctuations in, together with those of other returns, 1845-1900, Table 36, 192; amount of, compared with other European Banks, 201 ; Clauses of Act regulating issue of Bank Notes, 221-223 ; fixed issue, increase of, 1844-1902, 223 ; amount of notes issued greater, while gold held less, returns showing this, 1879, 1902, 223- 224 ; see also Note Issue. Note Issue, legal impediments to extension of, 88 ; advantage of moderate rate for excess issue, 88 ; Act to indemnify Bank of England for excess issue over limit allowed in Bank Act, 1844, 12th Decem- ber, 1857, 91-93 ; see also Note Circula- tion. Notes, Reserve of, represents greater part of gold at command of Bank, 84; amount necessarily smaller than coin and bullion held, 84 ; during panics, 1847, 1857, 1866, and 1890, 89, 90; see Re- serve. Policy of, distinct statement needed, 61. Railway Debentures held by — see Securi- ties. INDEX 231 England, Bank of: Rate of Discount (Rate of Interest), influence of, on amount of bills discounted, 28 ; Average, 32 ; and Marlcet Rate, divergence between, 32 ; Table 4, 1 845-1 900, shows this, 33; fixing Rate of Discount and protection of Reserve should be in same hands, 47, 62; The Pub- lished Rate, 48-54 ; Bank announced, 1878, that it did not feel bound to adhere as closely as formerly to a fixed Minimum Rate, 48-5 1 ; information as to this. Parliamentary Reports, 1847-8, 1848, 48-49 ; down to 1839, 49 ; marlcet value of money considerably below Bank in 1844, 49 ; Rate between 1839-1844, 49; "new system of discounting," 1844, 49; Bank adapted its own Rate to Market Rate, 1844, 49; effect of this down to 1848, so ; Lord Overstone (Mr. Samuel Jones Lloyd) on the Bank Rate, SO ; position of Bank to outside market fifty years ago, 50; Bank Rate and Market Rate in 1857, 1858, 50-51 ; drawbacks to published, fixed, 51 ; action of Bank helpful to Bill-brokers, 51-54 [see Bill-brokers); The Published, AND THE Reserve, 55-63 ; not so clear a guide to Market Rate as formerly, 55-56 ; Metropolitan Joint Stock Banks, in 1877, undertook independent course of action with regard to, 55 ; Bank of England no longer bound by its own, 56 ; frequent changes in, 57 ; value of opinion of Bank directors as to fixing, 57 J standard rate for discount needed, 61 ; joint committee. Bank and London Bankers, could fix, 61-62 ; advantages of such an arrangement, 61-62 ; uniformity of rate allowed on deposits advisable, 61 ; influence of Bank on, less than formerly, 67 ; not easy to trace con- nection of bullion held by the Bank with, 76 ; variations in, 85, 86 ; mean of ex- treme variations in, 86, 87 ; greatest fluctuation, in each decade, 87 ; difference between highest and lowest month, 87 ; proportion of Reserve to Liabilities con- nected with fluctuations in, 86-87 > average for each month, 1845-1900, 88 ; advan- tages of moderate, for excess Note Issue, 88; during panics, 1847, 1857, 1 866, and 1890, 89-90; low reserve accompanies high rate of interest, 90 ; proportion of Reserve to Liabilities and Bankers' Balances to Reserve, 1844, 1847-1878, 89-90 ; Variations in, 1844-1900, 95- 105 ; valuable index to fluctuations in the Money Market, 95 ; description of tables explaining, 96; Monthly Averages of Minimum, 1845-1900, Table 12, 97 ; Number of days at each rate and num- ber of changes in each year, 1844-1900, Table 13, 98-99; Number of days at each rate, arranged from highest number to smallest, and fi-om lowest rate to highest. Table 14, too ; details of varia- tions in, 96, 101-102 ; fewer high rates than previously from 1873-1900, 102- 103; low rates, 1891-1897, 103; and market rate, harmony between, 104 ; Some of the Causes which in- fluence, 106-111 ; Reserve, relation of, to, 106 ; tendency to lower rates in last thirty-six years, 106; influenceof autumnal demand and of Scotch and Irish Note Circulation on, 107-110 ; pressure on Bank in May and November, marked in, 1 10 ; Monthly Averages of, with those of Scotch and Irish Note Circulation and specie held, arranged from smallest to largest figures, 1845- 1900, Table 17, 124- 131 ; returns of, compared with those of London Bankers' Clearing House, 134 ; seasons of greatest business activity shown ty, 135 ; influenced by Bank Acts, 1844- 1845, through the Reserve, 135; Monthly average compared with that at Banks of France, Germany, Holland, and Belgium, and with Clearing House Returns, 136; connection of Autumnal Drain with, 139; high in autumn months, 139 ; no guide to Market Rate previous to 1844, 140 ; compared with that of France, 150- 152 ; compared with that of France in years of panic, 1847, 1857, 1866, 1890, 152 ; number of changes compared with those of Bank of Germany, 160, 171 ; proposal for mitigating fluctuations in, 172; injurious effect of high, on industrial prosperity, 173 ; compared with that at Bank of Holland, 177 ; at Bank of Belgium, 184, 186 ; FLUCTUATIONS IN, COMPARED WITH OTHER BUSINESS Fluctuations, 190-202 ; variations comparatively severe since 1845-54, 191 ; compared with those at other European Banks, 191-195 ; Summary of fluctua- tions in, together with those of other returns, 1845-1900, Table 36, 192 ; fluctuations in, more extreme than at other European Banks, 195 ; disadvan- tages of high range of fluctuation, 195 ; causes of severe fluctuation, 195-199 ; demands for specie, a cause, 195, 198 ; Number of variations compared with other European Banks, 1845-1900, Table 37i 196 ; Lowest and highest charged, and extent of fluctuation, compared with other European Banks, 1844-1900, Table 38, 197 ; Number and extent of fluctua- tions, compared with other European Banks, 1844-1900, Table 39, 198 ; and Autumnal Drain, 198 ; extent of fluctua- tions connected with want of fluidity of assets, 199; Some remarks on, at the Bank of England and at other European Banks, 203-216; compared with other European Banks, 203 ; low rates conipared with other European Banks, 1844-1900, 204; intermediate rates compared with other European Banks, 1844-1900, 205 ; high rates com- pared with other European Banks, 1844-1900, 208 ; Number of days at each rate compared with other European Banks, 1844-1900, Table 41, 209 ; Num- ber of variations, 1891-1900 and 1844- 1900, compared with other Banks, 210; Average minimum rate charged by, com- pared with other European Banks, in 232 INDEX groups of years, 1845-1900, Table 42, 210; Years in which no change took place, 1 845- 1900, compared withotherBanks,Table43, 211 ; greater uniformity secured by larger Reserve, 215-216; Monthly Averages, compared with other European Banks and with returns of London Bankers' Clearing House, 1845-1900, Table 45, 216 ; rela- tion of Reserve to, 218 ; influenced by foreign exchanges, 219 ; influenced by discounts at home, specie for export, proportion of Reserve to Liabilities, demands on bullion made through Scotch and Irish Note Circulation, and the Autumnal Drain, 219 ; variations, fre- quent and rapid, 219. England, Bank of: Rate of Interest — see Rate of Discount. Reserve, Note Circulation connected with, 8, 23 ; Scotch and Irish Note Circulation also connected with, 8, 41-42; The Average, 19-20 ; increase in, 19-20 ; proportion of, to Liabilities, smaller in recent years, 20, 41 ; alterations in char- acter of demands on, 20 ; proportion of Bankers' Balances to, 1844-1877, 20, 41; Bankers' Balances, proportion of, to the, 21 ; Bankers' Balances and the, 23- 27; Bankers' Balances represent "Till Money " rather than, 23 ; proportion of, to Liabilities, 1846-1877, 23-24; diminu- tion of, during panic, 1866, 25 ; amounts in panic, 1875, 25 ; in 1878 and 1890, 26; amount during panics, 1857, 1866, 1875, 36 ; Bankers' Balances sometimes larger than, 36-37 ; example of proportion of, to Liabilities after deducting Bankers' Bal- ances, 38 ; Bankers' Balances cannot be Reserve both of other Banks and of Bank of England, 39 ; proportion of, to Liabili- ties, Bankers' Balances being deducted, 41 ; all demands centre on, 41 ; Autumnal Drain, 41-42 ; influence of Bank Acts, 1844-184S, 41 ; HOW FAR Bankers' Bal- ances FORM AN EFFICIENT, 44-47; por- tion of normal and abnormal Bankers' Balances really and nominally " Reserve," 45 ; portion of Bankers' Balances only " Till Money," 45-46 ; protection of, and fixing Rate of Discount, should be in same hands, 47, 62 ; demands on, in- creased by suppression of English Country Note Circulation, 74 ; AND Liabilities, 81-94 > ^nd Liabilities, main point to consider, 81-84; and Liabilities, Monthly Averages of, 1845-1900, Table 11, 82- 83 ; proportion of, to Liabilities, 84-86 ; proportion of, to Liabilities, connected with fluctuations in the Rate of Dis- count, 86-88 ; proportion of, to Liabilities, during Crises, 1847, 1857, 1866, 89 ; High Rate of Interest accompanied by low Reserve, 90 ; proportion of, to Lia- bilities and Rate of Interest, 1844-1878, 90 ; proportion of Bankers' Balances to, and Rate of Interest, 1847-1878, 90; greater growth of loanable capital in pro- portion to, one cause of liability to fluctua- tion in value of money, 103 ; does not increase in proportion to demands on it, 103 ; Capital and deposits of other Banks and, 1872-1901, 104 ; Influence on Market Rate of Bank regulation of Reserve, 104 ; relation of, to rate of Interest, 106 ; the only source whence specie can be drawn for Note Circula- tion, Scotland and Ireland, 115; Bank Acts, 1844-45, influence on Rate of Dis- coiint through, 135 ; notes form part of, 166 ; Summary of fluctuations in, together with those of other returns, Table 36, 1845-1900, 193 ; division of, in accord- ance with Bank Act, 1844, 198 ; larger bullion, needed to meet sudden demands, 215-216; greater uniformity in Bank of England Rate of Discount secured by larger, 216 ; relation to Rate of Interest, 218; proportion of, to Liabilities in- fluences Rate of Interest, 219; composi- tion of, altered by Act of 1844, 220 ; influence of increase in deposits of other Banks on, 220 ; need of larger, 224-225 ; strength of Bank connected with adequate, 225. England, Bank of: Reserve of Notes— fee Notes. Rest, amount of, 17, 64. Securities, NOTES Issued, Specie and Securities in the Issue Depart- ment, 17 ; Annual Averages of the Other, 27-30 ; Government, 27 ; pro- portion of bills discounted to total, 28 ; held by the Bank of England, want of fluidity in, 29; amount of "other," in 1902, 29; divided between "Govern- ment" and "other" securities, 64; rail- way debentures held by, 1865, amount of, 65 ; proportion of bills discounted to "other" securities, 1844-1875, 66, 67; composition of, compared with those of other European Banks, 201 ; increase of, in Issue Department, caused by Act of 1844, 220; clauses of Act sanctioning this, 221-223. Specie — see Issue Department, coin and bullion held by ; see also Bullion. Specie, demands for — see Autumnal Drain, and Note Circulation, Scotch and Irish. Temporary advances, fluctuations in, 29 ; Bills Discounted and, 64-68; im- mediate wants of business indicated by, 67 ; 1844-1875, 67-68 ; fluctuations in, 68 ; in panic year, 1866, 68. Treasury Letter, November I2th, 1857, 89; compared with Bank Act (Holland) of 1884, 177. Weekly Returns, constantly studied, I ; more information formerly than now, 1-2; example of this, Table 1, 2-3 ; details in parliamentary reports, 3, 6-7 ; Table 2, 4 - 5 ; disadvantages of omissions, 6 ; example of. Bankers' Balances being deducted from both sides, 38 ; 1879 and 1902 compared (issue against securities), 223-224. Exports and Imports, compared with Clearing House Returns and with Bank Note Circulation, 1861-1900, Table 19, 137 ; excess of imports, a danger to our INDEX 233 commerce and banking system, 213-214 ; returns, 1861-1900, Table 44, 213. Fluidity, want of, in securities held by Bank of England, 29 ; extent of fluctuations in Bank of England rate, connected with want of fluidity of assets, 199 ; fluidity of resources of other European Banks, 200. Foreign Banks— j« Banks, Foreign. Foreign Exchanges, Bank of England Rate of Discount influenced by, 219. Foreign Trade of United Kingdom, 1861- 1900, Table 44, 213 ; see also Exports and Imports. France, Bank of: Organisation of, 141-143, 147-148 ; business of, method on which carried on, 147 ; Governor and Sub- Governors generally fix Rate of Discount, 147-148 ; governing body of, commercial element sometimes said to be not suffi- ciently represented in, 148 ; management of, in times of difficulty (especially in 1870, 1874-5), ^^^ and judicious, 148; other banks in France, 148, 149 ; assist- ance given to Bank of England in Baring Crisis, 1890, 148, 152 ; facilities given by, to trade of country, 149. Balance Sheet compared with Bank of Eng- land and other European Banks, Table 40, 206. Branches extend over France, 143, 147. Capital, amount of, compared with Bank of England and other European Banks, 200. Deposits, public, compared with Bank of England and other European Banks, 201. Gold and silver held, 1877-1900, Table 24, Liabilities, proportion of specie to, 81, 84. Note Circulation compared with Bank of England and other Banks, 201. Rate of Discount, Monthly Averages of, compared with Banks of England, Ger- many, Holland, and Belgium, and with London Bankers' Clearing House Returns, 1845-1900, 136 ; influence of autumnal movement of gold shown in returns of, 139; Variations in, 1844-igoo, 140- 153 ; before 1844 did not vary, 141 ; Monthly Averages of minimum, 1845- 1900, Table 21, 142 ; Number of days at each rate, and number of changes, in each year, 1844-1900, Table 22, 144- 145 ; Number of days at each rate, arranged from highest number to small- est, and from lowest rate to highest, 1 844-1900, Table 23, 146 ; generally fixed by Governor and Sub-Governors, 147-148 ; compared with Bank of Eng- land, fewer changes in, 150-152 ; with Bank of Germany, 160, 171 ; with Bank of Holland, 177; and with Bank of Belgium, 184-186 ; Summary of fluctua- tions in, together with those in other returns, 1845- 1900, Table 36, 192; Num- ber of variations in, compared with Bank of England and other European Banks, 1844-1900, Table 37, 196 ; Lowest and highest rate charged and extent of fluctua- tion in, compared with Bank of England and other European Banks, 1844-1900, Table 38, 197 ; Number and extent of fluctuations compared with those at Bank of England and other European Banks, 1844-1900, Table 39, 198 ; low rates compared with Bank of England and other European Banks, 1844- 1900, 204 ; intermediate rates compared with Bank of England and other European Banks, 1844-1900, 205 ; high rates compared with Bank of England and other European Banks, 1844-1900, 208; number of days at each rate compared with Bank of England and other European Banks, 1844-1900, Table 41, 209 ; number of variations, 1891-1900 and 1844-1900, compared with Bank of England and other European Banks, 210; Average minimum charged by each Bank compared with Bank of England and other European Banks, in groups of years, 1845-1900, Table 42, 210 ; Years in which no change took place, 1844-1900, compared with Bank of England and other European Banks, Table 43, 211 ; Monthly averages compared with Bank of England, other European Banks, and London Bankers' Clearing House Returns, 1845-1900, Table 45, 216. France, Bank of: Securities, composition of, compared with Bank of England and other European Banks, 201. Specie, proportion of, to Liabilities, 81, 84 ; and Bullion held, compared with Bank of England and other European Banks, 201. France, Banking in, and in England, differ- ences between, 148-149 ; other Banks in, besides the Bank of France, 148-149; compared with Germany, 160-161. Gairdner, Dr. Charles — see Note Circulation, Scotch. Germany, Imperial Bank of: History of, 155; founded originally, 1765, by Fred- erick II. of Prussia, 155 ; present position of, 155 ; man^ement under control of State, 158; other Banks in Germany besides the, 160. Balance Sheet compared with Bank of England and other European Banks, 207. Bank Act (Germany), 1875, 155 ; Sections 25-31, 158-159; limit of Note Issue fixed by, 162 ; requirements as to cash held against Note Circulation, 165. Bank Act (Germany), 1899, limit of Note Issue increased by, 1899, 162-163. Branches over whole of Germany, 160 ; number of, 160. Capital and Reserve compared with Bank of England and other European Banks, 200. Bills, Inland, dealt in, 161 ; discount of, most important item on credit side of account, 166 ; Inland and Foreign, large amount of, held, 167. Current Accounts (Giro Verkehr), 161 ; convenience in remitting money through- out Germany by means of, 161-162. Deposits, public, compared with those at Bank of England and other European Banks, 201. 234 INDEX Germany, Imperial Bank of: Liabilities, proportion of specie to, 84. Note Circulation, important factor in German business, 162, 164 ; reserves held against, 162-167 ; limit fixed by Bank Act of 1875, 162; increased by Bank Act, 1899, 162-163 ; authorised and excess issue, 162-164 ; tax of 5 per cent, on excess issue, 164, 166 ; compared with English Note Circulation, 162-164, 166 ; require- ments of Bank Law as to cash held against, 165 ; average cover, 165 ; in- crease of excess issue, 165 ; notes issued as required, 166 ; three limitations on note issue, 166 ; legal tender notes and gold must be held at least for one-third of notes in circulation, 167 ; Annual averages of, 1876-1900, Table 29, 169 ; dates and amounts of excess issue beyond legal limit, 1881-1900, 169-171 ; com- pared with Bank of England and other European Banks, 201. Rate of Discount, Monthly Averages of, compared with those at Banks of England, France, Holland, and Belgium, and with London Bankers' Clearing House Returns, 1845-1900, 136 ; influence of autumnal movement in gold shown in returns of, 139; Variations in, 1844-1900, 154- 173 ; Monthly Averages of minimum, 1845-1900, Table 25, 156; Number of days at each rate, and number of changes, in each year, 1844-1900, Table 26, 157 ; Number of days at each rate, arranged from highest number to smallest, and from lowest rate to highest, 1844-1900, Table 27, 158 ; rate below 3 per cent, never charged, 171 ; number of changes com- pared with Banks of England and France, 160, 171-172 ; compared with Banks of Holland and Belgium, 171 ; 4 per cent, the most usual, 171 ; compared with Bank of Holland, 177 ; compared with Bank of Belgium, 184, 186 ; Summary of fluctuations in, together with those in other returns, 1845-1900, Table 36, 192 ^ Number of variations in, compared with Bank of England and other European Banks, 1844-1900, Table 37, 196 ; Lowest and highest charged and extent of fluctua- tion during each year compared with Bank of England and other European Banks, i844-i900,Table38, 197; Number and extent of fluctuations, compared with Bank of England and other European Banks, 1844-1900, Table 39, 198; low rates compared with Bank of England and other European Banks, 1844-1900, 204 ; intermediate rates compared with Bank of England and other European Banks, 1844-1900, 205 ; high rates com- pared with Bank of England and other European Banks, 1844-1900, 208 ; Num- ber of days at each rate compared with Bank of England and other European Banks, Table 41, 1844-1900, 209; number of variations, 1891-1900 and 1844-1900, compared with Bank of England and other European Banks, 210; average minimum charged by, compared with Bank of England and other European Banks, in groups of years, 1845-1900, 210 ; Years in which no change took place, compared with Bank of England and other European Banks, 1844-1900, Table 43, 211; Monthly Averages at, compared with Bank of England and other European Banks, and with returns of London Bankers' Clearing House, Table 45, 1845-1900, 216. Germany, Imperial Bank of: Securities held can be rapidly turned into cash, 167 ; composition of, compared with Bank of England and other European Banks, 2or. Specie, proportion of, to Liabilities, 84 ; held by Bank, 1876-1900, Table 28, 168 ; and bullion compared with Bank of England and other European Banks, 201. Germany, introduction of gold standard in, 1872, and unsteadiness of money market at time, 160 ; banking in, compared with England and France, 160-161, 162, 164 ; other Banks in, 160. Gibbs, Mr. H. H. (Lord Aldenham), on Bankers' Balances — see England, Bank of. Bankers' Balances. Glasgow, Bank of, stoppage of, effect doubt- less on Bankers' Balances, 1878, 25-26. Gold, regulations as to purchase of, by Bank of England, Bank Act, 1844, 30, 199; influx in May and June, 139 ; see also Autumnal Demand. Gold Bullion— ^(!« England, Bank of, BulUon. Governor of the Bank of England — see England, Bank of. Governing Body of. Hankey, Mr. Thomson, on "Bills" and " Mortgages," 29 ; on investment of de- posits of the Bank, 65. Holland, Bank of: established 1814, 174- 17s ; management, system of, 1 74-1 75 > principally a Bank of Discount, 176-177. Balance Sheet, compared with Bank of England and other European Banks, 206. Bank Act (Holland), 27th April, 1884, allowing sale of silver coin, compared with Treasury Letter in England, 176-177. Bank Law (Holland) of 1888 allowed Bank to buy bills payable abroad, 176 ; of 1884, an acknowledgment of responsibility of State to endeavour to keep standard of value from fluctuating, 177. Branch (Rotterdam), agencies and corre- spondents, 175. Bills payable abroad, not allowed to buy, before 1888, 176; inland and foreign held, 176. Capital and Reserve, 176 ; compared with Bank of England and other European Banks, 200. Deposits, public, compared with Bank of England and other European Banks, 201. Discounts and Loans, 175. Gold, demand for export of, 1882, 176. Liabilities, proportion of specie to, 84. Loans and advances, 176. Note Circulation, cover in coin and bullion 40 per cent., 176 ; amount of, compared with Bank of England and other European Banks, 201. INDEX 235 Holland, Bank of: Rate of Discount, Monthly Averages of, compared with those at Banks of England, France, Germany, and Belgium, and with London Bankers' Clearing House Returns, 136; influence of autumnal movement in gold shown in returns of, 139; compared with that at Bank of Germany, 171, 177 ; Variations in, 1844-1900, 174- 180 ; lower, on average, than that at other European Banks, 177 ; compared with that at Banks of England, France, and Germany, 177 ; Monthly Average of minimum, 1845-1900, Table 30, 178 ; Number of days at each rate and number of changes, in each year, 1844- 1900, Table 31, 179 ; Number of days at each rate, arranged from highest number to smallest, and from lowest rate to highest, 1S44-1900, Table 32, 180; compared with that at Bank of Belgium, 184, 186 ; Summary of fluctuations in, together with those in other returns, 1845-1900, Table 36, 192 ; Number of variations in, com- pared with those at Bank of England and at other European Banks, 1844-1900, Table 37, 196 ; Lowest and highest rate charged, and extent of fluctuation in, compared with those at Bank of England and at other European Banks, 1844-1900, Table 38, 197 ; Number and extent of fluctuations, compared with those at Bank of England and at other European Banks, 1 844-1900, Table 39, 198; low rates compared with Bank of England and other European Banks, 1844-1900, 204 ; intermediate rates compared with Bank of England and other European Banks, 1844-1900, 205 ; high rates com- pared with Bank of England and other European Banks, 1844-1900, 208; Num- ber of days at each rate compared with Bank of England and other European Banks, Table 41, 1844-1900, 209; Num- ber of variations, 1891-1900 and 1844- 1900, compared with Bank of England and other European Banks, 210 ; Average minimum charged by, compared with Bank of England and other European Banks, in groups of years, 1845-1900, Table 42, 210; Years in which no change took place, compared with Bank of Eng- land and other European Banks, 1844- 1900, Table 43, 211 ; Monthly Averages at, compared with Bank of England and other European Banks, and with returns of London Bankers' Clearing House, Table 45, 1845-1900, 216. Remittances and drafts, 175, 176. Securities, composition of, compared with Bank of England and other European Banks, 201. Specie, proportion of, to Liabilities, 84 ; and Bullion held, compared with Bank of England and other European Banks, 201. Stamp Duty, 175. Imperial Bank of Germany, the— x«« Ger- many, the Imperial Bank of. Imports — see Exports. Interest, Rate of—see England, Bank of. Rate of Discount. Investment of Deposits of the Bank, Mr. Thomson Hankey on, 65. Ireland, Banks in — see Banks, Ireland. Irish Note Circulation— j-eis Note Circula- tion, Irish, and Scotch and Irish. Joint Stock Banks— j«« Banks, Joint Stock. Liabilities of the Bank of England — see England, Bank of. Liabilities. Lloyd, Mr. Samuel Jones (Lord Overstone), on Bank Rate— rjee England, Bank of, Rate of Discount. London Bankers' Balances at Bank of England— j-ee England, Bank of. Bankers' Balances. London Bankers' Clearing House— .!-« Clearing House, London Bankers'. Lowe, Mr. — see Sherbrooke, Lord. Market, position of Bank to outside, fifty years ago, 48-51. Market Rate and Bank Rate, divergence between, 32 ; Table 4, 1845-1900, 33 ; Bank adapted its own rate to, 1844, 49; effect of this down to 1848, 49-50; and Bank Rate in 1857, 1858, 50-51 ; Bank Rate not so clear a guide to, as formerly, 55-56 ; influence of Bank on, less than formerly, 67, 104 ; Bank of England Rate previous to 1844 no guide to, 140. Money, unsteadiness in the value of, 42 ; market value of considerably below Bank Rate before 1844, 49 ; greater growth of loanable capital in proportion to reserve, one cause of liability to fluctuation in value of, 103 ; in the country, greatly increased during last fifty years, 219. Money Market, methods as to Bill-broking followed in England, unfavourable to quiet working of, 52 ; Rate of Discount, a valuable index to fluctuations in, 95 ; demands for specie in London, connected with Bank of England Rate of Discount, 195, 198 ; English, connected with foreign, 215 ; English, largely the Clearing House of the world, 215 ; influence of Bank of England on, 219. Money Markets of Europe and America, Recent events influencing, 9 ; foreign, con- nection with English, 215. Mortgages and Bills of Exchange, differ- ence between, 29. New York, Associated Banks — see Banks, New York. Newmarch, Mr., estimate of Bills in circu- lation, 1851, 66; of metalHc circulation, 73 ; of holdings of Banks in 1 85 1, 220. Note Circulation. Note Circulation, Bank of England — see Bank of England, Note Circulation. Note Circulation, Belgium, France, Ger- many, Holland — see Belgium, France, Germany, Holland, Banks of. Note Cir- culation. 236 INDEX Note Circulation. English Country Note Circulation : Bank of England Note Circulation, Bullion held in the Issue Depart- ment, 69-80; English Country Note Circulation, Bank of England Notes take the place of lapsed Issues of, 72-74 ; Bank Act of 1844 designed to suppress, 74; demands on Reserve increased by sup- pression of, 74 ; suppression of, disadvan- tage to local trade, 74 ; Monthly Averages of, 1845-1900, Table 8, 75 ; Summary of fluctuations in, together vpith those in other returns, 1845-1900, Table 36, 193. Irish Note Circulation and Specie, Monthly Averages, 1845-1900, Table 16, 121-123 ; Table 17, 124-13 1 ; see also Scotch and Irish Note Circulation. Scotch Note Circulation, periodic increase in. May and November, 107-109 ; peri- odic increase, influence on business, 107- 108 ; Dr. Charles Gairdner on causes of periodic fluctuations in, 109 ; and Specie, Monthly averages of, 1845- 1900, Table IS, 118-120; Table 17, 124-131. Scotch and Irish Note Circulation, con- nected with Bank of England Reserve, 8, 41, 112 ; pressure on Bank of England, May and November,caused by demands of, 1 10; fluctuations in, noticed in 1856, III ; The Scotch and Irish Note Circu- lation, 112-131 ; and Bank Acts, 1845, 112; fluctuations in specie held against, 113; Dr. Charles Gairdner on influence exercised by Bank Acts, 1844-45, °^t ii3- 115 ; Bank of England Reserve, the only source whence specie can be drawn for, lis ; specie held, not special security for notes, but asset against general liabilities, IIS; fixed issues, 115; and specie held, difference between highest and lowest months and mean of extreme variations, 116 ; clauses in the Bank Acts regulating holding of specie against excess issue, 116-117 ; and specie held. Bank of Eng- land Rate of Discount, arranged from smallest to largest figures. Monthly Aver- ages, with those of Bank of England Rate of Discount, 1845-1900, Table 17, 124- 131 ; months of maximum, 136 ; influ- ence of Autumnal Drain, 139 ; Summary of fluctuations in returns of, and in those of specie held, together with those of other returns, 1845-1900, Table 36, 192- 193 ; demands made on bullion held by Bank through movements in, influence Bank of England Rate of Discount, 219. "Other" deposits— j«d England, Bank of, deposits. "Other" securities— «e England, Bank of, securities. Overstone, Lord, on the Bank Rate— «e England, Bank of. Rate of Discount. Panics: 1847, proportion of Reserve, London Bankers' Balances and Liabilities during, 89; Rate of Discount, gold bullion in Bank and Reserve of notes during, 89 ; Bank of England Rate of Discount com- pared with that of Bank of France, during, 152 ; permission to suspend Bank Act, 1844, fixing limit of note issue granted, 164. Panics : 1857, Bankers' Balances during, 24, 36 ; influence on Bankers' Balances, 25 ; amount of Bankers' Balances and of Reserve in, 36 ; proportion of Reserve, London Bankers' Balances and Lia- bilities during, 89 ; Rate of Discount, gold bullion in Bank, Reserve of notes during, 89 ; Treasury Letter issued during, 89 npte ; Bank of England Rate of Dis- count compared with Bank of France during, 152; Bank Act, 1844, fixing limit of note issue suspended, 164. 1866, Bankers' Balances during, 24, 36 ; diminution of Reserve during, 25 ; in- fluence of, on Bankers' Balances, 25 ; amount of Bankers' Balances and of Re- serve in, 36 ; fluctuations in temporary advances during, 68 ; proportion of Re- serve, London Bankers' Balances and Liabilities during, 89 ; Rate of Discount, gold bullion in Bank and Reserve of notes during, 89; Bank of England Rate of Discount compared with Bank of France, 152; permission to suspend Bank Act, 1844, fixing limit of note issue granted, 164. 187s, Bankers' Balances during, 25, 36 ; influence of, on Bankers' Balances, 25 ; other Deposits, other Securities, and Re- serve during, 25. 1890, other deposits, other securities, and Reserve during, 26 ; Rate of Discount, gold bullion in Bank and Reserve of notes during, 90 ; Bank of England Rate of Discount compared with that of Bank of France during, 152. See also Baring Crisis. Parliamentary Reports, Details of Bank of England weekly returns, 2-7 ; Table 2, 4-5 ; information as to the Bank of Eng- land adhering to fixed minimum Rate of Discount, Reports 1847-8, 1848, 48-50; information as to Bank of England rate. Reports, 1857, 1858, 50-51 ; remarks on constitution of governing body of the Bank, 58-59- Private and Joint Stock Banks— ;«« Banks, Private and Joint Stock. Railway Debentures held by Bank of Eng- land — see England, Bank of, Securities. Rate, Market — see Market Rate. Rate of Discount, Bank of England — see England, Bank of. Rate of Discount. Rate of Discount, Belgium, France, Ger- many, and Holland — see Belgium, France, Germany, and Holland, Banks of. Re-discounting, practice of foreign Banks, 52- Reichsbank — see Germany, Imperial Bank of. Reserve of the Bank of England — see England, Bank of. Reserve. Scotch Note Circulation — see Note Circula- tion, Scotch, and Scotch and Irish. Securities of the Bank of England — see England, Bank of. Securities. INDEX 237 Sherbrooke, Lord, Bill proposed by, to allow excess note issue, text of, 1873, 93-94; plan for modification of Bank Act, 1844- 1873, 172. Silver bullion held by Bank, 78 ; discussed in connection with Indian exchanges, 79 ; held by Bank, 1844-53, 1860-61, Table 10, 80. Specie at command of Bank, reserve of notes represents greater part of, 84 ; demands for in London Money Market, and Bank of England Rate of Discount, 195, 198 ; for export, influence of, on Bank of England Rate of Discount, 219. Specie, Autumnal Drain of — see Autumnal Drain. Specie held by Bank of England — see Eng- land, Bank of. Bullion and Coin, and aisa Specie at command of Bank. Specie held by Scotch and Irish Banks — see Note Circulation, Scotch and Irish. Temporary Advances of Bank of England — see England, Bank of. Temporary Ad- vances. Treasury Letter— «« Bank of England Treasury Letter. Weekly Returns of Bank of England— see England, Bank of. Weekly Returns. PLYMOUTH WILLIAM BKENDON AND SON PRINTERS